Quarterlytics / Technology / Communication Equipment / AudioCodes Ltd.

AudioCodes Ltd.

audc · NASDAQ Technology
Claim this profile
Ticker audc
Exchange NASDAQ
Sector Technology
Industry Communication Equipment
Employees 946
← All annual reports
FY2009 Annual Report · AudioCodes Ltd.
Sign in to download
Loading PDF…
UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
WASHINGTON, D.C.  20549

FORM 20–F

☐

x

☐

☐

REGISTRATION STATEMENT PURSUANT TO SECTION 12(b) OR (g) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

OR

For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2009

OR

TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

SHELL COMPANY REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

OR

Date of event requiring this shell company report _______________________

For the transition period from                           to

Commission file number 0-30070

AUDIOCODES LTD.
(Exact name of Registrant as specified in its charter
and translation of Registrant’s name into English)

ISRAEL
(Jurisdiction of incorporation or organization)

1 Hayarden Street, Airport City Lod 70151, Israel
(Address of principal executive offices)

Shabtai Adlersberg, Chairman and CEO, Tel: 972-3-976-4105,  Fax: 972-3-9764040, 1 Hayarden Street, Airport City, Lod 70151 Israel
(Name, Telephone, E-mail and/or Facsimile number  and Address of Company Contact Person)

Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:

Title of each class
Ordinary Shares, nominal value NIS 0.01 per share

Name of each exchange on which registered
NASDAQ Global Select Market

Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act:

None

(Title of Class)

Securities for which there is a reporting obligation pursuant to Section 15(d) of the Act:

None

report.

Indicate the number of outstanding shares of each of the issuer’s classes of capital or common stock as of the close of the period covered by the annual

(Title of Class)

As of December 31, 2009, the Registrant had outstanding 40,269,194 Ordinary Shares, nominal value NIS 0.01 per share.

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act:

If this report is an annual or transition report, indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of

the Securities Exchange Act of 1934:

Yes  ☐  No  x

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of
1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing
requirements for the past 90 days.

Yes  ☐   No  x

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Indicate  by  check  mark  whether  registrant  has  submitted  electronically  and  posted  omits  corporate  Web  site,  if  any,  every  Interactive  Data  File
required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter
period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files)

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, or a non-accelerated filer.  See definition of “accelerated

filer and large accelerated filer” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.  (Check one):

Yes ☐   No ☐

Yes x   No ☐

Large Accelerated filer ☐

Accelerated filer x

Non-accelerated filer ☐

Indicate by check mark which basis of accounting the registrant has used to prepare the financial statements included in this filing:

U.S. GAAP   x

International  Financial  Reporting  Standards  as  issued  by  the
International Accounting Standards Board   ☐

Other   ☐

If “Other” has been checked in response to the previous question, indicate by check mark which financial statement item the registrant has elected to

follow.

If this is an annual report, indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act):

Yes  ☐  No  x

 ☐ Item 17         ☐ Item 18

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
PRELIMINARY NOTE

This Annual Report contains “forward-looking statements” within the meaning of Section 27A of the Securities Act of 1933, or the Securities Act, and
Section 21E of the Securities Exchange Act, or the Exchange Act.  These forward-looking statements can generally be identified as such because the context of
the  statement  will  include  words  such  as  “may,”  “will,”  “intends,”  “plans,”  “believes,”  “anticipates,”  “expects,”  “estimates,”  “predicts,”  “potential,”
“continue,”  or  “opportunity,”  the  negative  of  these  words  or  words  of  similar  import.    Similarly,  statements  that  describe  our  business  outlook  or  future
economic performance, anticipated revenues, expenses or other financial items, introductions and advancements in development of products, and plans and
objectives related thereto, and statements concerning assumptions made or expectations as to any future events, conditions, performance or other matters, are
also  forward-looking  statements.    Forward-looking  statements  are  subject  to  risks,  uncertainties  and  other  factors  that  could  cause  actual  results  to  differ
materially from those stated in such statements. Factors that could cause or contribute to such differences include, but are not limited to, those set forth under
Item 3.D, “Key Information – Risk Factors” of this Annual Report.

Our actual results of operations and execution of our business strategy could differ materially from those expressed in, or implied by, the forward-
looking statements.  In addition, past financial and/or operating performance is not necessarily a reliable indicator of future performance and you should not
use our historical performance to anticipate results or future period trends.  We can give no assurances that any of the events anticipated by the forward-looking
statements will occur or, if any of them do, what impact they will have on our results of operations and financial condition.  In evaluating our forward-looking
statements, you should specifically consider the risks and uncertainties set forth under Item 3.D, “Key Information – Risk Factors” of this Annual Report.

Unless the context otherwise requires, “AudioCodes,” “us,” “we” and “our” refer to AudioCodes Ltd. and its subsidiaries.

ITEM 1.

IDENTITY OF DIRECTORS, SENIOR MANAGEMENT AND ADVISERS

PART I

Not applicable.

ITEM 2.

OFFER STATISTICS AND EXPECTED TIMETABLE

Not applicable.

ITEM 3.

KEY INFORMATION

1

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
A.           SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA

The selected financial data, set forth in the table below, have been derived from our audited historical financial statements for each of the years from
2005  through  2009.  The  selected  consolidated  statement  of  operations  data  for  the  years  ended  December  31,  2007,  2008  and  2009,  and  the  selected
consolidated balance sheet data as of December 31, 2008 and 2009, have been derived from our audited consolidated financial statements set forth elsewhere in
this Annual Report. The selected consolidated statement of operations data for the years ended December 31, 2005 and 2006, and the selected consolidated
balance sheet data as of December 31, 2005, 2006 and 2007, have been derived from our previously published audited consolidated financial statements, which
are not included in this Annual Report. The selected financial data should be read in conjunction with our consolidated financial statements, and are qualified
entirely by reference to these consolidated financial statements.

2

 
 
 
 
Statement of Operations Data:
Revenues
Cost of revenues
Gross profit
Operating expense:

Research and development, net
Selling and marketing
General and administrative
Impairment of goodwill and intangible assets

Total operating expenses
Operating income (loss)
Financial expenses, net (*)
Income (loss) before taxes on income (tax benefit)
Taxes on income, net
Equity in losses of affiliated companies

Net income (loss)

Net loss attributable to a non-controlling interest

Net income (loss) attributable to AudioCodes

Basic net earnings (loss) per share (*)

Diluted net earnings (loss) per share (*)

Year Ended December 31,

2005

2006

2007

2008

2009

(In thousands, except per share data)

  $

115,827    $
46,993     
68,834     

147,353    $
61,242     
86,111     

158,235    $
69,185     
89,050     

24,415     
25,944     
6,004     
-     
56,363     
12,471     
1,769     
10,702     
799     
693     
9,210    $

-     

9,210    $

0.23    $

0.21    $

35,416     
37,664     
8,766     
-     
81,846     
4,265     
700     
3,565     
289     
916     
2,360    $

-     

2,360    $

0.06    $

0.05    $

  $

  $

  $

  $

174,744    $
77,455     
97,289     

37,833     
44,657     
9,219     
85,015     
176,724     
(79,435)    
3,268     
(82,703)    
505     
2,582     
(85,790)   $

-    $

40,706     
42,900     
9,637     
-     
93,243     
(4,193)    
2,167     
(6,360)    
1,265     
1,097     
(8,722)   $

-     

(8,722)   $

(85,790)   $

(0.20)   $

(0.20)   $

(2.08)   $

(2.08)   $

125,894 
56,194 
69,700 

29,952 
32,111 
7,821 
- 
69,884 
(184)
2,744 
(2,928)
290 
76 
(3,294)

472 

(2,822)

(0.07)

(0.07)

Weighted average number of ordinary shares used in computing

basic net earnings (loss) per share

40,296     

41,717     

42,699     

41,201     

40,208 

Weighted average number of ordinary shares used in computing

diluted net earnings per share

43,086     

43,689     

42,699     

41,201     

40,208 

(*) Amounts adjusted due to implementation of ASC 470-20 (formerly FSP APB 14-1).

3

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
     
     
   
 
 
 
 
   
     
     
      
      
 
   
   
   
      
      
      
      
  
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
 
 
 
Balance Sheet Data:
Cash and cash equivalents
Short-term bank deposits, structured notes, marketable

securities and accrued interest

Working capital (*)
Long-term bank deposits, structured notes and  marketable

securities
Total assets (*)
Bank loans
Senior convertible notes (*)
AudioCodes shareholders’ equity(*)
Non-controlling interest(*)
Total equity (*)
Capital stock

2005

2006

December 31,
2007

2008

2009

  $

70,957    $

25,171    $

75,063    $

36,779    $

38,969 

71,792     
150,798     

77,572     
292,149     
-     
105,323     
154,545     
-     
154,545     
130,744     

58,080     
97,454     

35,309     
124,676     

78,351     
57,370     

50,377     
336,912     
-     
109,949     
175,607     
-     
175,607     
149,336     

32,670     
344,267     
-     
114,893     
180,577     
-     
180,577     
162,103     

-     
230,304     
27,750     
70,670     
83,860     
228     
84,088     
167,981     

13,902 
54,357 

- 
147,533 
21,750 
403 
84,129 
(244)
83,885 
170,062 

(*) Amounts adjusted due to implementation of ASC 470.

B. 

CAPITALIZATION AND INDEBTEDNESS

Not applicable.

C. 

REASONS FOR THE OFFER AND USE OF PROCEEDS

Not applicable.

D. 

RISK FACTORS

We are subject to various risks and uncertainties relating to or arising out of the nature of our business and general business, economic, financing,
legal and other factors or conditions that may affect us. We believe that the occurrence of any one or some combination of the following factors could have a
material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, cash flows and results of operations.

4

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
 
   
     
     
     
     
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Risks Related to Our Business and Industry

We reported losses in 2007, 2008 and 2009. We may experience additional losses in the future.

We reported a net loss of $8.7 million in 2007, $85.8 million in 2008 and $2.8 million in 2009. The loss in 2008 included a non-cash impairment charge of
$86.1 million taken in the fourth quarter of 2008 with respect to goodwill, intangible assets and investment in an affiliate. The majority of our expenses are
directly and indirectly related to the number of people we employ.  We may increase our expenses based on projections of revenue growth. If at any given time
we do not meet our expectations for growth in revenues our expenses incurred in anticipation of projected revenues may cause us to incur a loss. We may not
be able to anticipate a loss in advance and adjust our variable costs accordingly. We will need to increase revenues and reduce expenses in order to return to
profitability.

We  have  depended,  and  expect  to  continue  to  depend,  on  a  small  number  of  large  customers.  Our  largest  customer,  Nortel  Networks,  filed  for
bankruptcy protection in January 2009. Nortel has sold a number of its business units and is continuing to sell business units and liquidate assets in
the bankruptcy proceeding. The loss of Nortel or one of our other large customers or the reduction in purchases by a significant customer or failure of
such customer to pay for the products it purchases from us could have a material adverse effect on our revenues.

Historically, a substantial portion of our revenue has been derived from large purchases by a small number of original equipment manufacturers, or
OEMs, and network equipment providers, or NEPs, systems integrators and distributors. For example, our top three customers accounted for approximately
26.1% of our revenues in 2007 20.9% of our revenues in 2008 and 25.7% of our revenues in 2009. Based on our experience, we expect that our customer base
may  change  from  period  to  period.  If  we  lose  a  large  customer  and  fail  to  add  new  customers,  or  if  purchases  made  by  such  customers  are  significantly
reduced, there could be a material adverse effect on our results of operations.

Sales to Nortel Networks, our largest customer, accounted for 15.6% of our revenues in 2009 compared to 14.4% of our revenues in 2008 and 17.0%
of our revenues in 2007 ..  Nortel filed for bankruptcy protection in January 2009. As a result of this bankruptcy filing, $1.7 million of sales to Nortel in the
fourth quarter of 2008 were recorded as unpaid deferred revenues which also reduced trade receivables on our balance sheet. During 2009, Nortel returned to
us products with a sales price of $706,000, which reduced our unpaid deferred revenues by this amount. Nortel has sold a number of its business units and is
continuing  to  sell  business  units  and  liquidate  assets  in  the  bankruptcy  proceeding.  Some  of  the  business  units  sold  by  Nortel  were  customers  of  ours.  We
cannot be sure if Nortel or business units sold by Nortel that were customers of ours will continue to purchase products from us or, if Nortel sells additional
business units that deal with us, any purchaser of those business units will continue to do business with us. Any significant reduction in sales to Nortel and
those business units sold by Nortel that were customers of ours, or the inability to collect a significant portion of amounts owed to us by Nortel, could have a
material adverse effect on our results of operations.

5

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Recent and future economic conditions, including turmoil in the financial and credit markets, may adversely affect our business.

The general economic downturn, including disruptions in the world credit and equity markets, has had and continues to have a significant negative
impact  on  business  around  the  world.    The  impact  of  the  current  economic  environment  on  the  technology  industry  and  our  major  customers  has  been
significant.    Conditions  may  continue  to  be  depressed  or  may  be  subject  to  further  deterioration  which  could  lead  to  a  further  reduction  in  consumer  and
customer spending overall, which could have an adverse impact on sales of our products.  A disruption in the ability of our significant customers to access
liquidity  could  cause  serious  disruptions  or  an  overall  deterioration  of  their  businesses  which  could  lead  to  a  significant  reduction  in  their  orders  of  our
products and the inability or failure on their part to meet their payment obligations to us, any of which could have a material adverse effect on our results of
operations  and  liquidity.   A  significant  adverse  change  in  a  customer’s  financial  and/or  credit  position  could  also  require  us  to  assume  greater  credit  risk
relating to that customer’s receivables or could limit our ability to collect receivables related to previous purchases by that customer.  As a result, our reserves
for doubtful accounts and write-offs of accounts receivable may increase.

We  may  need  additional  financing  to  operate  or  grow  our  business.  We  may  not  be  able  to  raise  additional  financing  for  our  capital  needs  on
favorable terms, or at all, which could limit our ability to grow and to continue our longer term expansion plans.

We  may  need  additional  financing  to  operate  our  business  or  continue  our  longer  term  expansion  plans.  To  the  extent  that  we  cannot  fund  our
activities and acquisitions through our existing cash resources and any cash we generate from operations, we may need to raise equity or debt funds through
additional public or private financings. In November 2009, we were required to use $73.1 million to repurchase almost all of our outstanding senior convertible
notes  in  accordance  with  the  terms  of  the  notes.  We  borrowed  $30  million  in  2008  that  is  repayable  in  20  equal  quarterly  payments  of  $1.5  million  from
August, 2008 through July 2013. We will need to pay these installments and could also be required to repay all or portion of these bank loans if we do not
comply  with  covenants  in  our  loan  agreements  with  respect  to  maintaining  shareholders'  equity  at  specified  levels  or  achieving  certain  levels  of  operating
income.  We cannot be certain that we will be able to obtain additional financing on commercially reasonable terms, or at all. This could inhibit our growth,
increase our financing costs or cause us severe financial difficulties.

We are party to an agreement for the construction and long-term lease of a new building in Israel. We do not currently need all of the space that will
be  contained  in  this  building.  If  we  are  unable  to  sublease  the  property  under  reasonable  commercial  terms,  we  may  incur  increased  operating
expenses which could adversely affect our results of operations.

In  May,  2007,  we  entered  into  an  agreement  with  respect  to  property  adjacent  to  our  headquarters  in  Israel,  pursuant  to  which  a  building  of
approximately 145,000 square feet is being erected and will be leased to us for a period of eleven years. This new building was substantially completed on a
structural level in May 2010. The landlord claims that we should have taken delivery of the building at that time and started paying rent. We have disagreed
with  the  landlord’s  interpretation  of  the  relevant  agreement.  This  dispute  may  be  referred  to  arbitration.  We  cannot  predict  the  outcome  of  any  arbitration
proceeding or the effect on us if we were to lose an arbitration proceeding. We estimate the annual lease payments (including management fees) to be in the
range of $2.0 million to $3.2 million, depending on the amount expended on improvements made to the building.

6

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At  the  time  we  entered  into  the  agreement  in  2007,  the  leased  property  was  intended  to  serve  our  expanding  needs.  However,  in  view  of  current
economic conditions and our reduction in personnel undertaken since 2008, we do not need to occupy the entire building and may seek to sublease all or a
portion of the new building to third parties. If we are unable to enter into a sublease or enter into a sublease for an amount that is less than our obligations under
the lease, we may incur significant additional operating expenses which could adversely affect our results of operations.

We are dependent on the development of the VoIP market to increase our sales.

We are dependent on the development of the Voice over Internet Protocol, or VoIP, market to increase our sales. Most existing networks are still not
based on Voice over Packet technology which we use in our products designed for the VoIP market. We cannot be sure that the delivery of telephone and other
communications  services  over  packet  networks  will  expand  or  that  there  will  be  a  need  to  interconnect  to  other  networks  utilizing  the  type  of  technology
contained in our products. For example, the need for our media gateway products depends on the need to interconnect VoIP networks with traditional non-
packet based networks. Our session border control products depend on growth in the need to interconnect Voice over Packet networks with each other. The
adaptation process of connecting packet networks and telephone networks can be time consuming and costly. Sales of our VoIP products will depend on the
development of packet networks and the commercialization of VoIP services.  If this market develops more slowly than we expect, we may not be able to sell
our products in a significant enough volume to be profitable.

We may expand our business through acquisitions that could result in diversion of resources and extra expenses. This could disrupt our business and
affect our results of operations.

Part of our strategy is to pursue acquisitions of, or investments in, businesses and technologies or to establish joint ventures to expand our business.
For example, in April 2003, we purchased a product group from Nortel Networks and in May 2004 we purchased Ai-Logix Inc., now known as AudioCodes
Inc.  In 2005, we invested in two Israeli-based companies, MailVision Ltd. and CTI Squared Ltd., and continued investing in Natural Speech Communication
Ltd.  We have recognized losses from our equity investment in Natural Speech Communication in our results of operations in each of the past three years. In
December  2008,  we  began  consolidating  the  financial  results  of  Natural  Speech  Communication  in  our  financial  results  and  in  May  2010  we  acquired  the
remaining shares of Natural Speech Communications that were not previously owned by us. In July 2006, we acquired Nuera Communications, Inc. (which
merged into AudioCodes Inc.), in August 2006, we acquired Netrake Corporation (which merged into AudioCodes Inc.), and in April 2007, we completed our
acquisition of CTI Squared Ltd.

7

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
The negotiation of acquisitions, investments or joint ventures, as well as the integration of acquired or jointly developed businesses or technologies,
could divert our management’s time and resources.  Acquired businesses, technologies or joint ventures may not be successfully integrated with our products
and operations. The markets for the products produced by the companies we acquire may take longer than we anticipated to develop and to result in increased
sales and profits for us. We may not realize the intended benefits of any acquisition, investment or joint venture and we may incur losses from any acquisition,
investment or joint venture.

The  future  valuation  of  acquired  businesses  may  be  less  than  the  purchase  price  we  paid  and  result  in  impairment  charges  related  to  goodwill  or
intangible  assets.    During  the  fourth  quarter  of  2008,  we  recognized  non-cash  impairment  charges  of  $86.1  million  with  respect  to  goodwill  and  intangible
assets related to our acquisitions and an investment in an affiliated company.

In addition, acquisitions could result in:

·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·

substantial cash expenditures;
potentially dilutive issuances of equity securities;
the incurrence of debt and contingent liabilities;
a decrease in our profit margins;
amortization of intangibles and potential impairment of goodwill and intangible assets, such as occurred during 2008;
reduction of management attention to other parts of the business;
failure to invest in different areas or alternative investments;
failure to generate expected financial results or reach business goals; and
increased expenditures on human resources and related costs.

If acquisitions disrupt our sales or marketing efforts or operations, our business may suffer.

We recorded significant charges for the impairment of goodwill and intangible assets during the fourth quarter of 2008 which caused us to report a
net loss for 2008.  If our goodwill and other intangible assets become further impaired, we may be required to record additional charges to earnings.

We recorded aggregate charges of $86.1 million in the fourth quarter of 2008 for impairment charges with respect to goodwill and intangible assets related to
our acquisitions and an investment in an affiliated company. As a result, we reported a net loss for 2008. As of December 31, 2009, we had goodwill and other
intangible assets in an aggregate amount of $38.9 million, or approximately 26.4% of our total assets and 46.5% of our shareholders’ equity. Under accounting
principles generally accepted in the United States, we review our goodwill and other intangible assets for impairment annually during the fourth quarter of each
fiscal year and when events or changes in circumstances indicate the carrying value may not be recoverable.  The carrying value of our goodwill and other
intangible assets may not be recoverable due to factors such as a decline in our stock price and market capitalization, reduced estimates of future cash flows
and  profitability  and  slower  growth  rates  in  our  industry.    Our  impairment  charges  in  2008  were  primarily  the  result  of  a  decrease  in  our  market
capitalization.    Estimates  of  future  cash  flows  and  profitability  are  based  on  an  updated  long-term  financial  outlook  of  our  operations.  However,  actual
performance in the near-term or long-term could be materially different from these forecasts, which could impact future estimates.  A further significant decline
in our market capitalization or deterioration in our projected results could result in additional impairment of goodwill and/or intangible assets.  We may be
required  in  the  future  to  record  a  significant  charge  to  earnings  in  our  financial  statements  during  a  period  in  which  an  impairment  of  our  goodwill  is
determined to exist, as happened in 2008, which would negatively impact our results of operations and could negatively impact our stock price.

8

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
If new products we recently introduced or expect to introduce in the future fail to generate the level of demand we anticipated, we will realize a lower
than expected return from our investment in research and development with respect to those products, and our results of operations may suffer.

Our  success  is  dependent,  in  part,  on  the  willingness  of  our  customers  to  transition  or  migrate  to  new  products,  such  as  our  expanded  offering  of
Mediant  and  IPmedia  products,  our  session  border  controller  products,  the  multi  service  business  gateways  (MSBGs),  our  software  application  products  or
expected future products. We are involved in a continuous process of evaluating changing market demands and customer requirements in order to develop and
introduce  new  products,  features  and  applications  to  meet  changing  demands  and  requirements.  We  need  to  be  able  to  interpret  market  trends  and  the
advancement of technology in order to successfully develop and introduce new products, features and applications. If potential customers defer transition or
migration to new products, our return on our investment in research and development with respect to products recently introduced or expected to be introduced
in the near future will be lower than we originally anticipated and our results of our operations may suffer.

Because  of  the  rapid  technological  development  in  the  communications  equipment  market  and  the  intense  competition  we  face,  our  products  can
become  outmoded  or  obsolete  in  a  relatively  short  period  of  time,  which  requires  us  to  provide  frequent  updates  and/or  replacements  to  existing
products.  If we do not successfully manage the transition process to the next generation of our products, our operating results may be harmed.

The communications equipment market is characterized by rapid technological innovation and intense competition. Accordingly, our success depends
in part on our ability to develop next generation products in a timely and cost-effective manner. The development of new products is expensive, complex and
time consuming. If we do not rapidly develop our next generation products ahead of our competitors, we may lose both existing and potential customers to our
competitors. Further, if a competitor develops a new, less expensive product using a different technological approach to delivering informational services over
existing  networks,  our  products  would  no  longer  be  competitive.  Conversely,  even  if  we  are  successful  in  rapidly  developing  new  products  ahead  of  our
competitors and we do not cost-effectively manage our inventory levels of existing products when making the transition to the new products, our financial
results could be negatively affected by high levels of obsolete inventory. If any of the foregoing were to occur, then our operating results would be harmed.

9

 
 
 
 
 
 
Our industry is rapidly evolving and we may not be able to keep pace with technological changes, which could adversely affect our business.

The  transmission  of  multimedia  over  data  networks  is  rapidly  evolving.  Short  product  life  cycles  place  a  premium  on  our  ability  to  manage  the
transition from current products to new products.  Our future success in generating revenues will depend on our ability to enhance our existing products and to
develop  and  introduce  new  products  and  product  features.  These  products  and  features  must  keep  pace  with  technological  developments  and  address  the
increasingly sophisticated needs of our customers. The development of new technologies and products is increasingly complex and uncertain. This increases
the difficulty in coordinating the planning and production process and can result in delay in the introduction of new technologies and products.

The increase in the number of IP networks may adversely affect the demand for media gateway products.

Media gateway products are primarily intended to transcode voice from traditional telephony networks to IP networks and vise versa. Along with the
growth in the number of IP networks, there has been an increase in the amount of information that is sent directly from one IP network to another IP network.
This direct network communication potentially obviates the need to use a media gateway or transcoding. A reduction in the demand for media gateways may
adversely affect the demand for our media gateway products and, in turn, adversely affect our results of operations.

New industry standards, the modification of our products to meet additional existing standards or the addition of features to our products may delay
the introduction of our products or increase our costs.

The industry standards that apply to our products are continually evolving. In addition, since our products are integrated into networks consisting of
elements manufactured by various companies, they must comply with a number of industry standards and practices established by various international bodies
and industry forums.  Should new standards gain broad acceptance, we will be required to adopt those standards in our products. We may also decide to modify
our products to meet additional existing standards or add features to our products. Standards may be adopted by various industry interest groups or may be
proprietary and nonetheless accepted broadly in the industry. It may take us a significant amount of time to develop and design products incorporating these
new standards. We may also have to pay additional fees to the developers of the technologies which constitute the newly adopted standards.

Our  OEM  customers  or  potential  customers  may  develop  or  prefer  to  develop  their  own  technical  solutions,  and  as  a  result,  would  not  buy  our
products.

Our products are sold also as components or building blocks to large OEMs and NEPs. These customers incorporate our products into their product
offerings,  usually  in  conjunction  with  value-added  services  of  their  own  or  of  third  parties.  OEM  or  NEP  customers  or  potential  customers  may  prefer  to
develop their own technology or purchase third party technology. They could also manufacture their own components or building blocks that are similar to the
ones we offer. Large customers have already committed significant resources in developing integrated product offerings. Customers may decide that this gives
them better profitability and/or greater control over supplies, specifications and performance. Customers may therefore not buy components or products from
an external manufacturer such as us. This could have an adverse impact on our ability to sell our products and our revenues.

10

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
We have a limited order backlog. If revenue levels for any quarter fall below our expectations, our results of operations will be adversely affected.

We have a limited order backlog, which makes revenues in any quarter substantially dependent on orders received and delivered in that quarter. A
delay in the recognition of revenue, even from one customer, may have a significant negative impact on our results of operations for a given period. We base
our decisions regarding our operating expenses on anticipated revenue trends, and our expense levels are relatively fixed, or require some time for adjustment.
Because only a small portion of our expenses varies with our revenues, if revenue levels fall below our expectations, our results of operations will be adversely
affected.

Generally,  we  sell  to  original  equipment  manufacturers,  or  OEMs,  network  equipment  providers  or  system  integrator  customers,  as  well  as  to
distributors.  As a result, we have less information with respect to the actual requirements of end-users and their utilization of equipment. We also
have less influence over the choice of equipment by these end-users.

We typically sell to OEM customers, network equipment providers, and system integrators, as well as to distributors. Our customers usually purchase
equipment from several suppliers and may be trying to fulfill one of their customers’ specific technical specifications. We rely heavily on our customers for
sales  of  our  products  and  to  inform  us  about  market  trends  and  the  needs  of  their  customers.  We  cannot  be  certain  that  this  information  is  accurate.  If  the
information we receive is not accurate, we may be manufacturing products that do not have a customer or fail to manufacture products that end-users want.
Because we are selling products to OEMs, system integrators and distributors rather than directly to end-users, we have less control over the ultimate selection
of products by end-users.

The  markets  we  serve  are  highly  competitive  and  many  of  our  competitors  have  much  greater  resources,  which  may  make  it  difficult  for  us  to
maintain profitability.

Competition in our industry is intense and we expect competition to increase in the future. Our competitors currently sell products that provide similar
benefits  to  those  that  we  sell.  There  has  been  a  significant  amount  of  merger  and  acquisition  activity  and  strategic  alliances,  frequently  involving  major
telecommunications equipment manufacturers acquiring smaller companies, and we expect that this will result in an increasing concentration of market share
among these companies, many of whom are our customers.

11

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Our principal competitors in the area of analog media gateways (2 to 24 ports) for access and enterprise are Linksys (a division of Cisco Systems,
Inc.),  Mediatrix  Telecom,  Inc.,  Vega  Stream  Limited,  Samsung,  Innovaphone  AG,  Net.com/Quintum  Technologies,  Tainet  Communication  System  Corp.,
Welltech,  Ascii  Corp.,  D-Link  Systems,  Inc.,  Multitech  Inc.,  Inomedia,  OKI  and  LG.  In  the  area  of  low  density  digital  gateway  and  multi-service  business
gateways  we  face  competition  from  companies  such  as  Cisco,  Adtran,  Oneaccess,  and  more  specifically  in  the  enterprise  class  Session  Border  Controller
technology  with  ACME  Packet  (Convergence),  SIPera,  Ingate  and  Edwater.  In  addition  we  face  competition  in  low,  mid  and  high  density  gateways  from
companies  such  as  Nortel,  Alcatel-Lucent,  Nokia-Siemens,  Huawei,  Ericsson,  UTstarcom,  ZTE  and  from  Cisco  Systems,  Inc.,  Veraz  Networks,  Sonus
Networks, General Bandwidth, Dialogic/Cantat Technologies and Commatch (Telrad), some of which are also customers of our products and technology.

Our principal competitors in the media server market segment are Dialogic/Cantata Technology, NMS Communications, Convedia/Radisys, Movius
(IP  Unity  Glenayre),  Cognitronics  and  Aculab.    In  addition,  we  face  competition  in  software-based  and  hardware-based  media  servers  from  internal
development at companies such as Hewlett-Packard, Comverse-NetCentrex, Nortel, Alcatel - Lucent, Nokia – Siemens and Ericsson.

Our principal competitors in the sale of signal processing chips are Texas Instruments, Broadcom, Infineon, Centillium, Surf and Mindspeed. Several
large manufacturers of generic signal processors, such as Motorola, Agere Systems, which merged with LSI Corporation in April 2007, and Intel have begun,
or  are  expected  to  begin,  marketing  competing  processors.  Our  principal  competitors  in  the  communications  board  market  are  Dialogic/NMS
Communications,  Cantata, Aculab, PIKA Technologies, Inc., Intel and Motorola.

Our principal competitors in the area of IP Phones are comprised of “best-of-breed” IP phone vendors and end-to-end IP telephony vendors. “Best of
breed”  IP  phone  vendors  sell  standard-based  SIP  phones  that  can  be  integrated  into  any  standards-based  IP-PBX  or  hosted  IP  telephony  system.  These
competitors include Polycom, Mediatrix and SNOM.  End-to-end IP telephony vendors sell IP phones that only work in their proprietary systems and include
IP telephony vendors such as Cisco, Avaya/Nortel, Alcatel-Lucent, Siemens and Asstra.

Many of our competitors have the ability to offer complete network solutions and vendor-sponsored financing programs to prospective customers.
Some of our competitors with broad product portfolios may also be able to offer lower prices on products that compete with ours because of their ability to
recoup a loss of margin through sales of other products or services. Additionally, voice, audio and other communications alternatives that compete with our
products are being continually introduced.

In the future, we may also develop and introduce other products with new or additional telecommunications capabilities or services. As a result, we
may  compete  directly  with  VoIP  companies  and  other  telecommunications  and  solution  infrastructure  providers,  some  of  which  may  be  our  customers.
Additional competitors may include companies that currently provide communication software products and services. The ability of some of our competitors to
bundle other enhanced services or complete solutions with VoIP products could give these competitors an advantage over us.

12

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Offering to sell system level products that compete with the products manufactured by our customers could negatively affect our business.

Our  product  offerings  range  from  media  gateway  building  blocks,  such  as  chips  and  boards,  to  media  gateways,  media  servers  and  session  border
control products (systems).  These products could compete with products offered by our customers. These customers could decide to decrease purchases from
us because of this competition. This could result in a material adverse effect on our results of operations.

Offering to sell directly to carriers or service providers may expose us to requirements for service which we may not be able to meet.

We also sell our products directly to telecommunications carriers, service providers or other end-users.  We have traditionally relied on third party
distributors and OEMs to test and/or sell our products and to inform us about the requirements of end-users. We have limited experience selling our products
directly  to  end-user  customers.  Telecommunications  carriers  and  other  service  providers  have  great  bargaining  power  in  negotiating  contracts.    Generally,
contracts with end-users tend to be more complex and impose more obligations on us than contracts with third party distributors. We may be unable to meet the
requirements of these contracts.  If we are unable to meet the conditions of a contract with an end-user customer, we may be subject to liquidated damages or
liabilities that could result in a material adverse effect on our results of operations.

Selling directly to end-users may adversely affect our relationship with our current third party distributors upon whom we will continue to rely for a
significant portion of our sales.  Loss of third party distributors and OEMs, or a decreased commitment by them to sell our products as a result of direct sales
by us, could adversely affect our sales and results of operations.

We rely on third-party subcontractors to assemble our products and therefore do not directly control manufacturing costs, product delivery schedules
or manufacturing quality.

Our  products  are  assembled  and  tested  by  third-party  subcontractors.  As  a  result  of  our  reliance  on  third-party  subcontractors,  we  cannot  directly
control product delivery schedules. We have in the past experienced delays in delivery schedules. Any problems that occur and persist in connection with the
delivery, quality or cost of the assembly and testing of our products could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of
operations.  This  reliance  could  also  lead  to  product  shortages  or  quality  assurance  problems,  which,  in  turn,  could  lead  to  an  increase  in  the  costs  of
manufacturing or assembling our products.

In addition, we have recently engaged three original design manufacturers, or ODMs, based in Asia to design and manufacture some of our products.
Any problems that occur and persist in connection with the delivery, quality, cost of the assembly or testing of our products, as well as the termination of our
commercial  relationship  with  an  ODM  or  the  discontinuance  of  the  manufacturing  of  the  respective  products  could  have  a  material  adverse  effect  on  our
business, financial condition and results of operations.

13

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
We may not be able to deliver our products to our customers, and substantial reengineering costs may be incurred if a small number of third-party
suppliers do not provide us with key components on a timely basis.

Texas Instruments Incorporated supplies all of the chips for our signal processor product line. Our signal processor line is used both as a product line
in  its  own  right  and  as  a  key  component  in  our  other  product  lines.  Motorola  manufactures  all  of  the  communications  processors  currently  used  on  our
communications boards.

We have not entered into any long-term supply agreements or alternate source agreements with our suppliers and, while we maintain an inventory of

critical components, our inventory of chips would likely not be sufficient in the event that we had to engage an alternate supplier for these components.

Texas Instruments is also one of our major competitors in providing signal processing solutions. An unexpected termination of the supply of the chips
provided by Texas Instruments or Motorola or disruption in their timely delivery would require us to make a large investment in capital and personnel to shift
to  using  signal  processors  manufactured  by  other  companies  and  may  cause  a  delay  in  introducing  replacement  products.  Customers  may  not  accept  an
alternative product design. Supporting old products or redesigning products may make it more difficult for us to support our products.

We utilize other sole source suppliers upon whom we depend without having long-term supply agreements.

Some  of  our  sole  source  suppliers  custom  produce  components  for  us  based  upon  our  specifications  and  designs  while  other  of  our  sole  source
suppliers are the only manufacturers of certain components required by our products. We have not entered into any long-term supply agreements or alternative
source  agreements  with  our  suppliers  and  while  we  maintain  an  inventory  of  components  from  single  source  providers,  our  inventory  would  likely  not  be
sufficient  in  the  event  that  we  had  to  engage  an  alternate  supplier  of  these  single  source  components.  In  the  event  of  any  interruption  in  the  supply  of
components from any of our sole source suppliers, we may have to expend significant time, effort and other resources in order to locate a suitable alternative
manufacturer and secure replacement components. If no replacement components are available, we may be forced to redesign certain of our products.  Any
such new design may not be accepted by our customers.  A prolonged disruption in supply may force us to redesign and retest our products. Any interruption in
supply  from  any  of  these  sources  or  an  unexpected  technical  failure  or  termination  of  the  manufacture  of  components  could  disrupt  production,  thereby
adversely affecting our ability to deliver products and to support products previously sold to our customers.

In addition, if demand for telecommunications equipment increases, we may face a shortage of components from our suppliers.  This could result in

longer lead times, increases in the price of components and a reduction in our margins, all of which could adversely affect the results of our operations.

14

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Our customers may require us to produce products or systems to hold in inventory in order to meet their “just in time”, or short lead time, delivery
requirements.    If  we  are  unable  to  sell  this  inventory  on  a  timely  basis,  we  could  incur  charges  for  excess  and  obsolete  inventory  which  would
adversely affect our results of operations.

Our  customers  expect  us  to  maintain  an  inventory  of  products  available  for  purchase  off  the  shelf  subsequent  to  the  initial  sales  cycle  for  these
products.  This may require us to incur the costs of manufacturing inventory without having a purchase order for the products.  The VoIP industry is subject to
rapid  technological  change  and  volatile  customer  demands,  which  result  in  a  short  product  commercial  life  before  a  product  becomes  obsolete.    If  we  are
unable to sell products that are produced to hold in inventory, we may incur write-offs as a result of slow moving items, technological obsolescence, excess
inventories,  discontinued  products  and  products  with  market  prices  lower  than  cost.  Write-offs  could  adversely  affect  our  operating  results  and  financial
condition. We wrote off inventory in a total amount of $973,000 in 2007, $2.4 million in 2008 and $3.4 million in 2009.

The right of our customers to return products and their right to exchange products may affect our ability to recognize revenues which could adversely
affect the results of our operations.

Some of our customers expect us to permit them to return some or all of the products they purchase from us. If we contractually agree to allow a
customer  to  return  products,  the  customer  may  be  entitled  to  a  refund  for  the  returned  products  or  to  receive  a  credit  for  the  purchase  of  replacement
products.    If  we  agree  to  this  type  of  contractual  obligations,  it  could  affect  our  ability  to  recognize  revenues.  In  addition,  if  we  are  not  able  to  resell  any
products that are returned and we would have to write off this inventory.  This could adversely affect our results of operations.

Our products generally have long sales cycles and implementation periods, which increase our costs in obtaining orders and reduce the predictability
of our revenues.

Our  products  are  technologically  complex  and  are  typically  intended  for  use  in  applications  that  may  be  critical  to  the  business  of  our  customers.
Prospective customers generally must make a significant commitment of resources to test and evaluate our products and to integrate them into larger systems.
As  a  result,  our  sales  process  is  often  subject  to  delays  associated  with  lengthy  approval  processes  that  typically  accompany  the  design  and  testing  of  new
communications equipment. The sales cycles of our products to new customers are approximately six to twelve months after a design win, depending on the
type of customer and complexity of the product. This time period may be further extended because of internal testing, field trials and requests for the addition
or customization of features. This delays the time until we realize revenue and results in significant investment of resources in attempting to make sales.

Long sales cycles also subject us to risks not usually encountered in a short sales span, including customers’ budgetary constraints, internal acceptance
reviews and cancellation. In addition, orders expected in one quarter could shift to another because of the timing of customers’ procurement decisions. The
time required to implement our products can vary significantly with the needs of our customers and generally exceeds several months; larger implementations
can take multiple calendar quarters. This complicates our planning processes and reduces the predictability of our revenues.

15

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Our proprietary technology is difficult to protect, and our products may infringe on the intellectual property rights of third parties. Our business may
suffer if we are unable to protect our intellectual property or if we are sued for infringing the intellectual property rights of third parties.

Our  success  and  ability  to  compete  depend  in  part  upon  protecting  our  proprietary  technology.  We  rely  on  a  combination  of  patent,  trade  secret,
copyright and trademark laws, nondisclosure and other contractual agreements and technical measures to protect our proprietary rights. These agreements and
measures may not be sufficient to protect our technology from third-party infringement, or to protect us from the claims of others.

Enforcement of intellectual property rights may be expensive and may divert attention of management and of research and development personnel
away from our business.  Intellectual property litigation could also call into question the ownership or scope of rights owned by us. We believe that at least one
of our patents may cover technology related to the ITU G.723.1 standard. Because of our involvement in the standard setting process, we may be required to
license certain of our patents on a reasonable and non-discriminatory basis to a current or future competitor, to the extent required to carry out the G.723.1
standard.  Additionally, our products may be manufactured, sold, or used in countries that provide less protection to intellectual property than that provided
under U.S. or Israeli laws or where we do not hold relevant intellectual property rights.

We believe that the frequency of third party intellectual claims is increasing, as patent holders, including entities that are not in our industry and that
purchase  patents  as  an  investment  or  to  monetize  such  rights  by  obtaining  royalties,  use  infringement  assertions  as  a  competitive  tactic  and  a  source  of
additional  revenue.    Any  intellectual  property  claims  against  us,  even  without  merit,  could  cost  us  a  significant  amount  of  money  to  defend  and  divert
management’s attention away from our business. We may not be able to secure a license for technology that is used in our products and we may face injunctive
proceedings that prevent distribution and sale of our products even prior to any dispute being concluded. These proceedings may also have a deterrent effect on
purchases  by  customers,  who  may  be  unsure  about  our  ability  to  continue  to  supply  their  requirements.  We  may  be  forced  to  repurchase  our  products  and
compensate customers that have purchased such infringing products. We may be forced to redesign the product so that it becomes non-infringing, which may
have an adverse impact on the results of our operations.

In addition, claims alleging that the development, use, or sale of our products infringes third parties’ intellectual property rights may be directed either
at  us  or  at  our  direct  or  indirect  customers.  We  may  be  required  to  indemnify  such  customers  against  claims  made  against  them.  We  may  be  required  to
indemnify them even if we believe that the claim of infringement is without merit.

16

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Multiple patent holders in our industry may result in increased licensing costs.

There are a number of companies besides us that hold patents for various aspects of the technology incorporated in our industry’s standards and our
products.  We  expect  that  patent  enforcement  will  be  given  high  priority  by  companies  seeking  to  gain  competitive  advantages  or  additional  revenues.  The
holders of patents from which we have not obtained licenses may take the position that we are required to obtain a license from them. We cannot be certain that
we would be able to negotiate a license agreement at an acceptable price or at all. Our results of operations could be adversely affected by the payment of any
additional licensing costs or if we are prevented from manufacturing or selling a product.

Changes  in  governmental  regulations  in  the  United  States  or  other  countries  could  slow  the  growth  of  the  VoIP  telephony  market  and  reduce  the
demand for our customers’ products, which, in turn, could reduce the demand for our products.

VoIP  and  other  services  are  not  currently  subject  to  all  of  the  same  regulations  that  apply  to  traditional  telephony.  Nevertheless,  it  is  possible  that
foreign or U.S. federal or state legislatures may seek to impose increased fees and administrative burdens on VoIP, data, and video providers.  The FCC has
already required VoIP service providers to meet various emergency service requirements relating to delivery of 911 calls, known as E911, and to accommodate
law  enforcement  interception  or  wiretapping  requirements,  such  as  the  Communications  Assistance  for  Law  Enforcement  Act,  or  CALEA.  In  addition,  the
FCC  may  seek  to  impose  other  traditional  telephony  requirements  such  as  disability  access  requirements,  consumer  protection  requirements,  number
assignment and portability requirements, and other obligations, including additional obligations regarding E911 and CALEA.

The  cost  of  complying  with  FCC  regulations  could  increase  the  cost  of  providing  Internet  phone  service  which  could  result  in  slower  growth  and

decreased profitability for this industry, which would adversely affect our business.

The enactment of any additional regulation or taxation of communications over the Internet in the United States or elsewhere in the world could have
a material adverse effect on our customers’ (and their customers’) businesses and could therefore adversely affect sales of our products. We do not know what
effect, if any, possible legislation or regulatory actions in the United States or elsewhere in the world may have on private telecommunication networks, the
provision of VoIP services and purchases of our products.

Use  of  encryption  technology  in  our  products  is  regulated  by  governmental  authorities  and  may  require  special  development,  export  or  import
licenses.    Delays  in  the  issuance  of  required  licenses,  or  the  inability  to  secure  these  licenses,  could  adversely  affect  our  revenues  and  results  of
operations.

Growth  in  the  demand  for  security  features  may  increase  the  use  of  encryption  technology  in  our  products.    The  use  of  encryption  technology  is
generally  regulated  by  governmental  authorities  and  may  require  specific  development,  export  or  import  licenses.  Encryption  standards  may  be  based  on
proprietary technologies.  We may be unable to incorporate encryption standards into our products in a manner that will insure interoperability.  We also may
be unable to secure licenses for proprietary technology on reasonable terms.  If we cannot meet encryption standards, or secure required licenses for proprietary
encryption technology, our revenues and results of operations could be adversely affected.

17

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
We  are  subject  to  regulations  that  require  us  to  use  components  based  on  environmentally  friendly  materials.  We  may  be  subject  to  various
regulations relating to management and disposal of waste with respect to electronic equipment. Compliance with these regulations may increase our
costs. Failure to comply with these regulations could materially adversely affect our results of operations.

We  are  subject  to  telecommunications  industry  regulations  requiring  the  use  of  environmentally-friendly  materials  in  telecommunications
equipment.  For example, pursuant to a European Community directive, telecom equipment suppliers were required to stop using specified materials that are
not “environmentally friendly” by July 1, 2006. In addition, telecom equipment suppliers that take advantage of an exemption with respect to the use of lead in
solders are required by this directive to eliminate the lead in solders from their products by the time set forth by the European Community regulations.  Some
of our customers may also require products that meet higher standards than those required by the directive, such as complete removal of additional harmful
substances  from  our  products.  We  will  be  dependent  on  our  suppliers  for  components  and  sub-system  modules,  such  as  semiconductors  and  purchased
assemblies  and  goods,  to  comply  with  these  requirements.   This  may  harm  our  ability  to  sell  our  products  in  regions  or  to  customers  that  may  adopt  such
directives.

Compliance with these directives, especially with respect to the requirement that products eliminate lead solders, requires us to undertake significant
expenses with respect to the re-design of our products.  In addition, we may be required to pay higher prices for components that comply with this directive.
We may not be able to pass these higher component costs on to our customers. We cannot at this point estimate the expense that will be required to redesign
our products in order to include “environmentally friendly” components. We cannot be sure that we will be able to timely comply with these regulations, that
we  will  be  able  to  comply  on  a  cost-effective  basis  or  that  a  sufficient  supply  of  compliant  components  will  be  available  to  us.  Compliance  with  these
regulations  could  increase  our  product  design  costs.    New  designs  may  also  require  qualification  testing  with  both  customers  and  government  certification
boards.  We cannot be certain of the reliability of any new designs that utilize non-lead components, in part, due to the lack of experience with the replacement
materials and assembly technologies. In addition, the incorporation of new components may adversely affect equipment reliability and durability.

Some of our operations use substances regulated under various federal, state, local and international laws governing the environment, including laws
governing the management and disposal of waste with respect to electronic equipment. We could incur substantial costs, including fines and civil or criminal
sanctions, if we were to violate or become liable under environmental laws or if our products become non-compliant with environmental laws. We also face
increasing complexity in our product design and procurement operations as we adjust to new and future requirements relating to the materials that compose our
products. The EU has enacted the Waste Electrical and Electronic Equipment Directive, which makes producers of electrical goods financially responsible for
specified collection, recycling, treatment and disposal of past and future covered products. Similar legislation has been or may be enacted in other jurisdictions,
including the United States, Canada, Mexico, China and Japan.

18

 
 
 
 
 
 
Our inability or failure to comply with these regulations could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations. In addition, manufacturers
of components that use lead solders may decide to stop manufacturing those components prior to the required compliance date. These actions by manufacturers
of components could result in a shortage of components that could adversely affect our business and results of operations.

A  significant  portion  of  our  revenues  is  generated  outside  of  the  United  States  and  Israel.  We  intend  to  continue  to  expand  our  operations
internationally and, as a result, our results of operations could suffer if we are unable to manage our international operations effectively.

We generated 37% of our revenues in 2007, 40% of our revenues in 2008 and 36% of our revenues in 2009 outside of the United States and Israel.
Part  of  our  strategy  is  to  expand  our  penetration  in  existing  foreign  markets  and  to  enter  new  foreign  markets.  Our  ability  to  penetrate  some  international
markets may be limited due to different technical standards, protocols or product requirements in different markets. Expansion of our international business
will  require  significant  management  attention  and  financial  resources.  Our  international  sales  and  operations  are  subject  to  numerous  risks  inherent  in
international business activities, including:

·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·

economic and political instability in foreign countries;
compliance with foreign laws and regulations;
different technical standards or product requirements;
staffing and managing foreign operations;
foreign currency fluctuations;
export control issues;
governmental controls;
import or currency control restrictions;
local taxation;
increased risk of collection; and
burdens that may be imposed by tariffs and other trade barriers.

If  we  are  unable  to  address  these  risks,  our  foreign  operations  may  be  unprofitable  or  the  value  of  our  investment  in  our  foreign  operations  may

decrease.

Currently,  our  international  sales  are  denominated  primarily  in  U.S.  dollars.  Therefore,  any  devaluation  in  the  local  currencies  of  our  customers

relative to the U.S. dollar could cause customers to decrease or cancel orders or default on payment.

19

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
The prices of our products may become less competitive due to foreign exchange fluctuations.

Although we have operations throughout the world, the majority of our revenues and our operating costs in 2009 were denominated in, or linked to, the U.S.
dollar. Accordingly, we consider the U.S. dollar to be our functional currency. However, a significant portion of our operating costs in 2009 were incurred in
New Israeli Shekels (NIS). During 2009 the NIS appreciated against the U.S. dollar, which resulted in an increase in the U.S. dollar cost of our operations in
Israel. As a result of this differential, from time to time we may experience increases in the costs of our operations outside the United States, as expressed in
U.S.  dollars.  If  there  is  a  significant  increase  in  our  expenses,  we  may  be  required  to  increase  the  prices  of  our  products  and  may  be  less  competitive.  We
cannot be sure that our international customers will continue to place orders denominated in U.S. dollars.

Our  sales  to  European  customers  denominated  in  Euros  are  increasing.    Sales  denominated  in  Euros  could  make  our  revenues  subject  to  fluctuation  in  the
Euro/U.S. dollar exchange rate. If the U.S. dollar appreciates against the Euro, we may be required to increase the prices of our products that are denominated
in Euros.

We may be unable to attract sales representatives who will market our products effectively.

A significant portion of our marketing and sales involves the aid of independent sales representatives that are not under our direct control. We cannot
be certain that our current independent sales representatives will continue to distribute our products or that, even if they continue to distribute our products,
they will do so successfully. These representatives are not subject to any minimum purchase requirements and can discontinue marketing our products at any
time.  In  addition,  these  representatives  often  market  products  of  our  competitors.  Accordingly,  we  must  compete  for  the  attention  and  sales  efforts  of  our
independent sales representatives.

Our products could contain defects, which would reduce sales of those products or result in claims against us.

We develop complex and evolving products. Despite testing by us and our customers, undetected errors or defects may be found in existing or new
products. The introduction of products with reliability, quality or compatibility problems could result in reduced revenues, additional costs, increased product
returns  and  difficulty  or  delays  in  collecting  accounts  receivable.  The  risk  is  higher  with  products  still  in  the  development  stage,  where  full  testing  or
certification is not yet completed. This could result in, among other things, a delay in recognition or loss of revenues, loss of market share or failure to achieve
market acceptance. We could also be subject to material claims by customers that are not covered by our insurance.

20

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Obtaining  certification  of  our  products  by  national  regulators  may  be  time-consuming  and  expensive.  We  may  be  unable  to  sell  our  products  in
markets in which we are unable to obtain certification.

Our customers may expect us to obtain certificates of compliance with safety and technical standards set by national regulators, especially standards
set  by  U.S.  or  European  regulators.  There  is  no  uniform  set  of  standards,  and  each  national  regulator  may  impose  and  change  its  own  standards.  National
regulators  may  also  prohibit  us  from  importing  products  that  do  not  conform  to  their  standards.  If  we  make  any  change  in  the  design  of  a  product,  we  are
usually required to obtain recertification of the product. The process of certification may be time-consuming and expensive and may affect the length of the
sales cycle for a product. If we are unable to obtain certification of a product in a market, we may be unable to sell the product in that market.

We depend on a limited number of key personnel who would be difficult to replace.

Because our products are complex and our market is evolving, the success of our business depends in large part upon the continuing contributions of
our management and key personnel. Specifically, we rely heavily on the services of Shabtai Adlersberg, our Chief Executive Officer, Chairman of our Board of
Directors and Interim Chief Financial Officer. If Shabtai Adlersberg is unable or unwilling to continue with us, our results of operations could be materially
and adversely affected.  We do not carry key person insurance for Mr. Adlersberg. We are currently searching for a new chief financial officer to replace our
former chief financial officer who left us in April 2010 to pursue another opportunity. Mr. Adlersberg will be acting as our Interim Chief Financial Officer until
a replacement is appointed.

The  success  of  our  business  also  depends  upon  our  continuing  ability  to  attract  and  retain  other  highly-qualified  management,  technical,  sales  and
marketing  personnel.  We  need  highly-qualified  technical  personnel  who  are  capable  of  developing  technologies  and  products  and  providing  the  technical
support required by our customers. We experience competitive pressure with respect to retaining and hiring employees in the high technology sector in Israel.
If we fail to hire and retain skilled employees, our business may be adversely affected.

If we do not manage our operations effectively, our results of operations could be adversely affected.

We have actively expanded our operations in the past and may continue to expand them in the future. This expansion has required, and may continue
to require, the application of managerial, operational and financial resources. We cannot be sure that we will continue to expand, or that we will be able to
expand  our  operations  successfully.  In  particular,  our  business  requires  us  to  focus  on  multiple  markets,  including  the  VoIP,  wireline,  cable  and  wireless
markets. In addition, we work simultaneously with a number of large OEMs and network equipment providers each of which may have different requirements
for  the  products  that  we  sell  to  them.  We  may  not  have  sufficient  personnel,  or  may  be  unable  to  devote  this  personnel  when  needed,  to  address  the
requirements of these markets and customers. If we are unable to manage our operations effectively, our revenues may not increase, our cost of operations may
rise and our results of operations may be adversely affected.

21

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
As we grow we may need new or enhanced systems, procedures or controls. The transition to such systems, procedures or controls, as well as any
delay in transitioning to new or enhanced systems, procedures or controls, may seriously harm our ability to accurately forecast sales demand, manage our
product inventory and record and report financial and management information on a timely and accurate basis.

Our gross profit percentage could be negatively impacted by amortization expenses in connection with acquisitions, increased manufacturing costs
and other factors.  This could adversely affect our results of operations.

Our gross profit percentage decreased in 2007, 2008 and 2009. The decrease in our gross profit percentage was primarily attributable to amortization
expenses related to the acquisitions of Nuera and Netrake beginning in the third quarter of 2006 and CTI Squared beginning in the second quarter of 2007, as
well  as  expenses  related  to  equity-based  compensation  resulting  from  the  adoption  of  ASC  718  beginning  in  2006.  During  the  fourth  quarter  of  2008,  we
recognized  non-cash  impairment  charges  of  $86.1  million  with  respect  to  goodwill,  intangible  assets  and  investment  in  an  affiliate.  As  a  result  of  these
impairment charges, non-cash amortization expense included in cost of revenues declined in 2009.

Our gross profit percentage has also been negatively affected in the past and could continue to be negatively affected by an increase in manufacturing costs, a
shift in our sales mix towards our less profitable products, increased customer demand for longer product warranties and increased cost pressures as a result of
increased  competition. Acquisitions  of  new  businesses  could  also  negatively  affect  our  gross  profit  percentage,  which  could  cause  an  adverse  effect  on  our
results of operations.

The growth in our product portfolio means that we have to service and support more products. This may result in an increase in our expenses and an
adverse effect on our results of operations.

The  size  of  our  product  portfolio  has  increased  and  continues  to  increase.   As  a  result,  we  are  required  to  provide  to  our  customers  sales  support.
Customers have requested that we provide a contractual commitment to support a product for a specified period of time. This period of time may exceed the
working life of the product or extend past the period of time that we may intend to manufacture or support a product. We are dependent on our suppliers for the
components (hardware and software) needed to provide support and may be unable to secure the components necessary to satisfy our service commitments. We
do not have long-term contracts with our suppliers, and they may not be obligated to provide us with products or services for any specified period of time.  We
may need to purchase an inventory of replacement components and parts in advance in order to try to provide for their availability when needed.  This could
result  in  increased  risk  of  write-offs  with  respect  to  our  replacement  component  inventory  to  the  extent  that  we  cannot  accurately  predict  our  future
requirements  under  our  customer  service  contracts.    If  any  of  our  component  suppliers  cease  production,  cease  operations  or  refuse  or  fail  to  make  timely
delivery of orders, we may not be able to meet our contractual commitments for product support.  We may be required to supply enhanced components or parts
as substitutes if the original versions are no longer available. Product support may be costly and any extra service revenues may not cover the hardware and
software costs associated with providing long-term support.

22

 
 
 
 
 
 
Terrorist  attacks,  or  the  threat  of  such  attacks,  may  negatively  impact  the  global  economy  which  may  materially  adversely  affect  our  business,
financial condition and results of operation and may cause our share price to decline.

The  financial,  political,  economic  and  other  uncertainties  following  terrorist  attacks  throughout  the  world  have  led  to  a  worsening  of  the  global
economy. As a result, many of our customers and potential customers have become much more cautious in setting their capital expenditure budgets, thereby
restricting  their  telecommunications  procurement.  Uncertainties  related  to  the  threat  of  terrorism  have  had  a  negative  effect  on  global  economy,  causing
businesses to continue slowing spending on telecommunications products and services and further lengthen already long sales cycles.  Any escalation of these
threats or similar future events may disrupt our operations or those of our customers, distributors and suppliers, which could adversely affect our business,
financial condition and results of operations.

We are subject to taxation in several countries.

Because we operate in several countries, mainly in the United States, Israel, United Kingdom and Singapore, we are subject to taxation in multiple
jurisdictions. We are required to report to and are subject to local tax authorities in the countries in which we operate. In addition, our income that is derived
from sales to customers in one country might also be subject to taxation in other countries.  We cannot be sure of the amount of tax we may become obligated
to pay in the countries in which we operate. The tax authorities in the countries in which we operate may not agree with our tax position. Our tax benefits from
carry forward losses and other tax planning benefits such as Israeli approved enterprise programs, may prove to be insufficient due to Israeli tax limitations, or
may prove to be insufficient to offset tax liabilities from foreign tax authorities. Foreign tax authorities may also use our gross profit or our revenues in each
territory  as  the  basis  for  determining  our  income  tax,  and  our  operating  expenses  might  not  be  considered  for  related  tax  calculations  adversely  affect  our
results of operations.

Risks Relating to Operations in Israel

Conditions in Israel affect our operations and may limit our ability to produce and sell our products.

We are incorporated under the laws of the State of Israel, and our principal executive offices and principal research and development  facilities are
located  in  the  State  of  Israel.  Political,  economic  and  military  conditions  in  Israel  directly  affect  our  operations.  There  has  been  an  increase  in  unrest  and
terrorist  activity  in  Israel,  which  has  continued  with  varying  levels  of  severity  for  many  years  through  the  current  period  of  time.  This  has  led  to  ongoing
hostilities between Israel, the Palestinian Authority, other groups in the West Bank and Gaza Strip, and the northern border of Lebanon. The future effect of this
violence  on  the  Israeli  economy  and  our  operations  is  unclear.  The  Israeli-Palestinian  conflict  may  also  lead  to  political  instability  between  Israel  and  its
neighboring  countries.  Ongoing  violence  between  Israel  and  the  Palestinians,  as  well  as  tension  between  Israel  and  the  neighboring  countries,  may  have  a
material adverse effect on our business, financial conditions and results of operations.

23

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
We  cannot  predict  the  effect  on  us  of  an  increase  in  these  hostilities  or  any  future  armed  conflict,  political  instability  or  violence  in  the  region.
Additionally, some of our officers and employees in Israel are obligated to perform annual military reserve duty and are subject to being called for additional
active duty under emergency circumstances, such as the military confrontation in the Gaza Strip at the end of 2008. Some of our employees live within conflict
area  territories  and  may  be  forced  to  stay  at  home  instead  of  reporting  to  work.  We  cannot  predict  the  full  impact  of  these  conditions  on  us  in  the  future,
particularly if emergency circumstances or an escalation in the political situation occur. If many of our employees are called for active duty, or forced to stay at
home, our operations in Israel and our business may be adversely affected.  Additionally, a number of countries continue to restrict or ban business with Israel
or Israeli companies, which may limit our ability to make sales in those countries.

We are adversely affected by the devaluation of the U.S. dollar against the New Israeli Shekel and could be adversely affected by the rate of inflation
in Israel.

We generate substantially all of our revenues in U.S. dollars and, in 2009, a significant portion of our expenses, primarily salaries, related personnel
expenses  and  the  leases  of  our  buildings  in  Israel,  were  incurred  in  NIS.    We  anticipate  that  a  significant  portion  of  our  expenses  will  continue  to  be
denominated in NIS.

Our NIS related costs, as expressed in U.S. dollars, are influenced by the exchange rate between the U.S. dollar and the NIS. During 2008 and 2009,
the NIS appreciated against the U.S. dollar, which resulted in a significant increase in the U.S. dollar cost of our operations in Israel. To the extent the U.S.
dollar weakens against the NIS, we could experience an increase in the cost of our operations, which are measured in U.S. dollars in our financial statements,
which could adversely affect our results of operations. In addition, in periods in which the U.S. dollar appreciates against the NIS, we bear the risk that the rate
of  inflation  in  Israel  will  exceed  the  rate  of  such  devaluation  of  the  NIS  in  relation  to  the  U.S.  dollar  or  that  the  timing  of  such  devaluations  were  to  lag
considerably behind inflation, which will increase our costs as expressed in U.S. dollars.

The  devaluation  of  the  U.S.  dollar  in  relation  to  the  NIS  has  and  may  continue  to  have  the  effect  of  increasing  the  cost  in  U.S.  dollars  of  these
expenses. Our U.S. dollar-measured results of operations were adversely affected in 2008 and 2009. This could happen again if the U.S. dollar were to devalue
against the NIS.

In order to manage the risks imposed by foreign currency exchange rate fluctuations, from time to time, we enter into currency forward contracts and
put  and  call  options  to  hedge  some  of  our  foreign  currency  exposure.    We  can  provide  no  assurance  that  our  hedging  arrangements  will  be  effective.    In
addition, if we wish to maintain the U.S. dollar-denominated value of our products in non-U.S. markets, devaluation in the local currencies of our customers
relative to the U.S. dollar may cause our customers to cancel or decrease orders or default on payment.

24

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Because exchange rates between the NIS and the U.S. dollar fluctuate continuously, exchange rate fluctuations have an impact on our profitability and
period-to-period comparisons of our results of operations. In 2009, the value of the U.S. dollar decreased in relation to the NIS by 0.7%, and the inflation rate
in Israel was 3.9% and, as a result, adversely affected our results of operations in 2009. If this trend continues, it will continue to adversely affect our result of
operations.

The Israeli government programs in which we currently participate, and the tax benefits we currently receive require us to meet several conditions
and may be terminated or reduced in the future, which would increase our costs.

We benefit from certain government programs and tax benefits, particularly as a result of exemptions and reductions resulting from the “approved
enterprise” status of our existing production facilities and programs in Israel. In the past, the designation required advance approval from the Investment Center
of  the  Israel  Ministry  of  Industry,  Trade  and  Labor  (the  Investment  Center).  To  be  eligible  for  these  programs  and  tax  benefits,  we  must  continue  to  meet
conditions relating principally to adherence to the approved programs and to periodic reporting obligations. We believe that we are currently in compliance
with these requirements. However, if we fail to meet these conditions, we will be subject to corporate tax at the rate then in effect under Israeli law for such tax
year.

In April 2005, an amendment to the law came into effect (the “Amendment”) which significantly changed the provisions of the law. The Amendment
limited the scope of enterprises which may be approved by the Investment Center by setting criteria for the approval of a facility as a Privileged Enterprise,
such as provisions generally requiring that at least 25% of the Privileged Enterprise’s income be derived from export. Additionally, the Amendment enacted
major  changes  in  the  manner  in  which  tax  benefits  are  awarded  under  the  law  so  that  companies  no  longer  require  Investment  Center  approval  in  order  to
qualify for tax benefits.

The law provides that terms and benefits included in any certificate of approval granted prior to December 31, 2004 remain subject to the provisions
of  the  law  as  they  were  on  the  date  of  such  approval.  Therefore,  our  existing  “Approved  Enterprises”  are  generally  not  subject  to  the  provisions  of  the
Amendment.  As  a  result  of  the  Amendment,  tax-exempt  income  generated  under  the  provisions  of  the  law  as  amended,  will  subject  us  to  taxes  upon
distribution or liquidation and we may be required to record a deferred tax liability with respect to such tax-exempt income. The Company has elected the year
2008 as the year of election for “Privileged Enterprise” under the Amendment.

25

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
The  government  grants  we  have  received  for  research  and  development  expenditures  limit  our  ability  to  manufacture  products  and  transfer
technologies outside of Israel and require us to satisfy specified conditions.  If we fail to satisfy these conditions, we may be required to refund grants
previously received together with interest and penalties.

In connection with research and development grants we received from the OCS, we must pay royalties to the OCS on the revenue derived from the
sale of products, technologies and services developed with the grants from the OCS. The terms of the OCS grants and the law pursuant to which grants are
made restrict our ability to manufacture products or transfer technologies developed outside of Israel if OCS grants funded the development of the products or
technology.  An  amendment  to  the  relevant  law  facilitates  the  transfer  of  technology  or  know-how  developed  with  the  funding  of  the  OCS  to  third  parties
outside of Israel, but any future transfer would still require the approval of the OCS, which may not be granted, and is likely to involve a material payment to
the OCS. This restriction may limit our ability to enter into agreements for those products or technologies without OCS approval. We cannot be certain that any
approval of the OCS will be obtained on terms that are acceptable to us, or at all.

In order to meet specified conditions in connection with the grants and programs of the OCS, we have made representations to the Government of
Israel concerning our Israeli operations.    If we fail to meet the conditions related to the grants, including the maintenance of a material presence in Israel, or if
there is any material deviation from the representations made by us to the Israeli government, we could be required to refund the grants previously received
(together  with  an  adjustment  based  on  the  Israeli  consumer  price  index  and  an  interest  factor)  and  would  likely  be  ineligible  to  receive  OCS  grants  in  the
future. Any inability to receive these grants would result in an increase in our research and development expenses.

In 2009, we recognized a royalty-bearing grant of $2,417,000 from the Government of Israel, through the Office of the Chief Scientist, or the OCS,
for the financing of a portion of our research and development expenditures in Israel. The OCS budget has been subject to reductions, which may affect the
availability of funds for these prospective grants and other grants in the future. As a result, we cannot be certain that we will continue to receive grants at the
same rate, or at all. In addition, the terms of any future OCS grants may be less favorable than our past grant.

It  may  be  difficult  to  enforce  a  U.S.  judgment  against  us,  our  officers  and  directors,  assert  U.S.  securities  law  claims  in  Israel  or  serve  process  on
substantially all of our officers and directors.

We  are  incorporated  in  Israel.  Substantially  all  of  our  executive  officers  and  directors  are  nonresidents  of  the  United  States,  and  a  majority  of  our
assets and the assets of these persons are located outside the United States. Therefore, it may be difficult to enforce a judgment obtained in the United States
against us or any such persons or to effect service of process upon these persons in the United States. Israeli courts may refuse to hear a claim based on a
violation of U.S. securities laws because Israel is not the most appropriate forum to bring such a claim. In addition, even if an Israeli court agrees to hear a
claim, it may determine that Israeli law and not U.S. law is applicable to the claim. If U.S. law is found to be applicable, the content of applicable U.S. law
must be proved as a fact which can be a time-consuming and costly process. Certain matters of procedure will also be governed by Israeli law. There is little
binding  case  law  in  Israel  addressing  these  matters. Additionally,  there  is  doubt  as  to  the  enforceability  of  civil  liabilities  under  the  Securities  Act  and  the
Securities Exchange Act in original actions instituted in Israel.

26

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Israeli law may delay, prevent or make difficult a merger with or an acquisition of us, which could prevent a change of control and therefore depress
the price of our shares.

Provisions  of  Israeli  law  may  delay,  prevent  or  make  undesirable  a  merger  or  an  acquisition  of  all  or  a  significant  portion  of  our  shares  or  assets.
Israeli  corporate  law  regulates  acquisitions  of  shares  through  tender  offers  and  mergers,  requires  special  approvals  for  transactions  involving  significant
shareholders and regulates other matters that may be relevant to these types of transactions. These provisions of Israeli law could have the effect of delaying or
preventing a change in control and may make it more difficult for a third party to acquire us, even if doing so would be beneficial to our shareholders. These
provisions may limit the price that investors may be willing to pay in the future for our ordinary shares. In addition, our articles of association contain certain
provisions that may make it more difficult to acquire us, such as a staggered board, the ability of our board of directors to issue preferred stock and limitations
on business combinations with interested shareholders. Furthermore, Israel tax considerations may make potential transactions undesirable to us or to some of
our shareholders.

Risks Relating to the Ownership of our Ordinary Shares

The price of our ordinary shares may fluctuate significantly.

The market price for our ordinary shares, as well as the prices of shares of other technology companies, has been volatile. Between January 1, 2008
and June 15, 2010, our share price has fluctuated from a high of $5.26 to a low of $0.92. The following factors may cause significant fluctuations in the market
price of our ordinary shares:

fluctuations in our quarterly revenues and earnings or those of our competitors;
shortfalls in our operating results compared to levels forecast by securities analysts;
announcements concerning us, our competitors or telephone companies;
announcements of technological innovations;
the introduction of new products;
changes in product price policies involving us or our competitors;

·
·
·
·
·
·
· market conditions in the industry;
·
·
·

integration of acquired businesses, technologies or joint ventures with our products and operations;
the conditions of the securities markets, particularly in the technology and Israeli sectors; and
political, economic and other developments in the State of Israel and worldwide.

In  addition,  stock  prices  of  many  technology  companies  fluctuate  significantly  for  reasons  that  may  be  unrelated  or  disproportionate  to  operating

results. The factors discussed above may depress or cause volatility of our share price, regardless of our actual operating results.

27

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Our quarterly results of operations have fluctuated in the past and we expect these fluctuations to continue. Fluctuations in our results of operations
may disappoint investors and result in a decline in our share price.

We  have  experienced  and  expect  to  continue  to  experience  significant  fluctuations  in  our  quarterly  results  of  operations.  In  some  periods,  our
operating results may be below public expectations or below revenue levels and operating results reached in prior quarters or in the corresponding quarters of
the previous year. If this occurs, the market price of our ordinary shares could decline.

The following factors have affected our quarterly results of operations in the past and are likely to affect our quarterly results of operations in the

future:

·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·

size, timing and pricing of orders, including order deferrals and delayed shipments;
launching of new product generations;
length of approval processes or market testing;
technological changes in the telecommunications industry;
competitive pricing pressures;
the timing and approval of government research and development grants;
accuracy of telecommunication company, distributor and original equipment manufacturer forecasts of their customers’ demands;
changes in our operating expenses;
disruption in our sources of supply; and
general economic conditions.

Therefore, the results of any past periods may not be relied upon as an indication of our future performance.

Our actual financial results might vary from our publicly disclosed financial forecasts.

From time to time, we publicly disclose financial forecasts. Our forecasts reflect numerous assumptions concerning our expected performance, as well
as other factors which are beyond our control and which might not turn out to be correct. As a result, variations from our forecasts could be material. Our
financial results are subject to numerous risks and uncertainties, including those identified throughout this “Risk Factors” section and elsewhere in this Annual
Report. If our actual financial results are worse than our financial forecasts, the price of our ordinary shares may decline.

It  is  our  policy  that  we  will  not  provide  quarterly  forecasts  of  the  results  of  our  operations.  This  policy  could  affect  the  willingness  of  analysts  to
provide research with respect to our ordinary shares which could affect the trading market for our ordinary shares.

It is our policy that we will not provide quarterly forecasts of the results of our operations. This could result in the reduction of research analysts who
cover  our  ordinary  shares.  Any  reduction  in  research  coverage  could  affect  the  willingness  of  investors,  particularly  institutional  investors,  to  invest  in  our
shares which could affect the trading market for our ordinary shares and the price at which our ordinary shares are traded.

28

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
As  a  foreign  private  issuer  whose  shares  are  listed  on  the  Nasdaq  Global  Select  Market,  we  follow  certain  home  country  corporate  governance
practices instead of certain Nasdaq requirements.

As a foreign private issuer whose shares are listed on the Nasdaq Global Select Market, we are permitted to follow certain home country corporate governance
practices instead of certain requirements of the Nasdaq Marketplace Rules.

We  do  not  comply  with  the  Nasdaq  requirement  that  we  obtain  shareholder  approval  for  certain  dilutive  events,  such  as  for  the  establishment  or
amendment of certain equity based compensation plans.  Instead, we follow Israeli law and practice which permits the establishment or amendment of certain
equity  based  compensation  plans  to  be  approved  by  our  board  of  directors  without  the  need  for  a  shareholder  vote,  unless  such  arrangements  are  for  the
compensation of directors, in which case they also require audit committee and shareholder approval.

As a foreign private issuer listed on the Nasdaq Global Select Market, we  may also elect in the future to follow home country practice with regard to, among
other things, executive officer compensation, director nomination, composition of the board of directors and quorum at shareholders’ meetings, as well as not
obtain shareholder approval for certain dilutive events.

Accordingly, our shareholders may not be afforded the same protection as provided under Nasdaq’s corporate governance rules.

Our ordinary shares are listed for trading in more than one market and this may result in price variations.

Our ordinary shares are listed for trading on the Nasdaq Global Select Market, or Nasdaq, and on The Tel-Aviv Stock Exchange, or TASE. Trading in
our  ordinary  shares  on  these  markets  is  made  in  different  currencies  (U.S.  dollars  on  Nasdaq  and  New  Israeli  Shekels  on  TASE),  and  at  different  times
(resulting from different time zones, different trading days and different public holidays in the United States and Israel). Actual trading volume on the TASE is
generally  lower  than  trading  volume  on  Nasdaq,  and  as  such  could  be  subject  to  higher  volatility.  The  trading  prices  of  our  ordinary  shares  on  these  two
markets  often  differ  resulting  from  the  factors  described  above,  as  well  as  differences  in  exchange  rates.  Any  decrease  in  the  trading  price  of  our  ordinary
shares on one of these markets could cause a decrease in the trading price of our ordinary shares on the other market.

We do not anticipate declaring any cash dividends on our ordinary shares.

We have never declared or paid cash dividends on our ordinary shares and do not plan to pay any cash dividends in the near future. Our current policy

is to retain all funds and earnings for use in the operation and expansion of our business.

29

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
U.S. shareholders face certain income tax risks in connection with their acquisition, ownership and disposition of our ordinary shares. In any tax year,
we could be deemed a passive foreign investment company, which could result in adverse U.S. federal income tax consequences for U.S. shareholders.

Based on the composition of our gross income, the composition and value of our gross assets and the amounts of our liabilities during 2004, 2005,
2006, 2007, 2008 and 2009, we do not believe that we were a passive foreign investment company, or PFIC, for U.S. federal income tax purposes during any of
such tax years. It is likely, however, that we would be deemed to have been a PFIC in 2001, 2002 and 2003. There can be no assurance that we will not be
deemed  a  PFIC  for  any  future  tax  year  in  which,  for  example,  the  value  of  our  assets,  as  measured  by  the  public  market  valuation  of  our  ordinary  shares,
declines  in  relation  to  the  value  of  our  passive  assets  (generally,  cash,  cash  equivalents  and  marketable  securities).  If  we  are  a  PFIC  for  any  tax  year,  U.S.
shareholders who own our ordinary shares during such year may be subject to increased U.S. federal income tax liabilities and reporting requirements for such
year and succeeding years, even if we are no longer a PFIC in such succeeding years. Under new legislation recently enacted by the U.S., a U.S. holder of our
ordinary shares will be required to file an information return containing certain information required by the U.S. Internal Revenue Service for each year in
which we are treated as a PFIC.

We urge U.S. holders of our ordinary shares to carefully review Item 10E. – “Taxation – United States Tax Considerations – United States Federal
Income Taxes” in this Annual Report and to consult their own tax advisors with respect to the U.S. federal income tax risks related to owning and disposing of
our ordinary shares and the consequences of PFIC status.

We are subject to ongoing costs and risks associated with complying with extensive corporate governance and disclosure requirements.

As a foreign private issuer subject to U.S. federal securities laws, we spend a significant amount of management time and resources to comply with
laws, regulations and standards relating to corporate governance and public disclosure, including the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, SEC regulations and Nasdaq
rules.  Section  404  of  the  Sarbanes-Oxley  Act  requires  management’s  annual  review  and  evaluation  of  our  internal  control  over  financial  reporting  and
attestations of the effectiveness of these controls by our management and by our independent registered public accounting firm.  There is no guarantee that
these efforts will result in management assurance or an attestation by our independent registered public accounting firm that our internal control over financial
reporting is adequate in future periods. In connection with our compliance with Section 404 and the other applicable provisions of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act, our
management and other personnel devote a substantial amount of time, and may need to hire additional accounting and financial staff, to assure that we comply
with these requirements. The additional management attention and costs relating to compliance with the Sarbanes-Oxley Act and other corporate governance
requirements could materially and adversely affect our financial results.

30

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
ITEM 4         INFORMATION ON THE COMPANY

A.           HISTORY AND DEVELOPMENT OF THE COMPANY

AudioCodes  Ltd.  was  incorporated  in  1992  under  the  laws  of  the  State  of  Israel.  Our  principal  executive  offices  are  located  at  1  Hayarden  Street,
Airport  City,  Lod,  70151  Israel.  Our  telephone  number  is  972-3-976-4000.  Our  agent  in  the  United  States  is  AudioCodes  Inc.,.  27  World’s  Fair  Drive,
Somerset, New Jersey 08873.

Major Developments since January 1, 2009

Since January 1, 2009, we have increased our focus on sales to the enterprise segment of the market, which includes medium and large sized

businesses. As part of this increased focus, we have supplemented and increased our North American sales team who sell to this segment of the market. We
have also added products for the residential market segment, which include integrated access device, or IAD, that provides integrated functionality for VoIP,
data and access to the Internet.

Through  December  31,  2009,  we  had  invested  an  aggregate  of  $8.4  million  in  Natural  Speech  Communication  Ltd.  (“NSC”),  a  privately-held
development  stage  company  engaged  in  speech  recognition.  This  investment  was  intended  to  assist  that  company  in  achieving  substantive  technological
milestones. As of December 1, 2008, we began consolidating the financial results of NSC into AudioCodes’ financial results. As of December 31, 2009, we
owned 59.74% of the outstanding share capital of NSC and 53.74% of the share capital of NSC on a fully diluted basis.

In  January  2010,  we  entered  into  an  agreement  to  acquire  all  of  the  outstanding  equity  of  NSC  that  we  did  not  currently  own.  The  closing  of  the
transaction  occurred  in  May  2010.  Pursuant  to  the  agreement,  we  will  pay  an  aggregate  of  approximately  $1.2  million  for  the  remaining  interest  in  NSC,
payable in three annual installments commencing on the first anniversary of the closing. We will also be required to pay an additional purchase price of up to
$500,000 in 2013 if certain aggregate revenue milestones are met for 2010, 2011 and 2012

In July 2005, we invested $707,000 in MailVision Ltd., a privately-held company engaged in developing and marketing enhanced services platforms
for wireless service providers. Through December 31, 2009, we provided loans including accrued interest in the aggregate amount of $642,000 to MailVision.
The loans bear interest at the rate of 4%-9% per annum and may be converted into shares of MailVision. As of December 31, 2009, we owned 20.21% of the
outstanding share capital of this company.

Principal Capital Expenditures

We have made and expect to continue to make capital expenditures in connection with expansion of our production capacity. The table below sets forth our
principal capital expenditures incurred for the periods indicated (amounts in thousands).

31

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Computers and peripheral equipment

  $

2,023    $

2,466    $

1,195 

2007

2008

2009

Office furniture and equipment

Leasehold improvements

Total

B.           BUSINESS OVERVIEW

Introduction

436     

170     

166     

526     

76 

- 

  $

2,629    $

3,158    $

1,271 

We design, develop and sell products for voice and data over packet networks. In broad terms, voice over packet, or VoP, networks consist of key
network  elements  such  as  software  switches,  application  servers,  Internet  protocol,  or  IP  phones  and  media  gateways.  Our  products  primarily  provide  the
media gateway element in the network, as well as voice over Internet protocol, or VoIP, end-points such as IP Phones and VoIP mobile clients. Multi-service
business gateways integrate media gateway functionality with data routing and network access. The media gateways connect legacy and IP networks. They
essentially receive the legacy format of communication and convert it to an IP communication and vice versa. Typically, media gateways utilize compression
algorithms  to  compress  the  amount  of  information  and  reduce  the  amount  of  bandwidth  required  to  convey  the  information  (for  example,  a  voice
communication).  With  the  industry  migration  to  an  end-to-end  IP  network,  gateways  now  also  connect  between  different  VoIP  networks,  providing  session
border controller, or SBC, functionality.

Voice over IP gateway equipment can be generally segmented into three classes: carrier class gateways for use in central office facilities, enterprise
gateways for use by corporations and in small offices, and residential gateways for use in homes. In addition to the gateway element, which connects legacy
voice equipment to an IP network, there is growth in native VoIP end user equipment, primarily including IP phones, soft phones and VoIP mobile clients,
running on desktop PCs or portable devices such as PDAs, cellular phones, smart phones, and other devices that have wireless IP connectivity (e.g., WiFi,
UMTS and CDMA.).

The need to re-route voice and fax traffic from the traditional circuit-switched networks onto the new packet networks has led to the development of
interface  equipment  between  the  two  networks,  generally  referred  to  as  media  gateways.  The  processing  of  voice  and  fax  signals  in  gateway  and  access
equipment is done according to industry-wide standards. These standards are needed to ensure that all traditional telephony traffic is seamlessly switched and
routed over the packet network and vice versa. The industry migration into a network that is utilizing IP end-to-end has also added a new functionality into the
media  gateways  that  now  also  translates  between  different  implementations  of  VoIP.  This  includes  protocol  translation  as  well  as  security  services  and  is
provided by stand-alone SBCs as well as SBC functionality integrated into the gateway.

32

 
 
 
 
   
   
 
 
   
     
     
 
 
   
      
      
  
   
 
   
      
      
  
   
 
   
      
      
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
Packet  networks  differ  fundamentally  from  circuit-switched  networks  in  that  the  packet  network’s  resources  and  infrastructure  can  be  shared
simultaneously by several users and bandwidth can be flexibly allocated. Packet-based communications systems format the information to be transmitted, such
as  e-mail,  voice,  fax  and  data,  into  a  series  of  smaller  digital  packages  of  information  called  “packets.”  Each  of  these  packets  is  then  transmitted  over  the
network and is reassembled as a complete communication at the receiving end. The various packet networks employ different network protocols for different
applications, priority schemes and addressing formats to ensure reliable communication.

Packet  networks  offer  a  number  of  advantages  over  circuit-switched  networks.  Rather  than  requiring  a  dedicated  circuit  for  each  individual  call,
packet networks commingle packets of voice, fax and data from several communications sources on a single physical link. This provides superior utilization of
network resources, especially in dealing with information sources with bursts of information followed by periods of silence. This superior utilization means
that more traffic can be carried over the same amount of network resources.

The integration of voice and data communications makes possible an enrichment of services and an entire range of new, value-added applications,
such as unified messaging and voice-enabled web sites. In addition, voice traffic over packet networks is usually compressed to provide a further reduction in
the  use  of  or  demand  for  bandwidth.  Another  recent  trend  in  the  VoIP  environment,  referred  to  as  High  Definition  VoIP,  or  HD  VoIP,  now  enables  the
improvement of voice quality. The adoption of both VoIP technology and broadband networks has enabled the development and deployment of high-quality
voice  coding  algorithms  that  make  communication  more  efficient,  effective  and  natural.  HD  VoIP  allows  carriers  to  differentiate  their  services  with  an
improved audio experience, with the goal of creating customer loyalty and affinity. It also enables enterprises to provide better, clearer voice services for their
employees, which we believe makes them more productive and makes it easier to work across different cultures and accents.

As customers integrate more services into their IP network, they tend to use integrated products that provide all the services they need in one box.
Multi service business gateways, or MSBGs, combine all the capabilities of media gateways with the support of native data routing and switching. The MSBGs
enables enterprise customers to connect their branch office networks into the corporate headquarters, and service providers to connect their customers into their
network core. Some MSBGs also include integrated hosts, which can run off-the-shelf unified communications applications. This combination enables system
integrators to provide a fully integrated solution for small/medium businesses, or SMB/E, and enterprise branches, including the voice and data infrastructure
and the application in one device.

Moving into the VoIP world, enterprise and service provider have started to use a new breed of phone devices that inherently produce packets instead
of legacy voice, called IP phones. The IP phone is an advanced telephone that connect into the network using VoIP over Ethernet instead of using analog TDM
interfaces. Most enterprise telephony systems sold today are using IP phones, as well as service providers managed services such as IP Centrex.

In addition to wireline IP telephony, mobile networks have started to use VoIP as well. Mobile VoIP clients, running on smart-phones, enable cost
effective mobile roaming and allow Internet telephony service providers to enter the mobile space. These include mobile VoIP clients for leading smartphones
operating systems, such as iPhone OS, Symbian, Windows mobile and Android.

33

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
We typically categorize our products into two main business lines: network and technology. Sales of network products accounted for approximately
67%  of  our  revenues  in  2008  and  approximately  72%  of  our  revenues  in  2009  and  sales  of  technology  products  accounted  for  approximately  33%  of  our
revenues in 2008 and approximately 28% of our revenues in 2009.

Network  products  consist  of  customer  premises  equipment,  or  CPE,  gateways  for  the  enterprise  and  service  provider  (or  carrier)  markets  and  of
carrier-grade-oriented  low-  and  mid-density  media  gateways  for  service  providers.  Complementing  our  media  gateways  as  network  products  are  our  multi-
service business gateways, IP phones, media server, and value added application products.

Technology  products  are  enabling  in  nature  and  consist  of  our  chips  and  boards  business  products.  These  are  sold  primarily  to  original  equipment
manufacturers,  or  OEMs,  through  distribution  channels.  Our  chips  and  boards  serve  as  building  blocks  that  our  customers  incorporate  in  their  products.  In
contrast, our networking products are used by our customers as part of a broader technological solution and are a box level product that interacts directly with
other third party products.

Our Products

We offer two categories of products, networking products and technology products.

Networking Products

Networking  products  are  deployed  in  enterprise  unified  communications  networks,  service  providers  residential  and  access  networks,  trunking
applications in carrier networks, and fixed-mobile convergence applications.

·

·

·

Our media gateways enable voice, data and fax to be transmitted over Internet and other protocols, and interface with third party equipment
to facilitate enhanced voice and data services.

Our multi-service  business  gateways  integrate  multiple  data,  telephony  and  security  services  into  a  single  device.  Building  on  our  media
gateway  CPE  line,  we  have  added  the  support  of  new  functions  such  as  a  LAN  switch,  a  data  router,  a  firewall  and  a  session  border
controller,  providing  service  providers  with  an  integrated  demarcation  point  and  the  enterprise  with  an  all-in-one  solution  for  its
communications  needs.  Our  IP  phones  include  a  family  of  high  definition  IP  phones,  suitable  for  integration  with  third  party  IP-PBX
platforms for the enterprise IP telephony market, as well as into IP-Centrex service provider solutions.

Our  mobile  VoIP  clients  include  a  family  of  soft  clients  for  leading  smartphones  operating  systems  and  a  client  management  system,
providing mobile roaming solutions for mobile and voice over IP and voice over broadband service providers.

34

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
· Media servers enable conferencing, multi-language announcement functionality, and other applications for voice over packet networks.

·

Unified communication applications offer solutions that enable the integration of voice, data, fax and messaging.

Technology Products

Our technology products are enabling products that are part of our own or our customers’ products.

·

·

Our signal processor chips process and compress voice, data and fax and enable connectivity  between  traditional  telephone  networks  and
packet networks.

Our communication  boards  and  modules  for  communication  system  products  are  integrated  into  third-party  communications  systems  and
deployed on both access networks and enterprise networks.

Industry Background

Market Trends

The networking and telecommunications industries have experienced rapid change over the last few years. The primary factors driving this change

include the following:

·

·

New technologies.  The increase of speed and the proliferation of broadband access technologies alongside related technologies, such as new
high  definition  voice  compression  algorithms,  quality  of  service  mechanisms  and  security  and  encryption  algorithms  and  protocols, have
enabled  delivery  of  voice  over  packet  to  residential  and  enterprise  customers  with  more  reliability,  higher  quality  and  greater  security.
Examples  of  these  broadband  access  technologies  include:  third  generation cellular, WiMax, WiFi, data over cable, digital subscriber line
technologies  and  fiber  networks  (FTTx).  Packet  technologies  enable  delivery  of  real  time  and  non-real  time  services  by  different  service
providers that do not necessarily own the access network or the part of the network through which the subscriber accesses the network. This
allows for the growth of alternative or virtual service providers that do not own an access network.

Competition by alternative service providers with incumbent and traditional service providers. Competition by alternative service providers
is causing incumbents to deploy advanced broadband access technologies and increase their competitiveness by offering bundled services to
their  subscribers,  such  as  voice,  video  and  data,  and  online  gaming.  In  addition,  the  emergence  of  wide  band  vocoders  that  use  a  higher
sampling rate than used in legacy time domain multiplexing, or TDM, networks allows service providers to offer higher quality voice and
music over their newly established IP network.

35

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
·

·

·

·

New services enabled by broadband access. Changes in the regulatory environment affecting service providers and the availability of new
technologies or standards allow  service  providers  to  compete  with  one  another  in  the  provision  of  additional  services  over  and  above  the
traditional  telephony  service  of  voice,  fax  and  dial-up  modem  internet  connectivity.  New  services  that  could  be  offered  include  internet
connectivity over broadband access or access to rich multimedia content such as music, video and games.

Increasing need for peering between VoIP networks.  Service providers and enterprises are increasingly building out VoIP networks.  As a
result,  there  is  an  increasing  need  to  connect  between  two  VoIP  networks.    In  order  to  interconnect  between  two  VoIP  networks,  service
providers and enterprises need session border controllers to provide connectivity and security.

Increased use of open source codes for enterprise telephony. Similar to the trend experienced with respect to Linux in the IT world, open
source has started to gain momentum in the VoIP space as well. Open source based IP telephony solutions, led by Asterisk, a well known IP-
PBX implementation, is starting to penetrate the enterprise space as a low cost alternative to the proprietary IP-PBX solutions from the large
vendors. The adoption of open source IP telephony solutions is gaining momentum mainly in the SMB/SME space, as well as with service
providers and developers that add their own code on top of the open source basic code to enable special services and features.

Unified Communications in the Enterprise. With the move to VoIP and the network integration between voice and data based on Ethernet and
IP,  enterprises  can  easily  move  into  a  unified  communications  network.  Unified  communications  networks  integrate  all  means  of
communications  into  a  single  experience,  providing  on  line  (voice,  data,  instant  messaging)  and  off  line  (voice  mail,  email  and  fax)
integration into the same device. The devices can be PCs, desktop phones or mobile smartphones and PDAs.

· Mobility.  Mobile  smartphones  have  become  popular  among  business  professionals  as  well  as  the  general  public.  Smartphones,  running
advanced  operating  systems  such  as  Symbian,  Windows  Mobile,  Android  and  iPhone  OS,  include  high  CPU  power,  large  storage  space,
integrated  WiFi  and  3G  data,  as  well  as  the  ability  to  run  high  performance  multimedia  applications.  Mobile  VoIP  is  one  of  these
applications, allowing cost-effective roaming for a service provider’s customers and enterprise mobility services.

The Challenges

Despite the inherent advantages and the economic attractiveness of packet voice networking, the transmission of packet voice and fax poses a variety
of  technological  challenges.  These  challenges  relate  to  quality  of  service,  reliability  of  equipment,  functionality  and  features,  and  ability  to  provide  a  good
return on investment.

36

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
·

·

·

·

·

Quality of Service. The most critical issues leading to poor quality of service in the transmission of voice and fax over packet networks are
packet loss, packet delay and packet delay jitter. For real time signals like voice, the slightest delay in the arrival of a packet may render that
packet  unusable  and,  in  a  voice  transmission,  the  delayed  packet  is  considered  a  lost  packet.  Delay  is  usually  caused  by  traffic  hitting
congestion or a bottleneck in the network. The ability to address delay is compounded by the varying arrival times of packets, called packet-
jitter, which results from the different routes taken by different packets. This “jitter” can be eliminated by holding the faster arriving packets
until the slower arriving packets can catch up, but this introduces further delay. These idiosyncrasies of packet networks do not noticeably
detract from the quality of data transmission since data delivery is relatively insensitive to time delay. However, even the slightest delay or
packet loss in voice and fax transmission can have severe ramifications such as voice quality degradation or, in the case of a fax transmission,
call interruption. Therefore, the need to compensate for lost or delayed packets without degradation of voice and fax quality is a critical issue.

Gateway Reliability. In order for a packet network to be efficient for voice or fax transmission, the VoIP gateway equipment that is installed
in  core  networks  must  be  able  to  deliver  a  higher  level  of  performance  than  existing  switching  equipment  located  at  central  offices.  The
telecommunications providers’ central offices  contain  circuit-switching  equipment  that  typically  handles  tens  of  thousands  of  lines  and  is
built to meet severe performance criteria relating to reliability, capacity, size, power consumption and cost.

Connectivity  and  Security.  In  contrast  with  legacy  circuit  switched  voice  and  video  communications,  IP-based  communications  are  more
susceptible to attacks, interceptions and fraud by unauthorized entities. In addition, the complexity and relative immaturity of IP networks
and protocols pose significant quality of service and connectivity challenges when sessions cross between separate IP networks.

Functionality.  In  order  to  effectively  replace  legacy  circuit-switching  equipment,  packet  network  equipment  must  be  able  to  deliver
equivalent and improved functionality and features for the service providers and network users.

Return on Investment. With the reduction in profitability of service providers there is an even greater need for them to achieve better returns
on  investment  from  capital  expenditures  on  new  equipment.  Given  the  evolving  nature  of  packet  technologies  and  capabilities,  there  is
greater pressure to provide cost-effective technological solutions.

In order to maximize the benefits of using packet networks for the transmission of voice, data and fax, products must be able to address and solve
these inherent problems and challenges. These products must also be standards-based to support interoperability among different equipment manufacturers and
to allow operation over various networks.

37

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
AudioCodes’ Solution

Using our voice compression algorithms, industry standards, advanced digital signal processing techniques, VoIP control protocol expertise, and voice
communications system design expertise, our products address quality of service problems, security problems and reliability problems facing the VoIP industry.
As  a  result,  we  enable  our  customers  to  build  packet  networks  that  provide  communication  quality  comparable  to  traditional  telephone  networks.  Using
HDVoIP, voice quality can even surpass the quality of traditional TDM networks. We work closely with our customers in order to tailor our products to meet
their specific needs, assist them in integrating our products within their networks and help them bring their systems into operation on a timely basis. We also
work with our customers in deploying their systems in various network environments.

Utilizing  our  investment  in  developing  standards-based  VoIP  protocol  support  for  our  products,  customers  can  integrate  our  products  with  a  large
number  of  industry  leading  IP-PBXs  and  carrier  soft  switches.  Our  interoperability  teams  test  our  products  against  a  variety  of  other  products  for
interoperability, focusing on the leading standard VoIP protocols: Session Initiation Protocol, or SIP, and MEGACO/H.248.

We believe that the following strengths have enabled us to develop our products and provide services to our customers:

·

·

Leadership in voice compression technology.  We are a leader in voice compression  technology.  Voice  compression  exploits  redundancies
within a voice signal to reduce the bit rate of data required to digitally represent  the  voice  signal  while  still  maintaining  acceptable  voice
quality. Our key development personnel have significant experience in developing voice compression technology. We were involved in the
development  of  the  ITU  G.723.1  voice  coding  standard  that  was  adopted  by  the  VoIP  Forum  and  the  International  Telecommunications
Union  as  the  recommended  standard  for  use  in  voice  over  IP  gateways.  We  implement  industry  voice  compression  standards  and  work
directly with our customers to  design  state-of-the-art  proprietary  voice  compression  algorithms  that  satisfy specific network requirements.
We believe that our significant knowledge of the basic technology permits us to optimize its key elements and positions us to address further
technological  advances  in  the  industry.  We  also  believe  that  our  technological  expertise  has  resulted  in  us  being  sought  out  by  leading
equipment manufacturers to work with them in designing their systems and provision of solutions to their customers.

Digital  signal  processing  design  expertise.    Our  extensive  experience  and  expertise  in  designing  advanced  digital  signal  processing
algorithms enables us to implement them efficiently in real time systems. Digital signal algorithms are computerized methods used to extract
information  out  of  signals.  In  designing  our  signal  processors,  we  use  minimal  digital  signal  processing  memory  and  processing  power
resources. This allows us to develop higher density solutions than our competitors. Our expertise is comprehensive and extends to all of the
functions required to perform voice compression, fax and modem transmission over packet networks and telephone signaling processing.

38

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
·

·

Compressed voice communications systems design expertise.  We have the expertise to design and develop the various building blocks and
the  products  required  for  complete  voice  over  packet  systems.  In  building  these  systems,  we  develop  hardware  architectures,  voice
packetization  software  and  signaling  software,  and  integrate  them  with  our  signal  processors  to  develop  a  complete,  high  performance
compressed  voice  communications  system.  We  assist  our  customers  in  integrating  our  signal  processors  into  their  hardware  and  software
systems  to  ensure  high  voice  quality,  high  completion  rate  of  fax  and  data  transmissions  and  telephone  signaling  processing  accuracy.
Further, we are able to customize our off-the-shelf products to meet our customers’ specific needs, thereby providing them with a complete,
integrated solution.

Real time embedded software design and implementation expertise.  We have the expertise  to  design  and  develop  voice  and  data  network
elements  using  embedded  real  time  software  to  achieve  more  competitive  pricing.  The  development  and  integration  of  VoIP  signaling
protocols, routing protocols, management and provisioning into a more cost-effective solution uses our expertise and investment in research
and  development  resources.  We  believe  that  the  benefits  we  can  deliver  are  better  price  performance,  smaller  footprint,  reduced  power
consumption and more attractive products.

· Media gateway protocols design expertise. Our extensive experience in developing media gateway standard protocols, keeping ourselves up
to date with new request for comments, or RFCs, and adjusting our features according to customers requirements and interoperability testing
allows us to provide our customers with a single gateway that can interface with most of the leading solution providers in the VoIP market.

·

Close  technology  relationships  with  market  leaders.  Our  continuing  effort  of  testing  and  certifying  our  systems  against  other  vendors’
complimentary solutions, positions us as a provider of VoIP products that can interoperate with most of the world’s leading VoIP products. It
also helps to create for us an extensive feature list that can be used by different customers for their own networks and solutions.

We believe that our products possess the following advantages:

·

Voice  over  Packet  signal  processors.  Our  multi-channel  signal  processors  enable  our  customers  and  us  to  create  products  that  meet  the
reliability, capacity, size, power consumption and cost requirements needed for building high capacity VoIP products.

39

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
· Multiple  and  comprehensive  product  lines.  We  address  both  the  standards-based  open  telecommunications  architecture  market  and  the
proprietary system market. We can do this because we enable our customers to use multiple applications in different market segments. For
example, our VoIP communications boards target the open telecommunications architecture market, while our signal processors, modules and
voice  packetization  software  target  the  proprietary  system  market.  Our  analog  and  digital  media  gateways  and  multi-service  business
gateways target residential, hosted,  access,  trunking  and  enterprise  applications  and  our  digital  media  gateways  target  wireless,  wire  line,
cable  and  fixed-mobile  convergence  networks.  Our  IP  phones  and  VoIP  mobile  clients  target  the  enterprise  and  service  provider  hosted
solutions markets.

·

·

·

·

Extensive feature set. Our products incorporate an extensive set of signal processing functions and features (such as coders, fax processing
and  echo  cancellation),  functionalities  (such  as  session  initiation  protocol,  or  SIP,  H.248  or  Megaco,    H.323,  and  media  gateway  control
protocol,  or  MGCP)  and  implement  a  complete  system.  We  offer  the  ability  to  manage  multiple  channels  of  communications  working
independently of each other, with each channel capable of performing all of the functions required for voice compression, fax and modem
transmission,  telephone  signaling  processing  and  other  functions.  These  functions  include  voice,  fax  or  data  detection,  echo  cancellation,
telephone tone signal detection, generation and other telephony signaling processing. Our gateway products, media server and multi-service
business gateways also offer wireless/mobile features to enable fixed mobile convergence.

Cost-effective solutions. We are able to address different market segments and applications with the same hardware platforms thus providing
our customers with efficient and cost-effective solutions.

Open architecture. Our networking products utilize industry standard control protocols that enable them to interoperate with  other vendors
and easily integrate into enterprise IP telephony systems as well as carrier networks. Our voice over packet communications boards target the
open  architecture  gateway  market  segment,  which  enables  our  customers  to  use  hardware  and  software  products  widely  available  for
standards-based open telecommunications platforms. We believe that this provides our customers the benefits of scalability, upgradeability
and enhanced functionality without the need to replace their systems for evolving applications.

Various  entry  level  products.  Our  wide  product  range  (chips  to  media  gateways,  multi-service  business  gateway,  IP  phones  and  media
servers)  provides  our  customers  with  a  range  of  entry  level  products.  We  believe  that  these  building  blocks  enable  our  customers  to
significantly shorten their time to market by adding their value added solution.

40

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
·

VoIPerfect™ architecture.  Our  VoIPerfect  architecture  serves  as  the  underlying  technology  platform  common  to  all  of  our  products  since
1998.  VoIPerfectTM  is  regularly  updated  and  upgraded  with  features  and  functionalities  required  to  comply  with  evolving  standards  and
protocols. VoIPerfectTM architecture  comprises  VoIP  digital  signal  processing,  or  DSP,  software  and  media  streaming  embedded  software,
integrated  public  telephone  switched  network,  or  PTSN,  signaling  protocols  and  VoIP  standard  control  protocols,  provisioning  and
management  engines.  Additional  features  enable  carrier-grade  quality  and  high  availability.  VoIPerfectTM  architecture  components  are
available in AudioCodes’ products at various levels  of  integration,  from  the  chip  level,  through  blades,  to  high-availability  and  non-high-
availability analog and digital gateway platforms.

Business Strategy

AudioCodes'  vision  is  to  become  a  leading  strategic  supplier  of  VoIP  and  converged  VoIP  and  data  solutions  for  service  providers  and  enterprises

worldwide. The following are key elements of our strategy:

· Maintain and extend technological leadership.  We intend to capitalize on our expertise in voice compression technology and voice signaling
protocols  and  proficiency  in  designing  voice  communications  systems.  We  continually  upgrade  our  product  lines  with  additional
functionalities, interfaces and densities. We have invested heavily and are committed to continued investment in developing technologies that
are  key  to  providing  high  performance  voice,  data  and  fax  transmission  over  packet  networks  and  to  be  at  the  forefront  of  technological
evolution in our industry.

·

·

Strengthen and expand strategic relationships with key partners and customers.  We sell our products to leading enterprise channels, regional
system  integrators,  global  equipment  manufacturers  and  value-added  resellers,  or  VARs,  in  the  telecommunications  and  networking
industries and establish and maintain long-term working relationships with them. We work closely with our customers to engineer products
and subsystems that meet each customer’s particular needs. The long development cycles usually required to build equipment incorporating
our products  frequently  results  in  close  working  relationships  with  our  customers.  By  focusing  on  leading  equipment  manufacturers  with
large  volume  potential,  we  believe  that  we  reach  a  substantial  segment  of  our  potential  customer  base  while  minimizing  the  cost  and
complexity of our marketing efforts.

Expand and enhance the development of highly-integrated products. We plan to continue designing, developing and introducing new product
lines  and  product  features  that  address  the  increasingly  sophisticated  needs  of  our  customers.  We  believe  that  our  knowledge  of  core
technologies  and  system  design  expertise  enable  us  to  offer  better  solutions  that  are  more  complete  and  contain  more  features  than
competitive alternatives. We believe  that  the  best  opportunities  for  our  growth  and  profitability  will  come  from  offering  a  broad  range  of
highly-integrated network product lines and product features, the integration of data services into our VoIP products, and the expansion into
the unified communications applications market.

41

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
·

·

·

Build upon existing technologies to penetrate new markets. The technology we developed originally for the OEM market has served us in
building products that now sell into the service provider and enterprise markets. The same products and technology can also be used to create
vertical-specific products and solutions. Two vertical markets that we focus on are the military and government  markets  which  have  been
adopting service-provider scale VoIP solutions.

Develop a network of strategic partners. We sell our products through or in cooperation with customers that can offer or certify our products
as part of a full-service solution to their customers. We expect to further develop our strategic partner relationships with solution providers,
system integrators and other service providers in order to increase our customer base.

Acquire complementary businesses and technologies.  We may pursue the acquisition of complementary businesses and technologies or the
establishment  of  joint  ventures  to  broaden  our  product  offerings,  enhance  the  features  and  functionality  of  our  systems,  increase  our
penetration  in  targeted  markets  and  expand  our  marketing  and  distribution  capabilities.  As  part  of  this  strategy,  we  acquired  the  UAS
business  from  Nortel  in  April  2003  and  Ai-Logix  (now  part  of  AudioCodes  Inc.),  in  May  2004.  We  also  acquired  Nuera  (now  part  of
AudioCodes  Inc.)  in  July  2006,  Netrake  (now  part  of  AudioCodes  Inc.)  in  August  2006,  CTI  Squared  in  April  2007  and  Natural  Speech
Communication in 2010.

Products

Our products facilitate the transmission of voice, data and fax over packet networks. we have incorporated our algorithms, technologies and systems

design expertise in both our networking and technology product lines.

Networking products

This line of products includes products that are network level products. Our networking products include:

·
·

analog media gateways for toll bypass, residential gateways, hosted, access and enterprise applications;
digital  media  gateways  with  various  capacities  for  wireless,  wireline,  cable,  enterprise,  fixed  mobile  convergence,  and  unified
communications;

· multi-service business gateways for integrated voice, data and security access for service providers connecting enterprise customers to their

network and for the enterprise branch office;
IP phones for enterprise and managed services service providers;

·
· mobile VoIP access solutions;
· media servers  for  enhanced  voice  and  video  services  and  functionalities  such  as  conferencing,  video  sharing  and  messaging  (IPmedia™

Media Servers); and
value-added applications for unified communications.

·

42

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
In addition, we continue to offer customers our professional services, which usually involve customization and development projects for customers.

Technology products

This line of products serves as a building block for network level products. Our technology products include:

voice over packet processors;
VoIP communication boards;

·
·
· media processing boards for enhanced services and functionalities; and
·

voice and data logging hardware integration board products.

Our products are designed to build on our core technologies and competencies extending them both vertically (chips inserted into boards, boards inserted into
digital media gateways) and horizontally into different applications for different market segments, such as enterprise, call centers, wireline, cable and wireless.

Our Product Families – Networking Products

Analog Media Gateways for Toll Bypass, Service Provider Access and Enterprise Applications

MediaPackTM, our analog and basic rate interface, or BRI, media gateways for toll bypass, service provider access and enterprise applications, are
designed  to  empower  the  next-generation  network  by  providing  cost-effective,  cutting-edge  technology  solutions  that  deliver  voice  and  fax  services  to  the
corporate market, small businesses and home offices. Our analog media gateways for access and enterprise applications provide media streaming functionality
while being either controlled by a centralized call agent or used in box VoIP control protocols (SIP, H.323, and MGCP). Convergence of data, voice and fax is
achieved by a combination of the media gateway with any IP access technology, eliminating the cost of multiple access circuits. This product family utilizes
our experience and digital signal processing, or DSP, technology for echo cancellation, voice compression, silence suppression and comfort noise generation.
Part of this line is composed of our analog residential gateways whose primary target market is the large volume residential service providers, or SP, market.

The MediaPackTM family represents a feature rich product for streaming voice quality with a powerful analog interface supporting all major control

protocols, such as H323, SIP and MGCP, and is also capable of supporting unified communication and FMC applications.

The Mediant™ Family of Products-Digital and Mixed Media Access Media Gateways and Multi-Service Business Gateways for Service Provider Access and
Enterprise Applications (MediantTM 600, 1000, 2000 and Mediant 1000TM MSBG) and Digital Media Gateways and Various Capacities for Wireless, Wireline
and Cable (Mediant™ 3000, 5000, 8000)

43

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
MediantTM is our family of access gateways. We have Mediant™ products for service provider access enterprise networks. We also provide converged media
gateways  for  wireline,  cable,  wireless  (GSM  and  CDMA),  fixed-mobile-convergence  and  large  enterprise  networks.  The  MediantTM  product  family  offers
scalability  and  functionality,  providing  a  full  suite  of  standards  compliant  control  protocols  and  public  switched  telephone  network,  or  PSTN,  signaling
interfaces for a variety of applications in most IP-PBX and softswitch controlled environments, as well as for a variety of large enterprise, wireline, cable and
wireless media gateway applications in most softswitch controlled environments. This product family is compatible with popular wireline, cable and wireless
voice coders and protocols, including code-division multiple access, or CDMA, global system for mobile communications, or GSM, CDMA2000 and universal
mobile  telecommunications  service,  or  UMTS.  It  builds  on  our  TrunkPack®  architecture,  which  is  installed  in  millions  of  lines  worldwide.  It  is  also
interoperable with most of the world’s leading vendors.

The  MediantTM  family  provides  carriers  with  a  comprehensive  line  of  different  sized  gateways.  Small  or  medium-sized  gateways  enable  cost-effective
solutions for enterprise or small points of presence, as well as entry into fast growing new and emerging markets. The large gateways scale to central office
capacities  and  are  designed  to  meet  carriers’  operational  requirements.  The  Mediant™  family  of  media  gateways  is  capable  of  supporting  unified
communication and fixed mobile convergence applications which may be of increased interest to enterprises and service providers. The Mediant™ gateway
family shares our VoIP perfect architecture, designed to provide mature, field-proven solutions.

The Mediant™ family of products consists of a number of models that offer different capacity, that is the number of concurrent calls that the gateway can
handle. The capacity of our Mediant products range from approximately 30 concurrent calls to 8,000 concurrent calls for the wireless and wireline markets.

Our Mediant™ 1000 has two different models. One model is a modular media gateway. The other model includes multi-service business gateways, or
MSBGs,  which  are  networking  devices  that  combine  multiple  multiservice  functions  such  as  a  media  gateway,  session  border  controller,  data  router  and
firewall, LAN switch, WAN access, and  stand alone survivability, or SAS. The MSBG concept is designed to address the needs of service providers and cable
operators that offer IP-Centrex and SIP trunking services and of distributed enterprises.

We offer the Mediant 1000 MSBG, which is an all-in-one multi-service access solution designed to provide converged voice and data services for
business customers at wire speed, while maintaining service level agreement, or SLA, parameters for superior voice quality. The Mediant 1000 MSBG is based
on  AudioCodes’  VoIPerfect  best-of-breed  media  gateway  technology,  combined  with  enterprise  class  session  border  controller,  data  and  voice  security
elements, data routing, LAN switching and WAN access.

The session border controller, or SBC, technology integrated into the Mediant 1000 MSBG, offers secure VoIP and multimedia traversal of firewall,
or FW, and network address translation, or NAT, systems, as well as denial of service, or DoS, attack prevention at both the signaling and media layers. NAT
and  FW  traversal  are  necessary  to  allow  VoIP  and  multimedia  session  to  pass  from  the  Service  Provider  (“SP”)  network  to  the  residential  or  enterprise
networks. DoS attack prevention protects the SP network from attacks that load the network until it crashes. It also provides comprehensive Quality of Service,
or QoS, mechanisms and protocol mediation (translation between two variants of same VoIP protocol to enable two VoIP systems to communicate with each
other).

44

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
The Mediant 1000 MSBG can also include a general purpose CPU and hard disk, allowing to host any third-party off-the-shelf application. Positioned

as MSBG PLUS, this solution enables system integrators and software vendors to use the MSBG platform for integrated unified communications solutions.

For  the  cable  market,  the  MediantTM  gateway  family  complies  with  packet  telephony  standards  and  is  designed  for  either  hybrid  or  all  IP  cable
network  architecture.  The  Mediant  gateway  enables  deployment  of  advanced  packet-based  cable  telephony  at  multiple  service  operators  own  pace,  without
costly hardware changes. The MediantTM gateway can be initially deployed as a V5.2 IP access terminal and then easily migrated by software upgrade to a
cable telephony media gateway with external call management provided by a softswitch and an SS7 interface to the PSTN.

IPmediaTM Servers for Enhanced Services and Functionalities

IPmediaTM  platforms  are  designed  to  answer  the  growing  market  demand  for  enhanced  voice  services  over  packet  networks,  particularly  network-
based  applications  like  unified  communications,  call  recording,  and  conferencing  by  carriers  and  application  service  providers.  IPmediaTM  enables  our
customers  to  develop  and  market  applications  such  as  unified  communications,  interactive  voice  response,  call-centers,  conferencing  and  voice-activated
personal assistants.

350HD Series of High Definition IP Phones

AudioCodes 300 Series of HD VoIP-enabled IP phones offers a new dimension of voice call quality and clarity for the Enterprise and Service Provider
markets.  This  product  line  enables  us  to  provide  an  end-to-end  solution  which  relies  heavily  on  the  technological  infrastructure  and  proven  track  record  in
providing state-of-the art high quality VoIP products for Enterprise, Wireline, Wireless and Cable applications.

The 300 Series of IP phones meet the demand for High Definition VoIP solutions in end-user phones and terminals, providing high voice fidelity, advanced
security and features and enhanced user interface. The 300 Series of IP phones is widely interoperable with numerous IP-PBXs, softswitches and IP-Centrex
solutions.

VoIP Mobile Access Solution (VMAS)

The VMAS™ is a mobile VoIP solution from AudioCodes comprised of a Client Management System (CMS) and a variety of Mobile Soft Clients for
leading  Mobile  Operating  Systems  and  Smartphones.  VMAS  is  currently  available  for  leading  smartphones  such  as  iPhone™/iPod  touch®,  Nokia®,
Samsung®™, HTC™ and others.

45

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
CTI2 Value Added Services Applications (InTouch)

The InTouch platform is an enhanced value added services, or VAS, platform for service providers, such as cable, class 5, class 4, fixed-line, mobile,
multiservice virtual network operator, or MVNO, and operators. InTouch provides a suite of next generation VAS. InTouch is an IP-based, email-centric and
telco-grade platform conforming to ultimate service providers’ requirements for high-availability, reliability, scalability, and security. InTouch is designed to
smoothly scale from a very small system to a system with millions of subscribers based on the same software and architecture, while enabling a rich suite of
applications at all sizes. InTouch’s open architecture is based on industry-standard protocols, facilitating interoperability and integration with best of breed,
third-party applications. InTouch acts as a mediator between InTouch services and a large selection of clients and devices enabling service providers to offer
attractive packages.

Element Management System

Our element management system, or EMS, is an advanced solution for centralized, standards-based management of our VoP gateways, covering all

areas vital to the efficient operations, administration, management and provisioning of our MediantTM and MediaPackTM VoP gateways.

Our EMS offers network equipment providers and system integrators fast setup of medium and large VoP networks with the advantage of a single
centralized management system that configures, provisions and monitors all of AudioCodes gateways deployed, either as customer premises equipment, access
or core network platforms.

Our Product Families – Technology Products

Voice Over Packet Processors

Our signal processor chips compress and decompress voice, data and fax communications. This enables these communications to be sent from circuit-
switched telephone networks to packet networks. Our chips are digital signal processors on which we have embedded our algorithms. These signal processor
chips are the basic building blocks used by our customers and us to enable their products to transmit voice, fax and data over packet networks. These chips may
be incorporated into our communications boards, media gateway modules and analog media gateways for access and enterprise applications or they may be
purchased separately and incorporated into other boards or customer products.

TrunkPackTM VoIP Communication Boards

Our  communications  boards  are  designed  to  operate  in  gateways  connecting  the  circuit-switched  telephone  network  to  packet  networks  based  on
Internet protocols. Our boards comply with VoIP industry standards and allow for interoperability with other gateways. Our boards support standards-based
open  telecommunications  architecture  systems  and  combine  our  signal  processor  chips  with  communications  software,  signaling  software  and  proprietary
hardware  architecture  to  provide  a  cost  efficient  interoperable  solution  for  high  capacity  gateways.  We  believe  that  using  open  architecture  permits  our
customers to bring their systems to market quickly and to integrate our products more easily within their systems.

46

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
IPmediaTM Boards for Enhanced Services and Functionalities

The IPmediaTM product family is designed to allow OEMs and application partners to provide sophisticated content and services that create revenue
streams and customer loyalty through the ability to provide additional services. The IPmediaTM boards provides voice and fax processing capabilities to enable,
together with our partners, an architecture for development and deployment of enhanced services.

Voice and Data Logging Hardware Integration Board Products

The SmartWORKSTM family of products is our voice and data logging hardware integration board product line. SmartWORKSTM boards for the call

recording and voice voice/data logging industry are compatible with a multitude of private branch exchange, or PBX, telephone system integrations.

Core Technologies

We believe that one of our key competitive advantages is our broad base of core technologies ranging from advanced voice compression algorithms to
complex architecture system design. We have developed and continue to build on a number of key technology areas. We have named our cross platform core
technology VoIPerfect™. It essentially allows us to leverage the same feature set and interoperability with other products across our product lines.

Narrowband and Wideband (HDVoIP) Voice Compression Algorithms

Voice  compression  techniques  are  essential  for  the  transmission  of  voice  over  packet  networks.  Voice  compression  exploits  redundancies  within  a
voice signal to reduce the bit rate required to digitally represent the voice signal, from 64 kilobits per second, or kbps, down to low bit rates ranging from 5.3
kbps  to  8  kbps,  while  still  maintaining  acceptable  voice  quality.  A  bit  is  a  unit  of  data.  Different  voice  compression  algorithms,  or  coders,  make  certain
tradeoffs between voice quality, bit rate, delay and complexity to satisfy various network requirements. Use of voice activity detection techniques and silence
removal techniques further reduce the transmission rate by detecting the silence periods embedded in the voice flow and discarding the information packets
which do not contribute to voice intelligibility.

We are one of the innovators in developing low bit rate voice compression technologies. Our patented MP-MLQTM coder was adopted in 1995 by the
ITU as the basis for the G.723.1 voice coding standard for audio/visual applications over circuit-switched telephone networks. By adhering to this standard,
system manufacturers guarantee the interoperability of their equipment with the equipment of other vendors.

We also provide wideband compression techniques that provide high definition VoIP quality, which expands the sampled frequency range from the
traditional narrowband frequency range of 3.3Khz to over 7Khz, providing better voice quality and intelligibility, and a better user expertise. This technology is
expanding and is expected to become a de-facto standard for future VoIP communications.

47

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Advanced Digital Signal Processing Algorithms

To  provide  a  complete  voice  over  packet  communications  solution,  we  have  developed  a  library  of  digital  signal  processing  functions  designed  to
complement  voice  compression  coders  with  additional  functionality,  including:  echo  cancellation;  voice  activity  detection;  facsimile  and  data  modem
processing; and telephony signaling processing. Our extensive experience and expertise in designing advanced digital signal processing solutions allows us to
implement algorithms using minimal processing memory and power resources.

Our algorithms include:

Echo cancellation. Low bit rate voice compression techniques introduce considerable delay, necessitating the use of echo cancellation algorithms. The
key performance criterion of an echo canceller is its ability to deal with large echo reflections, long echo delays, fast changing echo characteristics, diverse
telecommunications  equipment  and  network  effects.  Our  technology  achieves  low  residual  echo  and  fast  response  time  to  render  echo  effects  virtually
unnoticeable.

Fax transmission. There are two widely used techniques for real time transmission of fax over networks based on Internet protocols: fax relay and fax
spoofing.  Fax  relay  takes  place  when  a  fax  is  sent  from  a  fax  machine  through  a  gateway  over  networks  based  on  Internet  protocols  in  real  time  to  a  fax
machine at the other end of the network. At the gateway, the analog fax signals are demodulated back into digital data, converted into packets, routed over the
packet network and reassembled at the receiving end. Fax relay is used when the round trip network delay is small (typically below one second). When the
round trip network delay increases, one of the fax machines may time out while waiting for a response from the other fax machine to arrive.

Data modem technology. We have developed data modem technologies that facilitate data relay over packet networks. Our data modem relay software

algorithms support all existing data modem standards up to a bit rate of 14.4 kbps.

Telephony  signaling  processing.  Various  telephony  signaling  standards  and  protocols  are  employed  to  route  calls  over  the  traditional  telephone
network, some of which use “in-band” methods, which means that the signaling tones are sent over the telephone line just like the voice signal. As a result, in-
band signaling tones may have to undergo the compression process just like the voice signal. Most low bit-rate voice coders, however, are optimized for speech
signals  and  exhibit  poor  tone  transfer  performance.  To  overcome  this,  our  processors  are  equipped  with  tone  detection  and  tone  generation  algorithms.  To
provide  seamless  transparency  between  the  traditional  telephone  network  and  packet  networks  for  signaling,  we  employ  various  digital  signal  processing
techniques for efficient tone processing.

48

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Voice Communications Software

To transmit the compressed voice and fax over packet networks, voice packetization processes are required to construct and deconstruct each packet
of  data  for  transmission.  The  processing  involves  breaking  up  information  into  packets  and  adding  address  and  control  fields  information  according  to  the
specifications of the appropriate packet network protocol. In addition, the software provides the interface with the signal processors and addresses packet delay
and packet loss issues.

Media Processing

Our media processing products provide the enabling technology and platforms for developing enhanced voice service applications for legacy and next
generation networks. We have developed media processing technologies such as message recording/playback, announcements, voice coding and mixing and
call  progress  tone  detection  that  enable  our  customers  to  develop  and  offer  advanced  revenue  generating  services  such  as  conferencing,  network
announcements, voice mail and interactive voice response.

Our media processing technology is integrated into our enabling technology platforms like Voice over Packet processors and VoIP blades, as well as
into our network platforms like the Mediant media gateways and the IPMedia media servers. The same technology is also integrated into our multi-service
business gateways, enabling the use of these platforms to run third party VoIP software, offloading media processing from the host CPU.

Addressing Multiple Networks and Standards Concurrently

Convergence of wireline and wireless networks is becoming a key driver for deployment of voice over packet networks, enabling operators to use

common equipment for both networks, thus lowering capital expenditures and operating expenses, while offering enriched services.

Our voice over packet products provide a cost-effective solution for these convergence needs, complying with the requirements of broadband Wireline
operators using xDSL technologies, Cable operators, mobile operators, FTTx operators, Internet telephony service providers, or ITSPs, and virtual network
Operators (VNOs). This includes support for relevant vocoders (wireline and wireless concurrently), interfaces and protocols.

Our  products  are  also  positioned  to  support  the  requirement  of  all  types  of  enterprise  customers.  From  SOHO,  SMB  all  the  way  up  to  large

enterprises, our products can provide integrated VoIP services and service provider access to enterprises in multiple vertical markets.

Hardware Architectures for Dense Multi-Trunk Voice over Packet Systems

Our voice over packet product offerings include high density, multi-trunk voice over packet systems for standards-based open telecommunications
platforms in access equipment. Multi-trunk processing is centered around a design encompassing two key processing elements, signal processors performing
voice,  fax  and  data  processing  and  a  communications  processor.  Overall  system  performance,  reliability,  capacity,  size,  cost  and  power  consumption  are
optimized,  based  on  our  hardware  architecture,  which  supports  high  throughput  rates  for  multi-trunk  processing.  On-board  efficient  network  and  system
interfaces relieve the system controller from extensive real time data transfer and processing of data streams.

49

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Carrier Grade System Expertise

To provide state of the art carrier grade media gateways, we have developed a wide expertise in a number of fields essential to such a product line. We
have developed or integrated the various components required to implement a full digital media gateway solution that behaves as a unified entity to the external
world. This required a major investment in adapting standard cPCI and MicroTCA (AMC) platforms to our needs. Such adaptation included optimizing power
supply  and  cooling  requirements,  adding  centralized  shelf  controllers,  fabric  switches  and  alarm  cards  to  the  chassis.  Another  aspect  of  the  expertise  we
developed relates to high availability software and hardware design. High availability is a required feature in any carrier grade media gateway platform. We
have also developed a sophisticated EMS to complete our offering. Our EMS enables the user to provision and monitor a number of media gateways from a
centralized location.

Customers

Our customers consist of service providers and enterprises, primarily via channels (such as distributors), OEMs, network equipment providers and
systems  integrators.  Historically,  we  have  derived  the  majority  of  our  revenues  from  sales  to  a  small  number  of  customers.  The  identities  of  our  principal
customers  have  changed  and  we  expect  that  they  will  continue  to  change,  from  year  to  year. We  expect  that  a  small  number  of  customers  will  continue  to
account for a large percentage of our sales. Sales to Nortel Networks accounted for 17.0% of our revenues in 2007, 14.4% of our revenues in 2008 and 15.6%
of our revenues in 2009. No other customer accounted for more than 10.0% of our revenues in 2007, 2008 or 2009. As a result of the continued operation of
Nortel’s business in bankruptcy and the continued attempt by Nortel to sell its business units, we cannot be sure as to the amount of revenues we will receive in
2010 from Nortel or any entity that purchases a Nortel business that is one of our customers.

Sales and Marketing

Our sales and marketing strategy is to secure the leading channels and system integrators in each region, partner with leading application companies
and achieve design wins with network equipment providers in our targeted markets. Prospective customers and channels generally must make a significant
commitment of resources to test and evaluate our products and to integrate them into larger systems, networks, and applications. As a result, our sales process
is often subject to delays associated with lengthy approval processes that typically accompany the design and testing of new communications equipment. For
these reasons, the sales cycles of our products to new customers are often lengthy, averaging approximately six to twelve months after achieving a design win.
This time may be further extended because of internal testing, field trials and requests for the addition or customization of features.

We also provide our customers with reference platform designs, which enable them to achieve easier and faster transitions from the initial prototype
designs we use in the test trials through final production releases. We believe this significantly enhances our customers’ confidence that our products will meet
their market requirements and product introduction schedules.

50

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
We  market  our  products  in  the  United  States,  Europe,  Asia,  Latin  America  and  Israel  primarily  through  a  direct  sales  force.  We  have  invested
significant resources in setting up local sales forces giving us a presence in relevant markets. We have given particular emphasis to emerging markets such as
Latin America and Eastern Europe in addition to continuing to sell our products in developed countries.

Marketing managers are dedicated to principal customers to promote close cooperation and communication. Additionally, we market our products in
these areas through independent sales representatives and system integrators. We select these independent entities based on their ability to provide effective
field sales, marketing communications and technical support to our customers. We have generally entered into a combination of exclusive and non-exclusive
sales  representation  agreements  with  these  representatives  in  each  of  the  major  countries  in  which  we  do  business.  These  agreements  are  typically  for
renewable 12-month terms, are terminable at will by us upon 90 days notice, and do not commit the sales representative to any minimum sales of our products
to  third  parties.  Some  of  our  representatives  have  the  ability  to  return  some  of  the  products  they  have  previously  purchased  and  purchase  more  up  to  date
models.

Manufacturing

Texas Instruments Incorporated supplies all of the signal processor chips used for our signal processors. Other components are generic in nature and

we believe they can be obtained from multiple suppliers.

We  have  not  entered  into  any  long-term  supply  agreements.  However,  we  have  worked  for  years  in  several  countries  with  established  global
manufacturing leaders such as Flextronics and have a good experience with their level of commitment and ability to deliver. To date, we have been able to
obtain  sufficient  amounts  of  these  components  to  meet  our  needs  and  do  not  foresee  any  supply  difficulty  in  obtaining  timely  delivery  of  any  parts  or
components. However, an interruption in supply from any of these sources, especially with regard to signal processors from Texas Instruments Incorporated, or
an unexpected termination of the manufacture of certain electronic components, could disrupt production, thereby adversely affecting our results. We generally
maintain an inventory of critical components used in the manufacture and assembly of our products although our inventory of signal processor chips would
likely not be sufficient in the event that we had to engage an alternate supplier for these components.

We  utilize  contract  manufacturing  for  substantially  all  of  our  manufacturing  processes.  Most  of  our  manufacturing  is  carried  out  by  third-party
subcontractors in Israel and China. We have extended our manufacturing capabilities through third party subcontractors in the United States and Mexico. Our
internal  manufacturing  activities  consist  primarily  of  the  production  of  prototypes,  test  engineering,  materials  purchasing  and  inspection,  final  product
configuration and quality control and assurance.

In  addition,  we  have    engaged  three  original  design  manufacturers,  or  ODM,  based  in  Asia  to  design  and  manufacture  some  of  our  products.
Termination  of  our  commercial  relationship  with  an  ODM  or  the  discontinuance  of  manufacturing  of  products  by  an  ODM  would  negatively  affect  our
business operations.

51

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
We  are  obligated  under  certain  agreements  with  our  suppliers  to  purchase  goods  and  under  an  agreement  with  one  of  our  manufacturing
subcontractors  to  purchase  excess  inventory.   Aggregate  non-cancellable  obligations  under  these  agreements  as  of  December  31,  2009  were  approximately
$930,000.

Industry Standards and Government Regulations

Our  products  must  comply  with  industry  standards  relating  to  telecommunications  equipment.    Before  completing  sales  in  a  country,  our  products
must  comply  with  local  telecommunications  standards,  recommendations  of  quasi-regulatory  authorities  and  recommendations  of  standards-setting
committees.  In  addition,  public  carriers  require  that  equipment  connected  to  their  networks  comply  with  their  own  standards.  Telecommunication-related
policies  and  regulations  are  continuously  reviewed  by  governmental  and  industry  standards-setting  organizations  and  are  always  subject  to  amendment  or
change. Although we believe that our products currently meet applicable industry and government standards, we cannot be sure that our products will comply
with future standards.

We  are  subject  to  telecommunication  industry  regulations  and  requirements  set  by  telecommunication  carriers  that  address  a  wide  range  of  areas
including  quality,  final  testing,  safety,  packaging  and  use  of  environmentally  friendly  components.    We  comply  with  the  European  Union’s  Restriction  of
Hazardous  Substances  Directive  (under  certain  exemptions)  that  requires  telecommunication  equipment  suppliers  to  not  use  some  materials  that  are  not
environmentally  friendly.    These  materials  include  cadmium,  hexavalent  chromium,  lead,  mercury,  polybrominated  biphenyls  and  polybrominatel  diphenyl
ethers.  Under  the  directive,  an  extension  for  compliance  was  granted  until  July,  2010_(and  it  is  expected  that  this  deadline  will  be  further  extended)  with
respect to the usage of lead in solders in network infrastructure equipment. We expect that other countries, including countries we operate in, will adopt similar
directives or other additional regulations.

Competition

Competition in our industry is intense and we expect competition to increase in the future. Our competitors currently sell products that provide similar
benefits  to  those  that  we  sell.  There  has  been  a  significant  amount  of  merger  and  acquisition  activity  and  strategic  alliances  frequently  involving  major
telecommunications equipment manufacturers acquiring smaller companies, and we expect that this will result in an increasing concentration of market share
among these companies, many of whom are our customers.

Our principal competitors in the area of analog media gateways (2 to 24 ports) for access and enterprise are Linksys (a division of Cisco Systems,
Inc.),  Mediatrix  Telecom,  Inc.,  Vega  Stream  Limited,  Samsung,  Innovaphone  AG,  Net.com/Quintum  Technologies,  Tainet  Communication  System  Corp.,
Welltech, Ascii Corp., D-Link Systems, Inc., Multitech Inc., Inomedia, OKI and LG.

52

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
In  the  area  of  low  density  digital  gateways  and  multi-service  business  gateways  we  face  competition  from  companies  such  as  Cisco,  Adtran,
Oneaccess, and more specifically in the enterprise class Session Border Controller technology with ACME Packets (Covergence), SIPera, Ingate and Edwater.
In addition we face competition in low, mid and high density gateways from companies such as Nortel, Alcatel-Lucent, Nokia-Siemens, Huawei, Ericsson,
UTstarcom,  ZTE  and  from  Cisco, Veraz  Networks,  Sonus  Networks,  General  Bandwidth,  Dialogic/Cantata  Technologies  and  Commatch  (Telrad).  Some  of
these competitors are also customers of our products and technologies.

Our  principal  competitors  in  the  media  server  market  segment  are  Dialogic/Cantata  Technology/NMS  Communications,  Convedia/Radisys,
Movius(IP Unity/Glenayre), Cognitronics and Aculab.  In addition, we face competition in software-based and hardware-based media servers from internal
development at companies such as Hewlett-Packard, Comverse-NetCentrex, Nortel, Alcatel - Lucent, Nokia-Siemens and Ericsson.

Our principal competitors in the sale of signal processing chips are Texas Instruments, Broadcom, Infineon, Centillium, Surf and Mindspeed. Several
large manufacturers of generic signal processors, such as Motorola, Agere Systems, which merged with LSI Corporation in April 2007, and Intel have begun,
or  are  expected  to  begin  marketing  competing  processors.  Our  principal  competitors  in  the  communications  board  market  are  Dialgic/NMS
Communications/Cantata, Aculab, PIKA Technologies, Inc, Intel, and Motorola.

Our principal competitors in the area of IP phones are comprised of “best–of-breed” IP phone vendors and end-to-end IP telephony vendors.  “Best-
of-breed”  IP  phone  vendors  sell  standard-based  SIP  phones  that  can  be  integrated  into  any  standards-based  IP-PBX  or  hosted  IP  telephony  systems.  These
competitors  include  Polycom,  Mediatrix  and  SNOM.    End-to-end  IP  telephony  vendors  sell  IP  phones  that  only  work  in  their  proprietary  systems.  These
competitors include Cisco, Avaya/Nortel, Alcatel-Lucent, Siemens and Asstra.

Many of our competitors have the ability to offer vendor-sponsored financing programs to prospective customers. Some of our competitors with broad
product portfolios may also be able to offer lower prices on products that compete with ours because of their ability to recoup a loss of margin through sales of
other products or services. Additionally, voice, audio and other communications alternatives that compete with our products are being continually introduced.

In the future, we may also develop and introduce other products with new or additional telecommunications capabilities or services. As a result, we
may compete directly with VoIP companies and other telecommunications infrastructure and solution  providers, some of which may be our current customers.
Additional competitors may include companies that currently provide communication software products and services. The ability of some of our competitors to
bundle other enhanced services or complete solutions with VoIP products could give these competitors an advantage over us.

Intellectual Property and Proprietary Rights

Our success is dependent in part upon proprietary technology. We rely primarily on a combination of patent, copyright and trade secret laws, as well
as confidentiality procedures and contractual provisions, to protect our proprietary rights. We also rely on trademark protection concerning various names and
marks that serve to identify it and our products. While our ability to compete may be affected by our ability to protect our intellectual property, we believe that
because of the rapid pace of technological change in our industry maintaining our technological leadership and our comprehensive familiarity with all aspects
of the technology contained in our signal processors and communication boards is also of primary importance.

53

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
We  own  U.S.  patents  that  relate  to  our  voice  compression  and  session  border  control  technologies.  We  also  actively  pursue  patent  protection  in
selected other countries of interest to us. In addition to patent protection, we seek to protect our proprietary rights through copyright protection and through
restrictions on access to our trade secrets and other proprietary information which we impose through confidentiality agreements with our customers, suppliers,
employees and consultants.

There  are  a  number  of  companies  besides  us  who  hold  or  may  acquire  patents  for  various  aspects  of  the  technology  incorporated  in  the  ITU’s
standards or other industry standards or proprietary standards, for example, in the fields of wireless and cable. While we have obtained cross-licenses from
some of the holders of these other patents, we have not obtained a license from all of the holders. The holders of these other patents from whom we have not
obtained licenses may take the position that we are required to obtain a license from them. Companies that have submitted their technology to the ITU (and
generally other industry standards making bodies) for adoption as an industry standard are required by the ITU to undertake to agree to provide licenses to that
technology on reasonable terms. Accordingly, we believe that even if we were required to negotiate a license for the use of such technology, we would be able
to do so at an acceptable price. Similarly, however, third parties who also participate with respect to the same standards-setting organizations as do we may be
able to negotiate a license for use of our proprietary technology at a price acceptable to them, but which may be lower than the price we would otherwise prefer
to demand.

Under  a  pooling  agreement  dated  March  3,  1995,  as  amended,  between  AudioCodes  and  DSP  Group,  Inc.,  on  the  one  hand,  and  France  Telecom,
Université  de  Sherbrooke  and  their  agent,  Sipro  Lab  Telecom,  on  the  other  hand,  we  and  DSP  Group,  Inc.  granted  to  France  Telecom  and  Université  de
Sherbrooke  the  right  to  use  certain  of  our  specified  patents,  and  any  other  of  our  and  DSP  Group,  Inc.  intellectual  property  rights  incorporated  in  the  ITU
G.723.1 standard. Likewise France Telecom and Université de Sherbrooke granted AudioCodes and DSP Group, Inc. the right to use certain of their patents
and any other intellectual property rights incorporated in the G.723.1 standard. In each case, the rights granted are to design, make and use products developed
or manufactured for joint contribution to the G.723.1 standard without any payment by any party to the other parties.

In addition, each of the parties to the agreement granted to the other parties the right to license to third parties the patents of any party included in the
intellectual  property  required  to  meet  the  G.723.1  standard,  in  accordance  with  each  licensing  party’s  standard  patent  licensing  agreement.  The  agreement
provides for the fee structure for licensing to third parties. The agreement provides that certain technical information be shared among the parties, and each of
the groups agreed not to assert any patent rights against the other with respect of the authorized use of voice compression products based upon the technical
information transferred. Licensing by any of the parties of the parties’ intellectual property incorporated in the G.723.1 standard to third parties is subject to
royalties that are specified under the agreement.

54

 
 
 
 
 
 
Each of the parties to the agreement is free to develop and sell products embodying the intellectual property incorporated into the G.723.1 standard
without payment of royalties to other parties, so long as the G.723.1 standard is implemented as is, without modification. The agreement expires upon the last
expiration date of any of the AudioCodes, DSP Group, Inc., France Telecom or Université de Sherbrooke patents incorporated in the G.723.1 standard.  The
parties to the agreement are not the only claimants to technology underlying the G.723.1 standard.

We are aware of parties who may be infringing our technology that is part of the G.723.1 standard.  We evaluate these matters on a case by case basis,
directly or through our licensing partner. Although we have not yet determined whether to pursue legal action, we may do so in the future. There can be no
assurance that any legal action will be successful.

Third parties have claimed, and from time to time in the future may claim, that our past, current or future products infringe their intellectual property
rights.  Intellectual  property  litigation  is  complex  and  there  can  be  no  assurance  of  a  favorable  outcome  of  any  litigation.  Any  future  intellectual  property
litigation, regardless of outcome, could result in substantial expense to us and significant diversion of the efforts of our technical and management personnel.
Litigation could also disrupt or otherwise severely impact our relationships with current and potential customers as well as our manufacturing, distribution and
sales  operations  in  countries  where  relevant  third  party  rights  are  held  and  where  we  may  be  subject  to  jurisdiction.  An  adverse  determination  in  any
proceeding could subject us to significant liabilities to third parties, require disputed rights to be licensed from such parties, assuming licenses to such rights
could be obtained, or require us to cease using such technology and expend significant resources to develop non-infringing technology. We may not be able to
obtain a license at an acceptable price.

We have entered into technology licensing fee agreements with third parties. Under these agreements, we agreed to pay the third parties royalties, based on
sales of relevant products.

Legal Proceedings

We are not a party to any material legal proceedings, except for the proceedings referred to below.

In  September  2009,  Network  Gateway  Solutions  LLC  filed  a  complaint  in  the  United  States  District  Court  for  the  District  of  Delaware  against
AudioCodes Ltd. and AudioCodes Inc. and 19 other defendants alleging the infringement of certain patents owned by Network Gateway, although Network
Gateway has not served AudioCodes Ltd. and, therefore, it is not a party to this proceeding. Patton Electronics, Inc., a customer of ours, is also a defendant in
this litigation. We have agreed to defend Patton in this litigation. The plaintiff filed an amended complaint in January 2010. The amended complaint does not
indicate the amount of monetary relief sought.

Prior  to  the  acquisition  of  Nuera  by  us  in  2006,  one  of  Nuera’s  customers  had  been  named  as  a  defendant  in  a  patent  infringement  suit  involving
technology the customer purchased from Nuera. In the suit, the plaintiff alleged that the customer used devices to offer services that infringe upon a patent the
plaintiff owns. The customer has sought indemnification from Nuera pursuant to the terms of a purchase agreement between Nuera and the customer relating to
the allegedly infringing technology at issue.

55

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
C.           ORGANIZATIONAL STRUCTURE

List of Significant Subsidiaries

AudioCodes Inc., our wholly-owned subsidiary, is a Delaware corporation.

AudioCodes UK Limited and AudioCodes Europe Limited, our wholly-owned subsidiaries, are incorporated in England.

D.           PROPERTY, PLANTS AND EQUIPMENT

We  lease  our  main  facilities,  located  in  Airport  City,  Lod,  Israel,  which  occupy  approximately  128,000  square  feet  for  annual  lease  payments
(including management fees) of approximately $2.6 million.  In January 2008, we increased the amount of space we leased by approximately 74,000 square
feet for annual lease payments (including management fees) of approximately $1.4 million. In addition, we have entered into an agreement with Airport City,
Ltd. regarding the neighboring property pursuant to which a building of approximately 145,000 square feet is being erected and will be leased to us for period
of  eleven  years.  This  new  building  was  substantially  completed  in  May  2010.  We  are  currently  engaged  in  a  dispute  with  the  landlord  as  to  when  we  are
required to take possession of this building. We estimate the annual lease payments (including management fees) to be in the range of $2.0 million to $3.2
million  depending  on  the  amount  expended  by  the  lessor  on  improvements  to  the  building.  In  view  of  current  economic  conditions  and  our  reduction  in
personnel undertaken since 2008, we may not need to occupy the entire building and may seek to sublease all or a portion of the new building to third parties.
We cannot be sure we will be able to sublease this building or a portion of it.

Our  U.S.  subsidiary,  AudioCodes  Inc.,  leases  a  7,000  square  foot  facility  in  San  Jose,  California,  and  has  additional  offices  with  aggregate  leased
space of 16,000 square feet in Raleigh, Boston and Dallas. AudioCodes Inc. also leases a 32,000 square foot facility in Somerset, New Jersey, and a 20,000
square  foot  facility  in  Plano,  Texas.  The  annual  lease  payments  (including  management  fees)  for  all  our  offices  in  the  United  States  is  approximately  $1
million.

We believe that these properties are sufficient to meet our current needs.  However, we may need to increase the size of our current facilities, seek new

facilities, close certain facilities or sublease portions of our existing facilities in order to address our needs in the future.

ITEM 4A.         UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS

None.

56

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
ITEM 5.           OPERATING AND FINANCIAL REVIEW AND PROSPECTS

Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates

Our  consolidated  financial  statements  are  prepared  in  accordance  with  U.S.  generally  accepted  accounting  principles,  or  U.S.  GAAP.  These
accounting principles require management to make certain estimates, judgments and assumptions based upon information available at the time that they are
made, historical experience and various other factors that are believed to be reasonable under the circumstances. These estimates, judgments and assumptions
can affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities as of the date of the financial statements, as well as the reported amounts of revenues and expenses
during the periods presented.

On  an  on-going  basis,  management  evaluates  its  estimates  and  judgments,  including  those  related  to  revenue  recognition  and  allowance  for  sales
returns, allowance for doubtful accounts, inventories, marketable securities, business combinations, goodwill and intangible assets, income taxes and valuation
allowance,  and  stock-based  compensation.  Management  bases  its  estimates  and  judgments  on  historical  experience  and  on  various  other  factors  that  are
believed to be reasonable under the circumstances, the results of which form the basis for making judgments about the carrying values of assets and liabilities
that are not readily apparent from other sources.

Our management has reviewed these critical accounting policies and related disclosures with our Audit Committee. See Note 2 to the Consolidated

Financial Statements, which contain additional information regarding our accounting policies and other disclosures required by US GAAP.

Management  believes  the  significant  accounting  policies  that  affect  its  more  significant  judgments  and  estimates  used  in  the  preparation  of  its
consolidated  financial  statements  and  are  the  most  critical  to  aid  in  fully  understanding  and  evaluating  AudioCodes’  reported  financial  results  include  the
following:

·
·
·
·
·
·
·

Revenue recognition and allowance for sales returns;
Allowance for doubtful accounts;
Inventories;
Intangible assets;
Goodwill;
Income taxes and valuation allowance; and
Stock-based compensation.

Revenue Recognition and Allowance for Sales Returns

We  generate  our  revenues  primarily  from  the  sale  of  products.  We  sell  our  products  through  a  direct  sales  force  and  sales  representatives.  Our
customers  include  original  equipment  manufacturers,  network  equipment  providers,  systems  integrators  and  distributors  in  the  telecommunications  and
networking industries, all of whom are considered end-users.

57

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revenues from products are recognized in accordance with Staff Accounting Bulleting (“SAB”) 104, “Revenue Recognition in Financial Statements”
when  the  following  criteria  are  met:  (i)  persuasive  evidence  of  an  arrangement  exists,  (ii)  delivery  of  the  product  has  occurred,  (iii)  the  fee  is  fixed  or
determinable  and  (iv)  collectability  is  probable.  We  have  no  obligation  to  customers  after  the  date  on  which  products  are  delivered,  other  than  pursuant  to
warranty obligations and any applicable right of return.  We grant to some of our customers the right of return or the ability to exchange a specific percentage
of the total price paid for products they have purchased over a limited period for other products.

We maintain a provision for product returns and exchanges. This provision is based on historical sales returns, analysis of credit memo data and other

known factors. This provision amounted to $559,000 in 2007, $754,000 in 2008 and $656,000 in 2009.

Revenues from the sale of products which were not yet determined to be final sales due to market acceptance or technological compatibility were
deferred and included in deferred revenues. In cases where collectability is not probable, revenues are deferred and recognized upon collection. Revenues from
services are recognized ratably over the time of the service agreement, usually one year.

Allowance for Doubtful Accounts

Our trade receivables are derived from sales to customers located primarily in the Americas, the Far East, Israel and Europe. We perform ongoing
credit evaluations of our customers and to date have not experienced any material losses from uncollected receivables. An allowance for doubtful accounts is
determined with respect to those amounts that we have recognized as revenue and determined to be doubtful of collection. We usually do not require collateral
on  trade  receivables  because  most  of  our  sales  are  to  large  and  well-established  companies.  On  occasion  we  may  purchase  credit  insurance  to  cover  credit
exposure for a portion of our sales and this may mitigate the amount we need to write off as a result of doubtful collections.

Inventories

Inventories are stated at the lower of cost or market value. Cost is determined using the “weighted average cost” method for raw materials and on the
basis of direct manufacturing costs for finished products. We periodically evaluate the quantities on hand relative to current and historical selling prices and
historical and projected sales volume and technological obsolescence. Based on these evaluations, inventory write-offs are provided to cover risks arising from
slow moving items, technological obsolescence, excess inventories, discontinued products and for market prices lower than cost.  We wrote-off inventory in a
total amount of $700,000 in 2007, $1.2 million in 2008 and $730,000 in 2009.

Intangible assets

As a result of our acquisitions, our balance sheet included acquired intangible assets, in the aggregate amount of approximately $19.0 million as of

December 31, 2007, $8.7 million as of December 31, 2008 and $6.8 million as of December 31, 2009.

58

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
We allocated the purchase price of the companies we have acquired to the tangible and intangible assets acquired and liabilities assumed, based on
their estimated fair values. These valuations require management to make significant estimations and assumptions, especially with respect to intangible assets.
Critical estimates in valuing intangible assets include future expected cash flows from technology acquired, trade names, backlog and customer relationships.
In addition, other factors considered are the brand awareness and market position of the products sold by the acquired companies and assumptions about the
period of time the brand will continue to be used in the combined company’s product portfolio. Management’s estimates of fair value are based on assumptions
believed to be reasonable, but which are inherently uncertain and unpredictable.

If  we  did  not  appropriately  allocate  these  components  or  we  incorrectly  estimate  the  useful  lives  of  these  components,  our  computation  of

amortization expense may not appropriately reflect the actual impact of these costs over future periods, which will affect our net income.

Intangible assets are reviewed for impairment in accordance with ASC 360-10-35  (formerly FAS 144), “Property, Plant, and Equipment- Subsequent
Measurement”, whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of an asset may not be recoverable. Recoverability of assets to
be held and used is measured by a comparison of the carrying amount of an asset to the future undiscounted cash flows expected to be generated by the asset. If
such assets are considered to be impaired, the impairment to be recognized is measured by the amount by which the carrying amount of the assets exceeds the
fair value of the assets. The loss is allocated to the intangible assets on a pro rata basis using the relative carrying amounts of those assets, except that the loss
allocated to an individual intangible asset shall not reduce the carrying amount of that asset below its fair value whenever that fair value is determinable.

Our  intangible  assets  are  comprised  of  acquired  technology,  customer  relations,  trade  names,  existing  contracts  for  maintenance  and  backlog.  All

intangible assets are amortized using the straight-line method over their estimated useful life.

During 2007 and 2009, no impairment charges were identified. During 2008, we recorded an impairment charge for intangible assets in the amount of

$5.9 million (relating to the acquisition of Nuera).

Goodwill

As  a  result  of  our  acquisitions,  our  balance  sheet  included  acquired  goodwill,  in  the  aggregate  amount  of  approximately  $111.2  millions  as  of

December 31, 2007 and $32.1 million as of December 31, 2008 and 2009.

ASC 350 (formerly FAS 142), “Intangible, Goodwill and Other” requires that goodwill be tested for impairment at least annually.  Goodwill is tested
for impairment by comparing the fair value of the reporting unit with its carrying value. Fair value is generally determined using discounted cash flows, market
multiples and market capitalization. Significant estimates used in the fair value methodologies include estimates of future cash flows, future short-term and
long-term growth rates, weighted average cost of capital and estimates of market multiples of the reportable unit. If these estimates or their related assumptions
change in the future, we may be required to record impairment charges for our goodwill and intangible assets with an indefinite life. Our annual impairment
test is performed in the fourth quarter each year.

59

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
The process of evaluating the potential impairment of goodwill is subjective and requires significant judgment at many points during the analysis. In
estimating the fair value of a reporting unit for the purposes of our annual or periodic analyses, we make estimates and judgments about the future cash flows
of that reporting unit. Although our cash flow forecasts are based on assumptions that are consistent with our plans and estimates we are using to manage the
underlying  businesses,  there  is  significant  exercise  of  judgment  involved  in  determining  the  cash  flows  attributable  to  a  reporting  unit  over  its  estimated
remaining useful life. In addition, we make certain judgments about allocating shared assets to the estimated balance sheets of our reporting units. We also
consider our and our competitor's market capitalizations on the date we perform the analysis. Changes in judgment on these assumptions and estimates could
result in a goodwill impairment charge.

Goodwill  represents  the  excess  of  the  purchase  price  and  related  costs  over  the  value  assigned  to  net  tangible  and  identifiable  intangible  assets  of
businesses acquired and accounted for under the purchase method. We review and test our goodwill for impairment at the reporting unit level at least annually,
or  more  frequently  if  events  or  changes  in  circumstances  indicate  that  the  carrying  amount  of  such  assets  may  be  impaired.  We  operate  in  one  operating
segment,  and  this  segment  comprises  our  only  reporting  unit.  We  perform  our  test  in  the  fourth  quarter  of  each  year  using  discounted  cash  flows,  market
multiples and market capitalization.  Significant estimates used in the methodologies include estimates of future cash-flows, future short-term and long-term
growth rates, weighted average cost of capital and market multiples for the reporting unit. The fair value derived from these methodologies is then compared to
the carrying value of the operating segment.

During  2007  and  2009,  no  impairment  charges  were  identified.  As  a  result  of  the  impairment  analysis  for  2008,  we  determined  that  the  goodwill
balance was impaired as a result of adverse equity market conditions which caused a decline in industry market multiples and reduced fair values from our
projected cash flows.  Accordingly, we recorded non-cash impairment charges of $79.1 million in 2008.

Income Taxes and Valuation Allowance

As  part  of  the  process  of  preparing  our  consolidated  financial  statements,  we  are  required  to  estimate  our  income  tax  expense  in  each  of  the
jurisdictions  in  which  we  operate.  This  process  involves  us  estimating  our  actual  current  tax  exposure,  which  is  accrued  as  taxes  payable,  together  with
assessing temporary differences resulting from differing treatment of items for tax and accounting purposes. These differences result in deferred tax assets,
which are included within our consolidated balance sheet. We may record a valuation allowance to reduce our deferred tax assets to the amount of future tax
benefit that is more likely than not to be realized.

60

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Although  we  believe  that  our  estimates  are  reasonable,  there  is  no  assurance  that  the  final  tax  outcome  and  the  valuation  allowance  will  not  be

different than those which are reflected in our historical income tax provisions and accruals.

We  have  filed  or  are  in  the  process  of  filing  U.S.  federal,  state  and  foreign  tax  returns  that  are  subject  to  audit  by  the  respective  tax  authorities.
Although the ultimate outcome is unknown, we believe that adequate amounts have been provided for and any adjustments that may result from tax return
audits are not likely to materially adversely affect our consolidated results of operations, financial condition or cash flows.

Stock-based compensation

We account for stock-based compensation in accordance with ASC 718  (formerly FAS 123R) ”Compensation-Stock Compensation”. We utilize the
Black-Scholes option pricing model to estimate the fair value of stock-based compensation at the date of grant. The Black-Scholes model requires subjective
assumptions regarding dividend yields, expected volatility, expected life of options and risk-free interest rates. These assumptions reflect management’s best
estimates. Changes in these inputs and assumptions can materially affect the estimate of fair value and the amount of our stock-based compensation expenses.
We recognized stock-based compensation expense of $8.0 million in 2007, $4.3 million in 2008 and $2.0 million in 2009. As of December 31, 2009, there was
approximately $1.8 million of total unrecognized stock-based compensation expense related to non-vested stock-based compensation arrangements granted by
us. As of December 31, 2009, that expense is expected to be recognized over a weighted-average period of 0.96 years.

A. 

OPERATING RESULTS

You should read this discussion with the consolidated financial statements and other financial information included in this Annual Report.

Overview

We design, develop and sell advanced voice over IP, or VoIP, and converged VoIP and data networking products and applications to service providers
and  enterprises.  We  are  a  VoIP  technology  leader  focused  on  VoIP  communications,  applications  and  networking  elements,  and  its  products  are  deployed
globally  in  broadband,  mobile,  cable,  and  enterprise  networks.  We  provide  a  range  of  innovative,  cost-effective  products  including  media  gateways,  multi-
service  business  gateways,  residential  gateways,  IP  phones,  media  servers,  session  border  controllers,  s  and  value-added  applications.    Our  underlying
technology,  VoIPerfectHD™,  relies  primarily  on  our  leadership  in  DSP,  voice  coding  and  voice  processing  technologies.  Our  high  definition  (HD)  VoIP
technologies and products provide enhanced intelligibility, and a better end user communication experience in emerging Voice networks.

Our  products  enable  our  customers  to  build  high-quality  packet  networking  equipment  and  network  solutions  and  provide  the  building  blocks  to
connect traditional telephone networks to the VoIP networks, as well as connecting and securing multimedia communication between different packet-based
networks. Our products are sold primarily to leading original equipment manufacturers, or OEMs, system integrators and network equipment providers in the
telecommunications  and  networking  industries.    We  have  continued  to  broaden  our  offerings,  both  from  internal  and  external  development  and  through
acquisitions,  as  we  have  expanded  in  the  last  few  years  from  selling  chips  to  boards,  subsystems,  media  gateway  systems,  media  servers,  session  border
controllers and messaging platforms. We have also increased our product portfolio to enhance our position in the market and serve our channels better as a
“one stop shop” for Voice over IP hardware.

61

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Our headquarters and research and development facilities are located in Israel with research and development extensions in the U.S. and U.K. We

have other offices located in Europe, the Far East, and Latin America.

Nortel Networks, our largest customer, accounted for 17.0% of our revenues in 2007, 14.4% of our revenues in 2008 and 15.6% of our revenues in
2009. Nortel filed for bankruptcy protection in January 2009. Nortel has operated in bankruptcy since then while also selling a number of its business units and
seeking to sell additional business units. As a result of Nortel’s bankruptcy filing, we could not recognize $1.7 million of sales to Nortel in the fourth quarter of
2008. During 2009, Nortel returned to us products with a sales price of $706,000. This amount reduced the $1.7 million of unpaid deferred revenues on our
balance sheet. The remaining approximately $1.0 million of these deferred revenues represent an unsecured claim in Nortel’s bankruptcy proceeding. We do
not know if we will recover any amount in the bankruptcy proceeding.

Our top five customers accounted for 32.8% of our revenues in 2007, 26.3% of our revenues in 2008 and 29.8% of our revenues in 2009. Based on
our experience, we expect that our largest customers may change from period to period. If we lose a large customer and fail to add new customers to replace
lost revenue, our operating results may be materially adversely affected.

Revenues based on the location of our customers for the last three fiscal years are as follows:

Americas
Far East
Europe
Israel
Total

2007

2008

2009

56.6%   
11.2 
25.5 
6.7 
100.0%   

52.4%   
16.4 
23.4 
7.8 
100.0%   

55. 6%
14.6 
21.5 
8.3 
100.0%

Part of our strategy over the past few years has involved the acquisition of complementary businesses and technologies. We continued implementation
of this strategy with three additional acquisitions in the past three years. In July, 2006, we completed the acquisition of Nuera (merged into AudioCodes Inc. as
of December 31, 2007).  Nuera provides Voice over Internet Protocol infrastructure solutions for broadband and long distance networks.

62

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
 
 
In August 2006, we acquired Netrake (merged into AudioCodes Inc. as of December 31, 2007), a provider of session border controller, or SBC, and
security gateway solutions. SBCs enable connectivity, policies and security for real-time media sessions, such as VoIP, video or fax, between public or private
IP networks. Security gateways enable secure real-time sessions across wifi, broadband and wireless networks in field mobile convergence deployments.

In  April  2007,  we  completed  the  acquisition  of  CTI  Squared.    CTI  Squared  is  a  provider  of  enhanced  messaging  and  communications  platforms
deployed globally by service providers and enterprises.  CTI Squared’s platforms integrate data and voice messaging services over internet, intranet, PSTN,
cellular, cable and enterprise networks.

In May 2010, we acquired all of the remaining outstanding equity of Natural Speech Communication Ltd. that we did not own. NSC is based in Israel

and is engaged in speech analytics and speech recognition technologies and products.

We believe that prospective customers generally are required to make a significant commitment of resources to test and evaluate our products and to
integrate  them  into  their  larger  systems.  As  a  result,  our  sales  process  is  often  subject  to  delays  associated  with  lengthy  approval  processes  that  typically
accompany the design and testing of new communications equipment. For these reasons, the sales cycles of our products to new customers are often lengthy,
averaging approximately six to twelve months.  As a result, we may incur significant selling and product development expenses prior to generating revenues
from sales.

The currency of the primary economic environment in which our operations are conducted is the U.S. dollar, and as such, we use the U.S. dollar as
our functional currency. Transactions and balances originally denominated in U.S. dollars are presented at their original amounts. All transaction gains and
losses  from  the  remeasurement  of  monetary  balance  sheet  items  denominated  in  non-U.S.  dollar  currencies  are  reflected  in  the  statement  of  operations  as
financial income or expenses, as appropriate.

The  demand  for  Voice  over  IP,  or  VoIP,  technology  has  increased  during  recent  years.  In  recent  years,  the  shift  from  traditional  circuit-switched
networks to next generation packet-switched networks continued to gain momentum. As data traffic becomes the dominant factor in communications, service
providers are building and maintaining converged networks for integrated voice and data services. In developed countries, traditional and alternative service
providers  adopt  bundled  triple  play  (voice,  video  and  data)  and  quadruple  play  (voice,  video,  data  and  mobile)  offerings.  This  trend,  enabled  by  voice  and
multimedia  over  IP,  has  fueled  competition  among  cable,  wireline,  ISP  and  mobile  operators,  increasing  the  pressure  for  adopting  and  deploying  VoIP
networks. In addition, underdeveloped markets without basic wire line service in countries such as China and India and certain countries in Eastern Europe are
adopting the use of VoIP technology to deliver voice and data services that were previously unavailable.

63

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
The general economic downturn, including disruptions in the world credit and equity markets, has had and continues to have a significant negative
impact  on  business  around  the  world.    The  impact  of  this  economic  environment    on  the  technology  industry  and  our  major  customers  has  been  severe.
Conditions may continue to be depressed or may be subject to further deterioration which could lead to a further reduction in consumer and customer spending
overall, which could have an adverse impact on sales of our products.  A disruption in the ability of our significant customers to access liquidity could cause
serious disruptions or an overall deterioration of their businesses which could lead to a significant reduction in their orders of our products and the inability or
failure on their part to meet their payment obligations to us, any of which could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations and liquidity. In
addition, any disruption in the ability of customers to access liquidity could lead customers to request longer payment terms from us or long-term financing of
their purchases from us.  Granting extended payment terms or a significant adverse change in a customer’s financial and/or credit position could also require us
to assume greater credit risk relating to that customer’s receivables or could limit our ability to collect receivables related to purchases by that customer.  As a
result, our reserves for doubtful accounts and write-offs of accounts receivable could increase.

Results of Operations

The following table sets forth the percentage relationships of certain items from our consolidated statements of operations, as a percentage of total

revenues for the periods indicated:

Statement of Operations Data:
Revenues
Cost of revenues
Gross profit
Operating expenses:

Research and development, net
Selling and marketing
General and administrative
Impairment of goodwill and intangible assets

Total operating expenses

Operating loss
Financial expenses, net
Loss before taxes on income
Taxes on income
Equity in losses of affiliated companies, net

Year Ended December 31,
2008

2009

2007

100.0%    

100.0%    

43.7 
56.3 

25.7 
27.1 
6.1 
- 
58.9 

(2.6)
1.4 
(4.3)
0.8 
0.7 

44.3 
55.7 

21.6 
25.5 
5.3 
48.7 
101.1 

(45.4)
1.9 
(47.3)
0.3 
1.5 

100.0%
44.6 
55.4 

23.8 
25.5 
6.2 
- 
55.5 

(0.1)
2.2 
(2.3)
0.2 
0.1 

Net loss

(5.5)%   

(49.1)%   

(2.6)%

64

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
  
   
  
   
  
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
 
   
  
   
  
   
  
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
 
   
  
   
  
   
  
   
 
Year Ended December 31, 2009 Compared to Year Ended December 31, 2008

Revenues.  Revenues decreased 28.0% to $125.9 million in 2009 from $174.7 million in 2008. The decrease in revenues was primarily due to the

downturn in the global economy and the challenging business environment in the market for telecommunications products.

Gross  Profit.    Cost  of  revenues  includes  the  manufacturing  cost  of  hardware,  quality  assurance,  overhead  related  to  manufacturing  activity  and
technology licensing fees payable to third parties. Gross profit decreased to $69.7 million in 2009 from $97.3 million in 2008. Gross profit as a percentage of
revenues  decreased  to  55.4%  in  2009  from  55.7%  in  2008.   The  decrease  in  our  gross  profit  percentage  was  primarily  attributable  to  a  decline  in  average
selling prices of our products. The decrease in gross profit was partially offset by the results of our cost reduction plan implemented in the first quarter of 2009.
In addition, the decrease in gross profit was partially offset by a reduction in manufacturing costs.

Research and Development Expenses, net.  Research and development expenses, net consist primarily of compensation and related costs of employees engaged
in  ongoing  research  and  development  activities,  development-related  raw  materials  and  the  cost  of  subcontractors  less  grants  from  the  OCS.  Research  and
development expenses decreased 20.8% to $30.0 million in 2009, from $37.8 million in 2008 and increased as a percentage of revenues to 23.8% in 2009 from
21.6% in 2008. The decrease in net research and development expenses on an absolute dollar basis was primarily due to our cost reduction plans implemented
during 2008 and 2009 that reduced the number of research and development personnel and due to a decrease in stock-based compensation expense to $642,000
in  2009  from  $1.5  million  in  2008.  We  expect  that  research  and  development  expenses  will  increase  in  an  absolute  dollar  basis  in  2010  as  a  result  of  our
continued development of new products.

Selling and Marketing Expenses.  Selling and marketing expenses consist primarily of compensation for selling and marketing personnel, as well as
exhibition, travel and related expenses. Selling and marketing expenses decreased 28.2% in 2009 to $32.1 million from $44.7 million in 2008. These expenses
decreased  primarily  as  a  result  of  our  cost  reduction  plans  implemented  during  2008  and  2009  which  reduced  the  number  of  personnel  in  this  area  and  a
decrease in the stock-based compensation expense included in selling and marketing expenses to $913,000 in 2009 compared to $2.0 million in 2008, as well
as a $718,000 decrease in amortization expenses. The decrease in amortization expenses was mainly due to an intangible asset impairment charge recorded in
the  fourth  quarter  of  2008.  As  a  percentage  of  revenues,  selling  and  marketing  expenses  were  25.5%  in  both  2008  and  2009.     We  expect  that  selling  and
marketing expenses will increase on an absolute dollar basis in 2010 as a result of an expected increase in our sales force and marketing activities.

General and Administrative Expenses.  General and administrative expenses consist primarily of compensation for finance, human resources, general
management,  rent,  network  and  bad  debt  reserve,  as  well  as  insurance  and  professional  services  expenses.  General  and  administrative  expenses  decreased
15.2% to $7.8 million in 2009 from $9.2 million in 2008. As a percentage of revenues, general and administrative expenses increased to 6.2% in 2009 from
5.3% in 2008. The decrease in general and administrative expenses on an absolute dollar basis, was primarily due to our cost reduction plans implemented
during 2008 and 2009 which reduced the number of our general and administrative personnel. We expect that general and administrative expenses will increase
in absolute dollar terms to support our expected growth.  

65

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Impairment  of  Goodwill  and  Intangible  Assets.  We  review  goodwill  for  impairment  annually  during  the  fourth  quarter  of  the  fiscal  year  or  more
frequently if events or circumstances indicate that an impairment loss may have occurred. In the fourth quarter of fiscal 2008, in connection with the impact of
weakening market conditions on our forecasts and a sustained, significant decline in the market capitalization to a level lower than our net book value, it was
concluded  that  triggering  events  existed  and  we  were  required  to  test  intangible  assets  and  goodwill  for  impairment,  in  accordance  with  ASC  360-10-35
(formerly SFAS 144) "Property, Plant, and Equipment- Subsequent Measurement" and ASC 350 (formerly FAS 142) "Intangible, Goodwill and Other". As a
result, in the fourth quarter of 2008, we recorded a goodwill impairment charge of approximately $79.1 million and an intangible assets impairment charge of
$5.9 million. These impairment charges did not impact our business operations, cash flows or compliance with the financial covenants in our loan agreements.
In 2009, there was no impairment charge.

Financial  Expenses,  Net.    Financial  expenses,  net  consist  primarily  of  interest  derived  on  cash  and  cash  equivalents,  marketable  securities,  bank
deposits and structured notes, net of interest accrued in connection with our senior convertible notes and bank loans and bank charges. Financial expenses, net,
in  2009  were  $2.7  million  compared  to  $3.3  million  in  2008.  The  decrease  in  financial  expenses,  net  in  2009  was  primarily  due  to  lower  interest  expense
recorded with respect to our senior convertible notes following the repurchase of notes in the fourth quarters of 2008 and 2009.

Taxes on Income.  Income taxes, net, were $290,000 in 2009 compared to $505,000 in 2008. The decrease is principally attributable to previous year’s

tax refund received in 2009.

Equity  in  Losses  of  Affiliated  Companies,  Net.    Equity  in  losses  of  affiliated  companies,  net  was  $76,000  in  2009  compared  to  $2.6  million  in
2008.  The decrease in these expenses is attributable to consolidating the financial results of NSC into our operating results starting December 1, 2008. Also, in
2008, these expenses included an impairment charge of $1.1 million related to an investment in an affiliate.

Year Ended December 31, 2008 Compared to Year Ended December 31, 2007

Revenues.    Revenues  increased  10.4%  to  $174.7  million  in  2008  from  $158.2  million  in  2007.  The  increase  in  revenues  was  primarily  due  to  an

increase in revenues from our networking business.

Gross  Profit.    Cost  of  revenues  includes  the  manufacturing  cost  of  hardware,  quality  assurance,  overhead  related  to  manufacturing  activity  and
technology licensing fees payable to third parties. Gross profit increased to $97.3 million in 2008 from $89.1 million in 2007. Gross profit as a percentage of
revenues decreased to 55.7% in 2008 from 56.3% in 2007.  The decrease in our gross profit percentage was primarily attributable to a less favorable product
mix in 2008 and a decline in average selling prices of our products. The decrease in gross profit percentage was partially offset by the higher sales volume that
allowed us to leverage our manufacturing overhead over a larger sales base as well as a reduction in manufacturing costs due to a reduction in our raw material
costs and our cost reduction plan implemented in 2008.

66

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Research and Development Expenses, net.  Research and development expenses, net consist primarily of compensation and related costs of employees engaged
in  ongoing  research  and  development  activities,  development-related  raw  materials  and  the  cost  of  subcontractors  less  grants  from  the  OCS.  Research  and
development expenses decreased 7.1% to $37.8 million in 2008, from $40.7 million in 2007 and decreased as a percentage of revenues to 21.6% in 2008 from
25.7% in 2007. The decrease in net research and development expenses, both on an absolute and a percentage basis, was primarily due to our cost reduction
plans implemented during 2007 and 2008 and due to a decrease in stock-based compensation expense which amounted to $1.5 million in 2008 and $3.0 million
in 2007.

Selling and Marketing Expenses.  Selling and marketing expenses consist primarily of compensation for selling and marketing personnel, as well as
exhibition, travel and related expenses. Selling and marketing expenses increased 4.1% in 2008 to $44.7 million from $42.9 million in 2007. These expenses
increased  because  the  effect  of  the  higher  value  of  the  NIS  compared  to  the  U.S.  dollar  increased  the  cost  of  expenses  denominated  in  NIS  and  higher
commissions on sales were greater than the decrease in expenses as a result of our reduction in personnel. As a percentage of revenues, selling and marketing
expenses decreased to 25.5% in 2008 from 27.1% in 2007. The decrease in selling and marketing expenses on a percentage basis was primarily a result of our
revenues  increasing  at  a  faster  rate  than  these  expenses  and  due  to  a  decrease  in  the  stock-based  compensation  expense  included  in  selling  and  marketing
expenses which was $2.0 million in 2008 compared to $3.5 million in 2007.

General and Administrative Expenses.  General and administrative expenses consist primarily of compensation for finance, human resources, general
management, rent, network and bad debt reserve, as well as insurance and professional services expenses. General and administrative expenses decreased 4.3%
to $9.2 million in 2008 from $9.6 million in 2007. As a percentage of revenues, general and administrative expenses decreased to 5.3% in 2008 from 6.1% in
2007. The decrease in general and administrative expenses was primarily due to our cost reduction plans implemented during 2007 and 2008.

Impairment  of  Goodwill  and  Intangible  Assets.  We  review  goodwill  for  impairment  annually  during  the  fourth  quarter  of  the  fiscal  year  or  more
frequently if events or circumstances indicate that an impairment loss may have occurred. In the fourth quarter of fiscal 2008, in connection with the impact of
weakening market conditions on our forecasts and a sustained, significant decline in the market capitalization to a level lower than our net book value, it was
concluded  that  triggering  events  existed  and  we  were  required  to  test  intangible  assets  and  goodwill  for  impairment,  in  accordance  with  ASC  360-10-35
(formerly SFAS 144) "Property, Plant and Equipment- Subsequent Measurement" and ASC 350 (formerly SFAS 142) "Intangible, Goodwill and Other". As a
result, in the fourth quarter of 2008, we recorded a goodwill impairment charge of approximately $79.1 million and an intangible assets impairment charge of
$5.9 million. These impairment charges do not impact our business operations, cash flows or compliance with the financial covenants in our loan agreements.
There was no impairment charge in 2007.

67

 
 
 
 
 
Financial Expenses, Net.  Financial expenses, net consist primarily of interest accrued in connection with our senior convertible notes and bank loans
and bank charges, net of interest derived on cash and cash equivalents, short-term and long-term marketable securities, short-term and long-term bank deposits
and structured notes, . Financial expenses, net, in 2008 were $3.3 million compared to $2.2 million in 2007. The increase in financial expenses, net in 2008 was
primarily due to lower interest rates and interest income, net, on the remaining net proceeds from our sale of senior convertible notes in November 2004 and
due  to  interest  expenses  related  to  bank  borrowings  in  the  aggregate  amount  of  $30  million  during  the  second  and  third  quarters  of  2008,  offset  in  part  by
reduced interest expense as the result of the repurchase of senior convertible notes in the fourth quarter of 2008.

Taxes on Income.  Taxes on income were $505,000 in 2008 compared to $1.3 million in 2007. The decrease was principally attributable to a reduction

in the deferred tax liability.

Equity in Losses of Affiliated Companies, Net.  Equity in losses of affiliated companies, net was $2.6 million in 2008 compared to $1.1 million in

2007.  The increase in 2008 was primarily due to an impairment charge of $1.1 million related to an investment in an affiliate.

Impact of Inflation, Devaluation and Fluctuation of Currencies on Results of Operations, Liabilities and Assets

Since the majority of our revenues are paid in or linked to the U.S. dollar, we believe that inflation and fluctuations in the NIS/U.S. dollar exchange
rate have no material effect on our revenues. However, a majority of the cost of our Israeli operations, mainly personnel and facility-related, is incurred in
NIS.  Inflation in Israel and U.S. dollar exchange rate fluctuations have some influence on our expenses and, as a result, on our net income. Our NIS costs, as
expressed in U.S. dollars, are influenced by the extent to which any increase in the rate of inflation in Israel is not offset (or is offset on a lagging basis) by a
devaluation of the NIS in relation to the U.S. dollar.

To protect against the changes in value of forecasted foreign currency cash flows resulting from payments in NIS, we maintain a foreign currency cash
flow  hedging  program.  We  hedge  portions  of  our  forecasted  expenses  denominated  in  foreign  currencies  with  forward  contracts.  These  measures  may  not
adequately protect us from material adverse effects due to the impact of inflation in Israel.

The following table presents information about the rate of inflation in Israel, the rate of devaluation of the NIS against the U.S. dollar, and the rate of

inflation in Israel adjusted for the devaluation:

Year ended 
December 31,

2007
2008
2009

Five months ended May 31, 2010

Israeli 
inflation 
rate 
%

NIS 
Devaluation 
Rate 
%

Israeli inflation
adjusted for
devaluation 
%

3.4     
3.8     
3.9     

0.0     

68

(9.0)    
(1.1)    
(0.7)    

1.4     

12.4 
4.9 
4.6 

(1.4)

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
 
   
      
      
  
   
   
   
 
   
      
      
  
   
 
Recent Accounting Pronouncements

Effective in 2009:

On  January  1,  2009,  we  adopted  an  amendment  to  ASC  810,  "Consolidation"  (originally  issued  as  FAS  160).  According  to  the  amendment,  non-
controlling  interest  in  a  subsidiary  is  an  ownership  interest  in  the  consolidated  entity  that  should  be  reported  as  a  separate  component  of  equity  in  the
consolidated financial statements. As such, changes in the parent's ownership interest with no change of control are treated as equity transactions, rather than
step acquisitions or dilution gains or losses. The amendment clarifies that losses of partially owned consolidated subsidiaries shall continue to be allocated to
the non-controlling interests even when their investment was already reduced to zero.

The  amendment  applies  prospectively,  except  for  the  presentation  and  disclosure  requirements,  which  are  applied  retrospectively  to  all  periods
presented.  As  a  result,  upon  adoption,  we  retroactively  reclassified  the  "Minority  interests"  balance  to  be  presented  in  a  new  caption  in  total  shareholders'
equity, "Non-controlling interest". The adoption also impacted certain captions previously used in the consolidated statement of operations, largely identifying
net  loss  including  the  portion  attributable  to  non-controlling  interest  and  net  loss  attributable  to  AudioCodes'  shareholders.  This  amendment  required  us  to
include the accumulated amount of non-controlling interest as part of shareholders' equity ($228 at December 31, 2008).

The net loss amounts we have previously reported are now presented as "Net loss attributable to AudioCodes' shareholders," and, as required, net loss
per  share  continue  to  reflect  amounts  attributable  only  to  AudioCodes'  shareholders.  Similarly,  in  the  statements  of  changes  in  shareholders'  equity,  we
distinguished between equity amounts attributable to AudioCodes' shareholders and amounts attributable to the non-controlling interest.

In  June  2009,  the  Financial  Accounting  Standards  Board  ("FASB")  issued  a  standard  that  established  the  FASB  Accounting  Standards
Codification  ("ASC")  and  amended  the  hierarchy  of  generally  accepted  accounting  principles  ("GAAP")  such  that  the  ASC  became  the  single  source  of
authoritative U.S. GAAP. Rules and interpretive releases issued by the SEC under authority of federal securities law are also sources of the authoritative GAAP
for SEC registrants. All other literature is considered non-authoritative. New accounting standards issued subsequent to June 30, 2009 are communicated by
the FASB through Accounting Standards Updates ("ASUs"). The ASC is effective from September 1, 2009. Throughout the notes to the consolidated financial
statements  references  that  were  previously  made  to  former  authoritative  U.S.  GAAP  pronouncements  have  been  changed  to  coincide  with  the  appropriate
section of the ASC.

69

 
 
 
 
Effective  January  1,  2009,  we  applied  an  amendment  to  ASC  470-20,  “Debt  with  Conversion  and  Other  Options”  (formerly  FSP  APB  14-1
"Accounting  for  Convertible  Debt  Instruments  That  May  Be  Settled  in  Cash  upon  Conversion  (Including  Partial  Cash  Settlement))".  The  amended  ASC
stipulates that issuers of convertible debt instruments that may be settled in cash upon conversion (including partial cash settlement) should separately account
for the liability and equity components of those instruments by allocating the proceeds from issuance of the instrument between the liability component (the
“Liability Component”) and the embedded conversion option (the “Equity Component”). This allocation is done by first determining the carrying amount of
the Liability Component based on the fair value of a similar liability excluding the Equity Component, and then allocating to the Equity Component the excess
of  the  initial  proceeds  ascribed  to  the  convertible  debt  instrument  over  the  amount  allocated  to  the  Liability  Component.  That  excess  is  reported  as  a  debt
discount  and  subsequently  amortized  as  interest  cost  over  the  instrument's  expected  life  using  the  interest  method.  The  cumulative  effect  of  the  change  in
accounting principle on periods prior to these presented in the amount of $9,329 is recognized as of January 1, 2007, as an offsetting adjustment to the opening
balance of retained earnings for that period.

We used the income approach in order to estimate the value of the Liability Component. Under the income approach, the fair value of the liability
component is determined based on the present value of the future cash flows using a discount rate that reflects the required rate of return for the liability. We
used the following assumptions in order to estimate the required rate of return on the liability component: (1) time to maturity was determined to be 5 years,
based  on  the  assumption  that  the  notes  would  be  redeemed  by  the  investors  at  their  earliest  contractual  redemption  date,  (2)  average  yeild  to  maturity  was
derived from traded bonds with similar default risk and time to maturity as the convertible notes, and (3) the default risk was determined by comparing the
Company’s historical financial ratios to those of other companies rated by Standard & Poor.

Still not effective:

In October 2009, the FASB issued an update to ASC 605-25, "Revenue recognition – Multiple-Element Arrangements", that provides amendments to

the criteria for separating consideration in multiple-deliverable arrangements to:

1)           Provide updated guidance on whether multiple deliverables exist, how the deliverables in an arrangement should be separated, and how the

consideration should be allocated;

2)           Require an entity to allocate revenue in an arrangement using estimated selling prices ("ESP") of deliverables if a vendor does not have

vendor-specific objective evidence of selling price ("VSOE") or third-party evidence of selling price ("TPE");

70

 
 
 
 
 
 
3)           Eliminate the use of the residual method and require an entity to allocate revenue using the relative selling price method; and

4)                      Require  expanded  disclosures  of  qualitative  and  quantitative  information  regarding  application  of  the  multiple-deliverable  revenue

arrangement guidance.

71

 
 
 
The mandatory adoption date is January 1, 2011. We may elect to adopt the update prospectively, to new or materially modified arrangements beginning on the
adoption date, or retrospectively, for all periods presented. We are currently evaluating the impact of this update on our consolidated results of operations and
financial condition.

In January 2010, the FASB updated the "Fair Value Measurements Disclosures". More specifically, this update will require (a) an entity to disclose
separately  the  amounts  of  significant  transfers  in  and  out  of  Levels  1  and  2  fair  value  measurements  and  to  describe  the  reasons  for  the  transfers;  and
(b) information about purchases, sales, issuances and settlements to be presented separately (i.e. present the activity on a gross basis rather than net) in the
reconciliation of fair value measurements using significant unobservable inputs (Level 3 inputs). This update clarifies existing disclosure requirements for the
level of disaggregation used for classes of assets and liabilities measured at fair value, and requires disclosures about the valuation techniques and inputs used
to  measure  fair  value  for  both  recurring  and  nonrecurring  fair  value  measurements  using  Level  2  and  Level  3  inputs.  As  applicable  to  us,  this  update  will
become effective as of the first interim or annual reporting period beginning after December 15, 2009, except for the gross presentation of the Level 3 roll
forward information, which is required for annual reporting periods beginning after December 15, 2010 and for interim reporting periods within those years.
We do not expect that the adoption of this update will have a material impact on our consolidated financial statements.

B.

LIQUIDITY AND CAPITAL RESOURCES

We  have  financed  our  operations  for  the  last  three  years,  from  the  remaining  proceeds  of  our  sale  of  convertible  notes,  as  well  as  with  cash  from

operations in those years.

In November 2004, we raised net proceeds of approximately $120.2 million in a private placement of $125.0 million aggregate principal amount of
our 2.00% Senior Convertible Notes due 2024.  Holders of the notes are entitled to convert the notes into our ordinary shares at a conversion rate of 53.4474
ordinary shares per $1,000 principal amount of notes, which is the equivalent to a conversion price of approximately $18.71 per share.  The conversion rate is
subject  to  adjustment  in  certain  circumstances,  such  as  changes  in  our  capital  structure  or  upon  the  issuance  by  us  of  share  dividends  or  certain  cash
distributions. During 2008, we repurchased $51.5 million in principal amount of our 2% Senior Convertible Notes for a total cost, including accrued interest, of
$50.2 million. In November 2009, we repurchased approximately $73.1 million in principal amount of the Notes.  As of December 31, 2009, there was a total
of $403,000 in principal amount of the Notes outstanding. The remaining outstanding Notes may be redeemed by us, in whole or in part at any time.  The
holders of these outstanding Notes may require us to redeem the Notes on November 9, 2014 or November 9, 2019, or upon certain fundamental changes.

In April and July 2008, we entered into loan agreements with banks in Israel that provide for borrowings of an aggregate of $30 million. The loans
bear interest at an annual rate equal to LIBOR plus 1.3%-1.5% with respect to $23 million of borrowings and LIBOR plus 0.5%-0.65% with respect to $7
million of borrowings.   The principal amount borrowed is repayable in 20 equal quarterly payments from August 2008 through July 2013. The banks have a
lien on our assets and we are required to maintain $7 million of compensating balances with the banks.  The agreements require us, among other things, to
maintain shareholders' equity at specified levels and to achieve certain levels of operating income. The agreements also restrict us from paying dividends. As of
December 31, 2009 and March 31, 2010, we were in compliance with the covenants contained in the loan agreements.

72

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
As of December 31, 2009, we had $52.9 million in cash and cash equivalents, marketable securities and bank deposits, a decrease of approximately
$62.2  million  from  $115.1  million  at  December  31,  2008.   The  decline  in  this  amount  was  primarily  attributable  to  the  repurchase  of  approximately  $73.1
million in principal amount of our Senior Convertible Notes in the fourth quarter of 2009, offset, in part, by cash provided by operating activities.

In January 2008, our Board approved a program to repurchase up to 4,000,000 of our ordinary shares. Purchases would be made from time-to-time at
the discretion of management subject, among other things, to our share price and market conditions. If management elects to have us purchase our shares, we
will use a portion of our cash to effect these purchases. In 2008, we repurchased a total of approximately 3.5 million ordinary shares at a total cost of $13.7
million.  We did not repurchase any of our ordinary shares in 2009.

Cash from Operating Activities

Our operating activities provided cash in the amount of $21.0 million in 2009, primarily due to a decrease in trade receivables, net, of $11.0 million, a
decrease in inventories of $7.1 million, non-cash depreciation and amortization expenses of $5.0 million and non-cash amortization of discount and deferred
charges on our senior convertible notes of $2.9 million, offset, in part, by our net loss, a decrease of $3.5 million in other payables and accrued expenses and a
decrease  of  $3.1  million  in  trade  payables.  Our  trade  receivables  and  our  inventories  decreased  primarily  because  of  our  lower  sales  volume  in  2009  than
in    2008.  Our  trade  receivables  also  decreased  because  of  increased  collection  efforts.  Our  trade  payables,  other  payables  and  accrued  expenses  decreased
primarily because of our lower cost of goods sold in 2009 than in 2008 and implementation of cost reduction steps and a wage cut in January 2009.

Our operating activities provided cash in the amount of $16.4 million in 2008, primarily due to non-cash expenses in the amount of $86.1 million for
impairment charges, $7.4 million for depreciation and amortization, $4.3 million for stock-based compensation and $1.5 million of equity in losses of affiliated
companies, as well as an increase of $3.1 million in trade and other payables, offset, in part, by our net loss and a decrease of $3.5 million in trade and other
receivables  and  an  increase  of  $1.8  million  in  inventories.    Our  trade  and  other  payables  increased  because  of  extended  payment  terms  granted  to  us  by
suppliers.  Our trade and other receivables decreased because we had lower revenues in the fourth quarter of 2008 than in the same period in 2007 and because
of increased year-end collection efforts. Inventory increased primarily because of lower than expected revenues in the fourth quarter of 2008.

Our operating activities provided cash in the amount of $12.4 million in 2007, primarily due to a decrease of $5.0 million in trade receivables and
non-cash  charges  of  $8.0  million  for  stock-based  compensation  and  $7.8  million  for  depreciation  and  amortization,  offset,  in  part,  by  our  net  loss  and  a
decrease of $5.1 million in trade and other payables and an increase of $2.6 million in inventories.

73

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash from Investing Activities

In  2009,  our  investing  activities  provided  cash  in  the  amount  of  $60.3  million,  primarily  due  to  the  net  proceeds  from  bank  deposits  and  from

redemption of marketable securities on maturity.

In 2008, our investing activities used cash in the amount of $20.0 million, primarily due to the excess of our investment in marketable securities and
short-term  and  long-term  bank  deposits  and  payments  in  connection  with  the  acquisition  of  CTI  Squared  over  proceeds  from  bank  deposits  and  sale  and
maturity of marketable securities.

In  2007,  our  investing  activities  provided  cash  in  the  amount  of  $32.7  million,  primarily  due  to  our  proceeds  from  the  maturity  of  marketable

securities and structured notes.

Cash from Financing Activities

In 2009, we used cash in financing activities of $79.1 million as a result of $73.1 million used to repurchase our Senior Convertible Notes and $6.0

million used for repayment of bank loans.

In 2008, our financing activities used $34.7 million due to $50.2 million used to repurchase our Senior Convertible Notes and $13.7 million used to

repurchase our ordinary shares offset, in part, by bank borrowings in the aggregate amount of $30 million.

In 2007, financing activities provided $4.8 million due to proceeds from issuance of our shares upon exercise of options and from purchases of our

shares under our Employee Stock Purchase Plans.

Financing Needs

We anticipate that our operating expenses will be a material use of our cash resources for the foreseeable future.  We believe that our current working
capital  is  sufficient  to  meet  our  operating  cash  requirements  for  at  least  the  next  twelve  months,  including  payments  required  under  our  existing  bank
loans.  Part of our strategy is to pursue acquisition opportunities. If we do not have available sufficient cash to finance our operations and the completion of
additional  acquisitions,  we  may  be  required  to  obtain  additional  debt  or  equity  financing.  We  cannot  be  certain  that  we  will  be  able  to  obtain,  if  required,
additional financing on acceptable terms or at all.

C.

RESEARCH AND DEVELOPMENT, PATENTS AND LICENSES, ETC.

Research and Development

In order to accommodate the rapidly changing needs of our markets, we place considerable emphasis on research and development projects designed
to improve our existing products and to develop new ones. We are developing more advanced communications boards, analog and digital media gateways for
carrier  and  enterprise  applications,  media  servers  and  session  border  controllers.  Our  platforms  will  feature  increased  trunk  capacity,  new  functionalities,
enhanced signaling software and compliance with new control protocols. As of December 31, 2009, 248 of our employees were engaged primarily in research
and development on a full-time basis. We also employed 2 employees on a part-time basis.

74

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Our research and development expenses were $30.0 million in 2009 compared to $37.8 million in 2008 and $40.7 million in 2007 . From time to time
we have received royalty-bearing grants from the Office of the Chief Scientist of the Israeli Ministry of Industry, Trade and Labor, or the OCS. As a recipient
of grants from the OCS, we are obligated to perform all manufacturing activities for projects subject to the grants in Israel unless we receive an exemption.
Know-how from the research and development which is used to produce products may not be transferred to third parties without the approval of the OCS and
may  further  require  significant  payments.  The  OCS  approval  is  not  required  for  the  export  of  any  products  resulting  from  such  research  or  development.
Through December 31, 2009, we had obtained grants from the OCS aggregating $8.5 million for certain of our research and development projects. We are
obligated to pay royalties to the OCS, amounting to 3%-4.5% of the sales of the products and other related revenues generated from such projects, up to 100%
of the grants received, linked to the U.S. dollar and bearing interest at the rate of LIBOR at the time of grant. The obligation to pay these royalties is contingent
on actual sales of the products and in the absence of such sales no payment is required.

D.

TREND INFORMATION

The accelerated demand for VoIP technology has impacted our business during the last few years. Over the past few years, the shift from traditional
circuit-switched  networks  to  next  generation  packet-switched  networks  has  continued  to  gain  momentum.  As  data  traffic  becomes  the  dominant  factor  in
communications,  service  providers  are  building  and  maintaining  converged  networks  for  integrated  voice  and  data  services.  In  addition,  underdeveloped
markets without basic wire line service in countries such as China and India and certain countries in Eastern Europe are beginning to use VoIP technology to
deliver voice and data services that were previously unavailable. In addition, the growth in broadband access and related technologies has driven the emergence
of alternative service providers. This in turn stimulates competition with incumbent providers, encouraging them to adopt voice over packet technologies. The
entry of new industry players and the demand for new equipment have impacted our business in the last few years.

In 2009, we continued to experience pressure to shorten our lead times in supplying products to customers. Some of our customers are implementing
“demand pull” programs by which they only purchase our product very close to the time, if not simultaneously with the time, they plan to sell their product. We
are  increasing  our  sales  efforts  in  new  markets,  such  as  Latin  America,  Eastern  Europe  and  Far  East.  We  have  introduced  new  system  level  products,  and
applications in our product lines.  We are still experiencing low visibility into customer demand for our products and our ability to predict our level of sales.

E.

OFF-BALANCE SHEET ARRANGEMENTS

We do not have any “off-balance sheet arrangements” as this term is defined in Item 5E of Form 20-F.

75

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
F.

TABULAR DISCLOSURE OF CONTRACTUAL OBLIGATIONS

As of December 31, 2009, our contractual obligations were as follows (in thousands):

PAYMENTS DUE BY PERIOD

LESS THAN
1 YEAR

1-3
YEARS

3-5
YEARS

MORE
THAN 5
YEARS

TOTAL

Senior convertible notes
403 
Bank loans
21,750 
Rent and lease commitments
34,170 
Severance pay fund (1)
1,101 
Uncertain tax positions (2)
322 
Office of the Chief Scientist
8,715 
930 
930 
Other commitments
(1)   Our obligation for accrued severance pay under Israel’s Severance Pay Law as of December 31, 2009 was $13.3 million. This obligation is payable only
upon  termination,  retirement  or  death  of  the  respective  employee.  We  have  funded  $12.2  million  through  deposits  into  severance  pay  funds,  leaving  a  net
obligation of approximately $1.1 million.

15,750     
11,770 

8,715 
– 

6,000 
4,686 

12,901 

403     

4,813 

– 

– 

(2)  Uncertain  income  tax  position  under  ASC  740  (formerly  FASB  Interpretation  No  48),  “Income  Taxes”,  are  due  upon  settlement  and  we  are  unable  to
reasonably estimate the ultimate amount of timing of settlement. See also Note 14f in our Consolidated Financial Statements for further information regarding
our liability under ASC 740.

ITEM 6.

DIRECTORS, SENIOR MANAGEMENT AND EMPLOYEES

A.

DIRECTORS AND SENIOR MANAGEMENT

The following table sets forth certain information with respect to our directors, senior executive officers and key employees at June 15, 2010:

Name

Shabtai Adlersberg

Lior Aldema
Jeffrey Kahn
Eyal Frishberg
Eli Nir
Yehuda Hershkovici
Tal Dor
Gary Drutin
Joseph Tenne(1)(2)(3)
Dr. Eyal Kishon(1)(2)(3)
Doron Nevo(1)(2)(3)
Osnat Ronen(1)(2)

(1) Member of Audit Committee
(2) Member of Nominating Committee
(3) Member of Compensation Committee

Age
57

44
52
52
44
43
41
49
54
49
54
48

  Chairman of the Board, President, Chief Executive Officer and Interim Chief

Position

Financial Officer

  Chief Operating Officer
  Chief Strategy Officer
  Vice President, Operations
  Vice President, Research and Development
  Vice President, Systems
  Vice President, Human Resources
  Vice President, Global Sales
  Director
  Director
  Director
  Director

76

 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
 
   
     
 
  
 
  
  
  
      
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
      
      
      
  
  
   
      
      
      
  
  
   
      
      
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Shabtai Adlersberg  co-founded AudioCodes  in  1993,  and  has  served  as  our  Chairman  of  the  Board,  President  and  Chief  Executive  Officer  since
inception. He has also acted as our Interim Chief Financial Officer since May 1, 2010. Mr. Adlersberg co-founded DSP Group, a semiconductor company, in
1987. From 1987 to 1990, Mr. Adlersberg served as the Vice President of Engineering of DSP Group, and from 1990 to 1992, he served as Vice President of
Advanced  Technology.  As  Vice  President  of  Engineering,  Mr. Adlersberg  established  a  research  and  development  team  for  digital  cellular  communication
which was spun-off in 1992 as DSP Communications. Mr. Adlersberg also serves as Chairman of the Board of Directors of Natural Speech Communication
Ltd.  and  as  a  director  of  MailVision  Ltd  and  CTI  Squared  Ltd.  Mr. Adlersberg  holds  an  M.Sc.  in  Electronics  and  Computer  Engineering  from  Tel  Aviv
University and a B.Sc. in Electrical Engineering from the Technion-Israel Institute of Technology, or the Technion.

Lior Aldema has served as Chief Operating Officer since January 2010 and previously served as our Vice President, Product Management from 2002
until 2009, as well as our Vice President Marketing from February 2003 until 2009. He has been employed by us since 1998, when he was team leader and
later headed our System Software Group in our research and development department. Prior to 1998, Mr. Aldema served as an officer in the Technical Unit of
the Intelligence Corps of the Israeli Defense Forces (Major), heading both operational units and large development groups related to various technologies. Mr.
Aldema holds an M.B.A. from Tel Aviv University and a B.Sc. from the Technion.

Jeffrey Kahn has served as our Chief Strategy Officer since January 2010. Prior to joining us, Mr. Kahn served as Founder and Managing Director of
Strategy3i, a global consultancy that he established in 2007 to provide counseling to leading global companies, including Pfizer, Unicredit and Renova, among
others. From 2005 to 2007, Mr. Kahn served as a director of investment banking at Maxim Group LLC, and from 1995 to 2005 he served as the Chief Strategic
Officer of Ruder Finn International, one of the world’s largest and oldest independent global communications firms.  Mr. Kahn holds a B.A. in international
relations and psychology from Brooklyn College and has done graduate studies in international relations and psychology at Tel Aviv University.

77

 
 
 
 
 
Eyal  Frishberg  has  served  as  our  Vice  President,  Operations  since  October  2000.  From  1997  to  2000,  Mr.  Frishberg  served  as  Associate  Vice
President,  SDH  Operations  in  ECI  Telecom  Ltd.,  a  major  telecommunication  company.  From  1987  to  1997,  Mr.  Frishberg  worked  in  various  operational
positions  in  ECI  Telecom  including  as  manager  of  ECI  production  facility  and  production  control.  Mr.  Frishberg  worked  from  1994  until  1997  for  ELTA
company,  part  of  Israeli  Aircraft  Industries  in  the  planning  and  control  department.  Mr.  Frishberg  holds  a  B.Sc.  in  Industrial  Engineering  from  Tel  Aviv
University and an M.B.A. from Ben-Gurion University of the Negev.

Eli Nir has served as our Vice President, Research and Development since April 2001. He has been employed by us since 1996, when he founded and
headed  our  System  Software  Group  in  our  research  and  development  department.  Prior  to  1996,  Mr.  Nir  served  as  an  officer  in  the  Technical  Unit  of  the
Intelligence Corps of the Israeli Defense Forces (Major), heading both operational units and large development groups mostly related to digital processing. Mr.
Nir holds an M.B.A. and an M.Sc. from Tel Aviv University in Digital Speech Processing and a B.Sc. from the Technion.

Yehuda Hershkovici has served as our Vice President, Systems Group since 2003. From 2001 to 2003, Mr. Hershkovici served as our Vice President,
Advanced  Products.  From  2000  to  2001,  Mr.  Hershkovici  served  as  our  Director  of  Advanced  Technologies.  From  1994  to  1998  and  during  1999,  Mr.
Hershkovici held a variety of research and development positions at Advanced Recognition Technologies, Ltd., a voice and handwriting recognition company,
heading its research and development from 1999 to 2000 as Vice President, Research and Development. From 1998 to 1999, Mr. Hershkovici was engaged in
developing  various  wireless  communication  algorithms  at  Comsys,  a  telecommunications  company.  Mr.  Hershkovici  holds  an  M.Sc.  and  a  B.Sc.,  from  the
Technion both in the area of telecommunications.

Tal Dor has served as our Vice President of Human Resources since March 2000. Prior to March 2000, Ms. Dor acted for several years as a consultant
in Israel to, among others, telephone and cable businesses, as well as health and social service organizations. Ms. Dor holds a B.A. in psychology, from Ben-
Gurion University of the Negev and an M.A. in psychology from Tel Aviv University.

Gary Drutin currently serves as our Vice President of Global Sales.  Mr. Drutin was the Vice President of Sales for Europe, Middle East and Latin
America from 2005 until 2007 and Vice President of Channel Operations and Marketing from 2004 until 2005.  From 2001 until 2004, Mr. Drutin was Country
Manager  and  General  Manager  for  Cisco  Israel,  Cyprus  and  Malta  and  from  1997  until  2001  served  as  regional  sales  manager  for  service  providers  and
enterprises for Cisco Israel. From 1990 until 1997, he served in sales management roles at Digital Equipment Corporation Israel. Mr. Drutin holds an M.B.A
degree from Tel-Aviv University in Information Systems and Marketing and a B.Sc. degree in Computer Engineering from the Technion.

Joseph Tenne has served as one of our directors since June 2003. Mr. Tenne is currently the Chief Financial Officer of Ormat Technologies, Inc., a
company listed on the New York Stock Exchange, which is engaged in the geothermal and recovered energy business. Since January 2006, Mr. Tenne has also
served as the Chief Financial Officer of Ormat Industries Ltd., an Israeli holding company listed on the Tel-Aviv Stock Exchange and the parent company of
Ormat Technologies, Inc.  From 2003 to 2004, Mr. Tenne was the Chief Financial Officer of Treofan Germany GmbH & Co. KG, a German company, which is
engaged in the development, production and marketing of oriented polypropylene films, which are mainly used in the food packaging industry. From 1997
until 2003, Mr. Tenne was a partner in Kesselman & Kesselman, Certified Public Accountants in Israel and a member of PricewaterhouseCoopers International
Limited. Mr. Tenne holds a B.A. in Accounting and Economics and an M.B.A. from Tel Aviv University. Mr. Tenne is also a Certified Public Accountant in
Israel.

78

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Dr. Eyal Kishon has served as one of our directors since 1997.  Since 1996, Dr. Kishon has been Managing Partner of Genesis Partners, an Israel-
based venture capital fund.  From 1993 to 1996, Dr. Kishon served as Associate Director of Dovrat-Shrem/Yozma-Polaris Fund Limited Partnership.  Prior to
that, Dr. Kishon served as Chief Technology Officer at Yozma Venture Capital from 1992 to 1993.  Dr. Kishon serves as a director of Allot Communications
Ltd and Celtro Inc.  From 1991 to 1992, Dr. Kishon was a Research Fellow in the Multimedia Department of IBM Science & Technology.  From 1989 to 1991,
Dr. Kishon worked in the Robotics Research Department of AT&T Bell Laboratories.  Dr. Kishon holds a B.A. in Computer Science from the Technion – Israel
Institute of Technology and an M.Sc. and a Ph.D. in Computer Science from New York University.

Doron Nevo has served as one of our directors since 2000.  Mr. Nevo is President and CEO of KiloLambda Technologies Ltd., an optical subsystems
company, which he co-founded in 2001.  From 1999 to 2001, Mr. Nevo was involved in fund raising activities for Israeli-based startup companies.  From 1996
to  1999,  Mr.  Nevo  served  as  President  and  CEO  of  NKO,  Inc.    Mr.  Nevo  established  NKO  in  early  1995  as  a  startup  subsidiary  of  Clalcom,  Ltd.    NKO
designed  and  developed  a  full  scale,  carrier  grade,  IP  telephony  system  platform  and  established  its  own  IP  network.    From  1992  to  1996,  Mr.  Nevo  was
President and CEO of Clalcom Ltd.  Mr. Nevo established Clalcom in 1992 as a telecom service provider in Israel.  He also serves on the board of a number of
companies, including Utility Wireless Corp. (a manufacturer of radio frequency sub-systems), Elcom Technologies (manufacturer of Satcom and digital radio
synthesizers), Notox, Ltd. (a biotech company), BioCancell, Inc. and Bank Adanim.  Mr. Nevo holds a B.Sc. in Electrical Engineering from the Technion –
Israel Institute of Technology and an M.Sc. in Telecommunications Management from Brooklyn Polytechnic.

Osnat Ronen has served as one of our directors since December 2007. Ms. Ronen has served as General Partner of Viola Private Equity since January
2008.  From 2001 until 2007, Ms. Ronen was the Deputy Chief Executive Officer of Leumi & Co. Investment House, the private equity investment arm and
investment banking services arm of the Leumi Group.  Prior to this position, she was Deputy Head of the Subsidiaries Division of Leumi Group from 1999
until  2001.    Ms.  Ronen  serves  as  a  director  of  Leumi  Leasing  and  Investments  Ltd.,  National  Consultants  (Netconsultant)  Ltd.,  Fox-Wizel  Ltd.,  Paz  Oil
Company Ltd. and Keshet Broadcasting Ltd.  Ms. Ronen received an M.B.A. degree and a BSc degree in mathematics and computer science from the Tel Aviv
University.

B.

COMPENSATION

The aggregate direct remuneration paid during the year ended December 31, 2009 to the 14 persons who served in the capacity of director, senior
executive  officer  or  key  employee  during  2009  was  approximately  $2.6  million,  including  approximately  $308,000  which  was  set  aside  for  pension  and
retirement benefits. Two of the persons who were officers in 2009 are no longer employed by us. The compensation amounts do not include amounts expended
by us for automobiles made available to our officers, expenses (including business, travel, professional and business association dues and expenses) reimbursed
to officers and other fringe benefits commonly reimbursed or paid by companies in Israel.

79

 
 
 
 
 
 
Stock options to purchase our ordinary shares granted to persons who served in the capacity of director or executive officer under our 1997, 1999 and
2008 Stock Option Plans are generally exercisable at the fair market value at the date of grant, and expire ten years (under the 1997 Plan) and seven years
(under  the  1999  Plan  and  the  2008  Plan),  respectively,  from  the  date  of  grant.  The  options  are  generally  exercisable  in  four  equal  annual  installments,
commencing one year from the date of grant.

As of December 31, 2009, both the 1997 and 1999 Stock Option Plans had expired and no options are available for future grants under these plans.

A summary of our stock option activity and related information for the years ended December 31, 2007, 2008 and 2009 for the 14 persons who served

in the capacity of director, senior executive or key employee officer during 2009 is as follows:

2007

2008

2009

Number
of
Options

Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price

Number
of
Options

Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price

Number
of
Options

Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price

Outstanding at the beginning of the year

1,842,269 

 $

Granted
Cancelled
Exercised

352,500 
 $
(176,000)    
(16,500)   $

9.72 

6.42 

2.31     

2,002,269 

 $

 $
85,000 
(225,000)    
(84,000)   $

7.54 

3.25 

2.23     

1,778,269 

 $

483,577 
 $
(358,418)    
(37,500)   $

Outstanding at the end of the year

2,002,269    $

7.54     

1,778,269    $

7.66     

1,865,928    $

7.66 

1.42 

0 

6.44 

As  of  December  31,  2009,  options  to  purchase  1,262,351  ordinary  shares  were  exercisable  by  the  14  persons  who  served  as  an  officer  or  director

during 2009 at an average exercise price of $8.21 per share.

Under the Israeli Companies Law, the compensation arrangements for officers who are not directors require the approval of the board of directors,
unless  the  articles  of  association  provide  otherwise.    Our  articles  of  association  do  not  provide  otherwise.  Arrangements  regarding  the  compensation  of
directors require the approval of the audit committee, the board and the shareholders, in that order.

80

 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
   
 
  
  
  
 
   
      
      
      
      
      
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
 
   
      
      
      
      
      
  
   
 
 
C.

BOARD PRACTICES

Corporate Governance Practices

We  are  incorporated  in  Israel  and  therefore  are  subject  to  various  corporate  governance  practices  under  the  Israeli  Companies  Law,  1999,  or  the
Companies Law, relating to such matters as outside directors, the audit committee, the internal auditor and approvals of interested party transactions.  These
matters are in addition to the ongoing listing conditions of the Nasdaq Global Select Market and other relevant provisions of U.S. securities laws.  Under the
Nasdaq rules, a foreign private issuer may generally follow its home country rules of corporate governance in lieu of the comparable Nasdaq requirements,
except for certain matters such as composition and responsibilities of the audit committee and the independence of its members.  For further information, see
“Item 16G – Corporate Governance.”

Independent Directors

Under the Israeli Companies Law, Israeli companies that have offered securities to the public in or outside of Israel are required to appoint at least two
“outside” directors. Doron Nevo, Dr. Eyal Kishon and Osnat Ronen currently serve as our outside directors. Under the requirements for listing on the Nasdaq
Global Select Market, a majority of our directors are required to be independent as defined by Nasdaq rules.  Doron Nevo, Dr. Eyal Kishon, Osnat Ronen and
Joseph Tenne qualify as independent directors under the applicable Securities and Exchange Commission and Nasdaq rules.

To qualify as an outside director under Israeli law, an individual or his or her relatives, partners, employers or entities under the person's control may
not have, and may not have had at any time during the previous two years, any affiliation, as such term is defined in the Companies Law, with the company or
any entity controlling, controlled by or under common control with the company. In addition, no individual may serve as an outside director if the individual’s
position or other activities create or may create a conflict of interest with his or her role as an outside director or are likely to interfere with his or her ability to
serve as a director. For a period of two years from termination from office, a former outside director may not serve as a director or employee of the company or
provide professional services to the company for consideration. Pursuant to the Israeli Companies Law, at least one of the outside directors appointed by a
publicly-traded  company  must  have  “financial  and  accounting  expertise.”  The  other  outside  directors  are  required  to  possess  “financial  and  accounting
expertise” or “professional expertise,” as these terms are defined in regulations promulgated under the Companies Law. Joseph Tenne is designated as the audit
committee’s financial expert.

The  outside  directors  must  be  elected  by  the  shareholders,  including  at  least  one-third  of  the  shares  of  non-controlling  shareholders  voted  on  the
matter. However, the outside directors can be elected by shareholders without this one-third approval if the total shares of non-controlling shareholders voted
against the election do not represent more than one percent of the voting rights in the company. The term of an outside director is three years and may be
extended for additional three-year terms. An outside director can be removed from office only under very limited circumstances. All of the outside directors
must serve on a company’s statutory audit committee and each other committee of a company’s board of directors is required to include at least one outside
director. If, at the time an outside director is elected, all current members of the board of directors are of the same gender, then the elected outside director must
be of the other gender.

81

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Pursuant to an amendment to the Israeli Companies Law, an Israeli company whose shares are publicly traded may elect to adopt a provision in its
articles of association pursuant to which a majority of its board of directors will constitute individuals complying with certain independence criteria prescribed
by  the  Israeli  Companies  Law.    We  have  not  included  such  a  provision  in  our  articles  of  association  since  our  board  of  directors  complies  with  the
independence requirements of the Nasdaq and Securities and Exchange Commission regulations described above.

Audit Committee

Under the Companies Law and the requirements for listing on the Nasdaq Global Select Market, our board of directors is required to appoint an audit
committee. Our audit committee must be comprised of at least three directors, including all of the outside directors. The audit committee consists of: Dr. Eyal
Kishon, Doron Nevo, Joseph Tenne and Osnat Ronen. Our board of directors has determined that Joseph Tenne is an “audit committee financial expert” and
that all members of the Audit Committee are independent under the applicable Securities and Exchange Commission and Nasdaq rules.

The audit committee may not include the chairman of the board of directors, a controlling shareholder and the members of his immediate family, or
any director who is employed by the company or provides services to the company on a regular basis. Under Israeli law, the role of the audit committee is to
examine flaws in our business management, in consultation with the internal auditor and the independent accountants, and to propose remedial measures to the
board. The audit committee also reviews for approval transactions between us and office holders or interested parties, as described below.

We  have  adopted  an  audit  committee  charter  as  required  by  Nasdaq  rules.  Our  audit  committee  assists  the  board  of  directors  in  fulfilling  its
responsibility  for  oversight  of  the  quality  and  integrity  of  our  accounting,  auditing  and  financial  reporting  practices  and  financial  statements  and  the
independence  qualifications  and  performance  of  our  independent  auditors.  The  audit  committee  also  has  the  authority  and  responsibility  to  oversee  our
independent auditors, to recommend for shareholder approval the appointment and, where appropriate, replacement of our independent auditors and to pre-
approve audit fees and all permitted non-audit services and fees.

Nominating Committee

Nasdaq  rules  require  that  director  nominees  be  selected  or  recommended  for  the  board’s  selection  either  by  a  committee  composed  solely  of
independent directors or by a majority of independent directors.  Our Nominating Committee assists the board of directors in its selection of individuals as
nominees  for  election  to  the  board  of  directors  and/or  to  fill  any  vacancies  or  newly  created  directorships  on  the  board  of  directors.    The  Nominating
Committee consists of Dr. Eyal Kishon, Doron Nevo, Joseph Tenne and Osnat Ronen.  All members of the Nominating Committee are independent under the
applicable Nasdaq rules.

82

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Compensation Committee

Nasdaq rules also provide that the compensation of a company’s chief executive officer and other executive officers is required to be approved either
by  a  majority  of  the  independent  directors  on  the  board  of  directors  or  a  committee  comprised  solely  of  independent  directors.  Our  board  of  directors  has
appointed  Dr.  Eyal  Kishon,  Doron  Nevo  and  Joseph  Tenne  to  serve  on  our  Compensation  Committee  of  the  board  of  directors.  All  members  of  the
Compensation Committee are independent under the applicable Nasdaq rules.

Internal Auditor

Under the Companies Law, our board of directors is also required to appoint an internal auditor proposed by the audit committee. The internal auditor
may be our employee, but may not be an interested party or office holder, or a relative of any interested party or office holder, and may not be a member of our
independent  accounting  firm.  The  role  of  the  internal  auditor  is  to  examine,  among  other  things,  whether  our  activities  comply  with  the  law  and  orderly
business  procedure.  Brightman,  Almagor  Zohar  &  Co.  (a  member  firm  of  Deloitte  &  Touche  in  Israel)  was  appointed  as  our  internal  auditor  in  November
2008. Previously, Eitan Hashachar CPA had been our internal auditor since January 2001.

Board Classes

Pursuant  to  our  articles  of  association,  our  directors,  other  than  our  outside  directors,  are  classified  into  three  classes  (classes  I,  II  and  III).  The

members of each class of directors and the expiration of the term of office is as follows:

Vacant
Joseph Tenne
Shabtai Adlersberg

Class I
Class II
Class III

2010
2011
2012

We currently do not have a Class I director.

Our  outside  directors  under  the  Companies  Law,  Doron  Nevo,  Dr.  Eyal  Kishon  and  Osnat  Ronen,  are  not  members  of  any  class  and  serve  in

accordance with the provisions of the Companies Law. Mr. Nevo’s term ends in 2012, Dr. Kishon’s term ends in 2011, and Ms. Ronen’s term ends in 2010.

D.

EMPLOYEES

We had the following number of employees as of December 31, 2007, 2008 and 2009 in the areas set forth in the table below:

83

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Research and development
Sales & marketing, technical service & support
Operations
Management and administration

Our employees were located in the following areas as of December 31, 2007, 2008 and 2009.

Israel
United States
Europe
Far East
Latin America

As of December 31,

2007 
296 
249 
99 
44 
688 

2008 
249 
209 
92 
45 
595 

As of December 31,

2007 
425 
197 
29 
31 
6 
688 

2008 
382 
151 
27 
28 
7 
595 

2009 
248 
201 
88 
41 
578 

2009 
384 
125 
26 
36 
7 
578 

The decrease in the number of employees in 2008 and 2009 was primarily attributable to our cost reduction plans implemented in 2007 and 2008. In

2009, salary reduction measures were taken with respect to our employees worldwide.

Israeli labor laws and regulations are applicable to our employees in Israel. These laws principally concern matters such as paid annual vacation, paid
sick  days,  length  of  the  workday,  pay  for  overtime,  insurance  for  work-related  accidents,  severance  pay  and  other  conditions  of  employment.  Israeli  law
generally requires severance pay, which may be funded by Manager’s Insurance, described below, upon the retirement or death of an employee or termination
of  employment  without  cause  (as  defined  under  Israeli  law).  Furthermore,  Israeli  employees  and  employers  are  required  to  pay  predetermined  sums  to  the
National  Insurance  Institute,  which  include  payments  for  national  health  insurance.  The  payments  to  the  National  Insurance  Institute  currently  range  from
approximately  5%  to  17%  of  wages  up  to  specified  wage  levels,  of  which  the  employee  contributes  approximately  65%  and  the  employer  contributes
approximately 35%.

Our employees are subject to certain provisions of the collective bargaining agreements between the Histadrut (General Federation of Labor in Israel)
and  the  Coordination  Bureau  of  Economic  Organizations  (including  the  Industrialists Associations)  by  order  of  the  Israeli  Minister  of  Industry,  Trade  and
Labor. These provisions principally concern cost of living increases, recreation pay and other conditions of employment. We generally provide our employees
with benefits and working conditions above the required minimums. Our employees, as a group, are not currently represented by a labor union. To date, we
have not experienced any work stoppages.

84

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
Pursuant to an order issued in December 2007 by the Israeli Minister of Industry, Trade and Labor, new provisions relating to pension arrangements in
the  collective  bargaining  agreements  between  the  Histadrut  and  the  Coordination  Bureau  of  Economic  Organizations  will  apply  to  all  employees  in  Israel,
including  our  employees  in  Israel.  We  regularly  contribute  to  a  “Manager’s  Insurance  Fund”  or  to  a  privately  managed  pension  fund  on  behalf  of  our
employees located in Israel. These funds provide employees with a lump sum payment upon retirement (or a pension, in case of a pension fund) and severance
pay, if legally entitled thereto, upon termination of employment. We provide for payments to a Manager’s Insurance Fund and pension fund contributions in the
amount of 13.3% of an employee’s salary on account of severance pay and provident payment or pension, with the employee contributing 5.0% of his salary.
We also pay an additional amount of up to 2.5% of certain of our employees’ salaries in connection with disability payments. In addition, we administer an
Education Fund for our Israeli employees and pay 7.5% of these employees’ salaries thereto, with the employees contributing 2.5% of their salary.

E.

SHARE OWNERSHIP

The following table sets forth the share ownership and outstanding number of options of our directors and officers as of June 15, 2010.

Name

Total Shares
Beneficially
Owned

Percentage of
Ordinary Shares  

Number of
Options

5,572,576     

13.8%   

277,514 

*     
*     
*     
*     
*     
*     
*     
*     
*     
*     
*     

* 
* 
* 
* 
* 
* 
* 
* 
* 
* 
* 

Shabtai Adlersberg

Eyal Frishberg
Eli Nir
Lior Aldema
Yehuda Hershkovici
Tal Dor
Gary Drutin
Jeff Kahn
Joseph Tenne
Dr. Eyal Kishon
Doron Nevo
Osnat Ronen

*Less than one percent.

Our officers and directors have the same voting rights as our other shareholders.

85

 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
   
      
  
   
  
   
  
   
   
  
   
   
  
   
   
  
   
   
  
   
   
  
   
   
  
   
   
  
   
   
  
   
   
  
   
   
  
   
 
   
      
  
   
  
   
      
  
   
  
 
The following tables sets forth information with respect to the options to purchase our ordinary shares held by Mr. Adlersberg as of June 15, 2010. In
addition, on December 14, 2009, we granted to Mr. Adlersberg restricted share units that will enable him to receive 40,269 of our ordinary shares subject to his
continuing service to us. These shares vest quarterly over a four-year period from the date of grant. As of June 15, 2010, 5,031 of these shares had vested.

Number of
Options

275,000
120,808

Employee Share Plans

Grant Date

Exercise
Price

Exercised

    Cancelled  

Vesting

Expiration Date

September 23, 2004
December 14, 2009

  $
  $

12.84     
2.57     

-     
-     

- 
- 

5 years
4 years

September 23, 2011
December 14, 2016

We  have  Employee  Share  Purchase  Plans  for  the  sale  of  shares  to  our  employees  and  Employee  Share  Option  Plans  for  the  granting  of  options  to  our
employees, officers, directors and consultants. Most of these plans are pursuant to the Israeli Income Tax Ordinance, entitling the beneficiaries who are our
employees to tax benefits under Israeli law. There are various conditions that must be met in order to qualify for these benefits, including registration of the
options in the name of a trustee for each of the beneficiaries who is granted options.  For tax benefits each option, and any ordinary shares acquired upon the
exercise of the option, must be held by the trustee at least for a period commencing on the date of grant and ending no later than 24 months after the date of
grant, in accordance with the period of time specified by Section 102 of Israel’s Income Tax Ordinance, and deposited in trust with the trustee.

Employee Share Purchase Plans

            We implemented two Employee Share Purchase Plans in May 2001. One plan, the global plan, was for our non-U.S., employees and the other our U.S.
employees.   We  amended  and  restated  the  global  plan  in  July  2007  and  adopted  an  additional  plan  for  U.S.  employees  in  July  2007.  Under  these  Plans,  a
maximum of 6,500,000 of our ordinary shares were reserved for sale to our employees at a price equal to 85% of the lesser of fair market value on the first day
or last day of each offering period under the Plans.  As of December 31, 2008, we had issued 2,259,776 of our ordinary shares pursuant to purchases under
these plans.

During 2008, our Board of Directors decided to suspend operation of the Employee Share Purchase Plans.

Employee Share Option Plans

2008 Equity Incentive Plan.  We have adopted an equity incentive plan under Section 102 of the Israeli Income Tax Ordinance, or Section 102, which
provides certain tax benefits in connection with share-based compensation to employees, officers and directors.  This plan, our 2008 Equity Incentive Plan, was
approved by the Israeli Tax Authority.

86

 
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
      
      
    
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Under our equity incentive plan, we may grant our directors, officers and employees restricted shares, restricted share units and options to purchase
our ordinary shares under Section 102.  We may also grant other persons awards under our equity incentive plan.  However, such other persons (controlling
shareholders and consultants) will not enjoy the tax benefits provided by Section 102.  The total number of ordinary shares that were originally available for
grant under the 2008 Plan was 2,009,122. This number is reduced by one share for each option we grant under the 2008 Plan. During 2009, options to purchase
1,054,308 ordinary shares and 40,269 restricted share units were granted under the 2008 Plan. As a result, as of December 31, 2009, 914,545 ordinary shares
remained available for grant under the 2008 Plan.

The Israeli Tax Authority approved the 2008 Plan under the capital gains tax track of Section 102.  Based on Israeli law currently in effect and the
election  of  the  capital  gains  tax  track,  and  provided  that  options,  restricted  shares  and  restricted  shares  units  granted  or,  upon  their  exercise  or  vesting,  the
underlying shares, issued under the plan are held by a trustee for the two years following the date in which such awards are granted, our employees, officers
and directors will be (i) entitled to defer any taxable event with respect to the awards until the underlying ordinary shares are sold, and (ii) subject to capital
gains tax of 25% on the sale of the shares.  However, if we grant awards at a value below the underlying shares' market value at the date of grant, the 25%
capital gains tax rate will apply only with respect to capital gains in excess of the underlying shares' market value at the date of grant and the remaining capital
gains will be taxed at the grantee's regular tax rate.  We may not recognize a tax benefit pertaining to the employees' restricted shares, restricted share units and
options for tax purposes except in the events described above under which the gain is taxed at the grantee's regular tax rate.

Restricted  shares,  restricted  share  units  and  options  granted  under  the  2008  Plan  will  generally  vest  over  four  years  from  the  grant  date.    If  the
employment of an employee is terminated for any reason, the employee (or in the case of death, the designated beneficiary) may exercise his or her vested
options within ninety days of the date of termination (or within twelve months of the date of termination in the case of death or disability) and shall be entitled
to any rights upon vested restricted shares and vested restricted share units to be delivered to the employee to the extent that they were vested prior to the date
his or her employment terminates. Directors are generally eligible to exercise his or her vested options within twelve months from the date the director ceases
to serve on the board of directors.

1999 Option Plans. In 1999, our board restated three 1997 Employee Share Option Plans for our Israeli employees, officers, directors and consultants
and  two  1997  Share  Option  Plans  for  our  U.S.  employees,  officers,  directors  and  consultants. Additionally,  in  1999  our  board  adopted  an  Employee  Share
Option Plan for our Israeli employees, officers, directors and consultants, and an Employee Share Option Plan for our U.S. employees, officers, directors and
consultants. The terms of the 1999 Plans are substantially the same as those of the 1997 Plans, but have reduced the exercise period of options from 10 to 7
years. The board has the ability to grant options with longer or shorter terms. The terms of the 1999 Plans have been modified slightly since they were adopted
and, in 2003, the Israeli Plan was changed to conform to amendments to the Israeli Income Tax law. As of December 31, 2008, options to purchase a total of
4,976,067 shares are outstanding under the 1997 and 1999 Israeli Plans and options to purchase a total of 1,380,470 shares are outstanding under the 1997 U.S.
Plan. As of December 31, 2008, the 1997 and 1999 Israeli Plans and the 1997 U.S. Plans have expired and we will no longer make any grants under these
plans.

87

 
 
The  holders  of  options  under  all  of  the  plans  are  responsible  for  all  personal  tax  consequences  relating  to  the  options.  The  exercise  prices  of  the
options are based on the fair value of the ordinary shares at the time of grant as determined by our board of directors. The current practice of our board of
directors is to grant options with exercise prices that equal 100% of the closing price of our ordinary shares on the applicable date of grant.

ITEM 7.

MAJOR SHAREHOLDERS AND RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS

A.

MAJOR SHAREHOLDERS

To our knowledge, (A) we are not directly or indirectly owned or controlled (i) by another corporation or (ii) by any foreign government and (B) there
are no arrangements, the operation of which may at a subsequent date result in a change in control of AudioCodes. The following table sets forth, as of June 15,
2010, the number of our ordinary shares, which constitute our only outstanding voting securities, beneficially owned by (i) all shareholders known to us to own
more than 5% of our outstanding ordinary shares, and (ii) all of our directors and senior executive officers as a group. 

Identity of Person or Group

Amount Owned

Percent of Class

Shabtai Adlersberg(1)
Leon Bialik(2)
Rima Management, LLC(3)
All directors and senior executive officers as a group (11 persons)(4)

5,850,090     
4,079,322     
2,978,592     
6,669,024     

14.4%
10.1%
7.4%
16.4%

(1)

(2)

(3)

(4)

Includes options to purchase 275,000 shares, exercisable within sixty days of June 15, 2010 and 2,514 restricted shares units that vest within sixty
days of June 15, 2010.
The information  is  derived  from  a  statement  on  Schedule  13G/A,  dated  February  8,  2010  of  Leon  Bialik  filed  with  the  Securities  and  Exchange
Commission.
The information is derived from a statement on Schedule 13G, dated February 16, 2010, of Rima Management, LLC and Richard Mashaal filed with
the Securities and Exchange Commission.
Includes 1,096,448 ordinary shares which may be purchased pursuant to options exercisable  within sixty days following June 15, 2010 and restricted
shares units that vest within 60 days of June 15, 2010.

Mr. Adlersberg held 14.4% of our ordinary shares as of December 31, 2009, as compared to 14.3% of our ordinary shares as of December 31, 2008

and 13.9% of our ordinary shares as of December 31, 2007.

88

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
   
   
   
 
 
 
 
Mr. Bialik held 10.1% of our ordinary shares as of December 31, 2009 as compared to 10.2% of our ordinary shares as of December 31, 2008 and

9.8% of our ordinary shares as of December 31, 2007.

Rima Management, LLC held 7.4% of our ordinary shares as of December 31, 2009 as compared to 7.2% of our ordinary shares as of December 31,

2008 and less than 5.0% of our ordinary shares as of December 31, 2007.

As of June 15, 2010, there were approximately 21 holders of record of our ordinary shares in the United States, although we believe that the number
of beneficial owners of the ordinary shares is significantly greater. The number of record holders in the United States is not representative of the number of
beneficial holders nor is it representative of where such beneficial holders are resident since many of these ordinary shares were held of record by brokers or
other nominees.

The major shareholders have the same voting rights as the other shareholders.

B.

RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS

None.

C.

INTERESTS OF EXPERTS AND COUNSEL

Not applicable.

ITEM 8.

FINANCIAL INFORMATION

A.

Consolidated Statements and Other Financial Information

See Item 18.

Legal Proceedings

For a discussion of our legal proceedings, please see “Item 4B-Information on the Company-Business Overview-Legal Proceedings.”

Dividend Policy

For a discussion of our dividend policy, please see “Item 10B-Additional Information-Memorandum and Articles of Association-Dividends.”

B.

Significant Changes

No significant change has occurred since December 31, 2009, except as otherwise disclosed in this Annual Report.

89

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
ITEM 9.

THE OFFER AND LISTING

A.

OFFER AND LISTING DETAILS

Our ordinary shares are listed on the Nasdaq Global Select Market and The Tel Aviv Stock Exchange under the symbol “AUDC.”

The following table sets forth, for the periods indicated, the high and low sales prices of our ordinary shares as reported by the Nasdaq Global Select

Market.

Calendar Year

2009
2008
2007
2006
2005

Calendar Period

2010

2009

2008

Second quarter (through June 15, 2010)
First quarter

Fourth quarter
Third quarter
Second quarter
First quarter

Fourth quarter
Third quarter
Second quarter
First quarter

Price Per Share

High

Low

3.06    $
5.26    $
10.40    $
14.64    $
17.00    $

Price Per Share

High

Low

4.39    $
4.17    $

3.06    $
2.40    $
1.60    $
1.90    $

2.63    $
4.42    $
4.73    $
5.26    $

0.92 
1.47 
4.55 
8.77 
8.67 

2.43 
2.65 

1.94 
1.37 
1.16 
0.92 

1.47 
2.31 
3.62 
2.50 

  $
  $
  $
  $
  $

  $
  $

  $
  $
  $
  $

  $
  $
  $
  $

90

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
     
 
 
   
      
  
   
      
  
   
      
  
 
Calendar Month

2010

May
April
March
February
January

2009

December

Price Per Share

High

Low

  $
  $
  $
  $
  $

  $

3.80    $
4.39    $
4.17    $
3.58    $
3.50    $

2.90    $

2.43 
3.80 
3.50 
3.04 
2.65 

2.38 

The  following  table  sets  forth,  for  the  periods  indicated,  the  high  and  low  sales  prices  of  our  ordinary  shares  as  reported  by  The  Tel  Aviv  Stock
Exchange. All share prices shown in the following table are in NIS. As of December 31, 2009, the exchange rate was equal to approximately NIS 3.775 per
U.S. $1.00.

Calendar Year

2009 
2008
2007
2006
2005

Calendar Period
2010

Second quarter (through June 15, 2010)
First quarter

2009

2008

Fourth quarter
Third quarter
Second quarter
First quarter

Fourth quarter
Third quarter
Second quarter
First quarter

Price Per Share

High

Low

NIS 11.55     
NIS 20.20   
NIS 44.00   
NIS 66.27   
NIS 73.80   

Price Per Share

NIS 16.05   
NIS 15.25   

NIS 11.55   
NIS 8.30   
NIS 6.64   
NIS 7.33   

NIS 9.20   
NIS 15.22   
NIS 15.62   
NIS 20.20   

NIS 4.26 
NIS 5.71 
NIS 18.90 
NIS 38.10 
NIS 40.20 

NIS 9.20 
NIS 9.50 

NIS 7.61 
NIS 5.50 
NIS 4.70 
NIS 4.26 

NIS 5.72 
NIS 8.46 
NIS 12.14 
NIS 10.81 

91

 
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
     
 
 
   
      
  
   
      
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
      
  
 
 
   
      
  
 
 
 
 
   
      
  
 
 
 
 
 
Calendar Month

2010

2009

May
April
March
February
January

December

B.

PLAN OF DISTRIBUTION

Not applicable.

C.

MARKETS

Price Per Share

High

Low

NIS 14.65   
NIS 16.05   
NIS 15.25   
NIS 13.60   
NIS 12.88   

NIS 9.20 
NIS 14.30 
NIS 13.01 
NIS 11.40 
NIS 9.50 

NIS 10.74   

NIS 8.93 

Our  ordinary  shares  are  listed  for  trading  on  the  Nasdaq  Global  Select  Market  under  the  symbol  “AUDC”.  Our  ordinary  shares  are  also  listed  for
trading on The Tel-Aviv Stock Exchange under the symbol “AUDC”. In addition, we are aware of our ordinary shares being traded on the following markets:
Frankfurt Stock Exchange, Berlin Stock Exchange, Munich Stock Exchange and XETRA.

D.

SELLING SHAREHOLDERS

Not applicable.

E.

DILUTION

Not applicable.

92

 
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
      
  
 
 
 
 
 
   
      
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
F.

EXPENSES OF THE ISSUE

Not applicable.

ITEM 10.

ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

A.

SHARE CAPITAL

Not applicable.

B.

MEMORANDUM AND ARTICLES OF ASSOCIATION

Objects and Purposes

We were incorporated in 1992 under the laws of the State of Israel. Our registration number with the Israeli Registrar of Companies is 520044132.

Our objects and purposes, set forth in Section 2 of our memorandum of association, are:

to plan, develop and market voice signal systems;

to purchase, import, market and wholesale and retail distribute, in Israel and abroad, consumption goods and accompanying products;

to serve as representatives of bodies, entrepreneurs and companies from Israel and abroad with respect to their activities in Israel and abroad;
and

to carry out any activity as determined by the lawful management.

·

·

·

·

Share Capital

Our authorized share capital consists of NIS 1,025,000 divided into 100,000,000 ordinary shares, nominal value NIS 0.01 per share, and 2,500,000 preferred
shares, nominal value NIS 0.01 per share.  As of June 15, 2010, we had 40,492,225 ordinary shares outstanding and no preferred shares outstanding.

Borrowing Powers

The board of directors has the power to cause us to borrow money and to secure the payment of borrowed money. The board of directors specifically

has the power to issue bonds or debentures, and to impose mortgages or other security interests on all or any part of our property.

Amendment of Articles of Association

Shareholders  may  amend  our  articles  of  association  by  a  resolution  adopted  at  a  shareholders  meeting  by  the  holders  of  50%  of  voting  power

represented at the meeting in person or by proxy and voting thereon.

93

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Dividends

Under the Israeli Companies Law, we may pay dividends only out of our profits. The amount of any dividend to be distributed among shareholders is
based  on  the  nominal  value  of  their  shares.  Our  board  of  directors  has  determined  that  we  will  not  distribute  any  amounts  of  our  undistributed  tax  exempt
income as dividend. We intend to reinvest our tax-exempt income and not to distribute such income as a dividend.  Accordingly, no deferred income taxes have
been provided on income attributable to our Approved Enterprise program as the undistributed tax exempt income is essentially permanent in duration.

Voting Rights and Powers

Unless any shares have special rights as to voting, every shareholder has one vote for each share held of record. A shareholder is not entitled to vote at
any shareholders meeting unless all calls then payable by him in respect of his shares have been paid (this does not apply to separate meetings of the holders of
a particular class of shares with respect to the modification or abrogation of their rights).

Under our articles of association, we may issue preferred shares from time to time, in one or more series. However, in connection with our listing on
The Tel-Aviv Stock Exchange in 2001, we agreed that for such time as our ordinary shares are traded on The Tel-Aviv Stock Exchange, we will not issue any
of the 2,500,000 preferred shares, nominal value NIS 0.01, authorized in our articles of association. Notwithstanding the foregoing, we may issue preferred
shares if the preference of those shares is limited to a preference in the distribution of dividends and such preferred shares have no voting rights.

Business Combinations

Our articles of association impose restrictions on our ability to engage in any merger, asset or share sale or other similar transaction with a shareholder

holding 15% or more of our voting shares.

Winding Up

Upon our liquidation, our assets available for distribution to shareholders will be distributed to them in proportion to the nominal value of their shares.

Redeemable Shares

Subject to our undertaking to the Tel-Aviv Stock Exchange as described above, we may issue and redeem redeemable shares.

Modification of Rights

Subject to the provisions of our memorandum of association, and without prejudice to any special rights previously conferred upon the holders of our
existing shares, we may, from time to time, by a resolution approved by the holders of 75% voting power represented at the meeting in person or by proxy and
voting thereon, provide for shares with such preferred or deferred rights or rights of redemption, or other special rights and/or such restrictions, whether in
regard to dividends, voting repayment of share capital or otherwise, as may be stipulated in such resolution.

94

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
If at any time our share capital is divided into different classes of shares, we may modify or abrogate the rights attached to any class, unless otherwise
provided by the articles of association, by a resolution approved by the holders of 75% voting power represented at the meeting in person or by proxy and
voting thereon, subject to the consent in writing of the holders of 75% of the issued shares of that class.

The provisions of our articles of association relating to general meetings also apply to any separate general meeting of the holders of the shares of a
particular class, except that two or more members holding not less than 75% of the issued shares of that class must be present in person or by proxy at that
separate general meeting for a quorum to exist.

Unless otherwise provided by our articles of association, the increase of an authorized class of shares, or the issuance of additional shares thereof out
of the authorized and unissued share capital, shall not be deemed to modify or abrogate the rights attached to previously issued shares of that class or of any
other class.

Shareholders Meetings

An annual meeting of shareholders is to be held once a year, within 15 months after the previous annual meeting. The annual meeting may be held in

Israel or outside of Israel, as determined by the board of directors.

The  board  of  directors  may,  whenever  it  thinks  fit,  convene  a  special  shareholders  meeting.  The  board  of  directors  must  convene  a  special

shareholders meeting at the request of:

·
·
·

at least two directors;
at least one-quarter of the directors in office; or
one  or  more  shareholders  who  hold  at  least  5%  of  the  outstanding  share  capital  and  at  least  1%  of  the  voting  rights,  or  one  or  more
shareholders who hold at least 5% of the outstanding voting rights.

A special shareholders meeting may be held in Israel or outside of Israel, as determined by the board of directors.

Notice of General Meetings; Omission to Give Notice

The provisions of the Companies Law and the related regulations override the provisions of our articles of association, and provide for notice of a
meeting of shareholders to be sent to each registered shareholder at least 21 days or 35 days in advance of the meeting depending on the items included in the
meeting  agenda.    Notice  of  a  meeting  of  shareholders  must  also  be  published  in  two  Israeli  newspapers  at  least  five  days  prior  to  the  record  date  for  the
meeting.

Notice  of  a  meeting  of  shareholders  must  specify  the  type  of  meeting,  the  place  and  time  of  the  meeting,  the  agenda,  a  summary  of  the  proposed
resolutions, the majority required to adopt the proposed resolutions, and the record date for the meeting. The notice must also include the address and telephone
number of our registered office, and a list of times at which the full text of the proposed resolutions may be examined at the registered office.

95

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
The accidental omission to give notice of a meeting to any shareholder, or the non-receipt of notice sent to such shareholder, does not invalidate the

proceedings at the meeting.

Limitations on Foreign Shareholders to Hold or Exercise Voting Rights

There are no limitations on foreign shareholders in our articles of association. Israeli law restricts the ability of citizens of countries that are in a state

of war with Israel to hold shares of Israeli companies.

Fiduciary Duties; Approval of Transactions under Israeli Law

The  Companies  Law  imposes  fiduciary  duties  that  “office  holders,”  including  directors  and  executive  officers,  owe  to  their  company.  An  office

holder’s fiduciary duties consist of a duty of care and a duty of loyalty.

Duty of care. The duty of care generally requires an office holder to act with the level of care which a reasonable office holder in the same position
would have acted under the same circumstances. This includes the duty to use reasonable means to obtain information regarding the advisability of a given
action submitted for his or her approval or performed by virtue of his or her position and all other relevant information material to these actions.

Duty of loyalty. The duty of loyalty generally requires an office holder to act in good faith and for the benefit of the company. Specifically, an office
holder must avoid any conflict of interest between the office holder’s position in the company and his or her other positions or personal affairs. In addition, an
office holder must avoid competing against the company or exploiting any business opportunity of the company for his or her own benefit or the benefit of
others. An office holder must also disclose to the company any information or documents relating to the company’s affairs that the office holder has received
due to his or her position in the company. A company may approve any of the acts mentioned above provided that all the following conditions apply: the office
holder acted in good faith and neither the act nor the approval of the act prejudices the good of the company, and the office holder disclosed the essence of his
or her personal interest in the act, including any substantial fact or document, a reasonable time before the date for discussion of the approval.

The term “office holder” includes any person who, either formally or in substance, serves as a director, general manager or chief executive officer, or
who  reports  directly  to  the  general  manager  or  chief  executive  officer.  Each  person  listed  in  the  table  under  “Item  6.  Directors,  Senior  Management  and
Employees—A. Directors and Senior Management” above is an “office holder” of AudioCodes.

Compensation. Under the Companies Law, all arrangements as to compensation of office holders who are not directors require approval of the board
of directors and, in certain cases, the prior approval of the audit committee. Arrangements as to compensation of directors also require audit committee and
shareholder approval.

96

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Disclosure of personal interest. The Companies Law requires that an office holder promptly disclose any personal interest that he or she may have,
and all related material information known to him or her, in connection with any existing or proposed transaction by the company. A “personal interest” of an
office holder, as defined in the Companies Law, includes a personal interest of the office holder’s relative or a corporation in which the office holder or the
office  holder’s  relative  is  a  5%  or  greater  shareholder,  director  or  general  manager  or  has  the  right  to  appoint  at  least  one  director  or  the  general  manager.
“Personal interest” does not apply to a personal interest stemming merely from holding shares in the company.

The office holder must make the disclosure of his personal interest no later than the first meeting of the company’s board of directors that discusses
the particular transaction. The office holder’s duty to disclose shall not apply in the event that the personal interest only results from a personal interest of the
office holder’s relative in a transaction that is not an “extraordinary transaction”. The Companies Law defines an “extraordinary transaction” as a transaction
not  in  the  ordinary  course  of  business,  not  on  market  terms,  or  likely  to  have  a  material  impact  on  the  company’s  profitability,  assets  or  liabilities,  and  a
"relative" as a spouse, sibling, parent, grandparent, descendent, spouse's descendant and the spouse of any of the foregoing.

Approvals.  For  a  transaction  that  is  not  an  extraordinary  transaction,  under  the  Companies  Law,  once  the  office  holder  complies  with  the  above
disclosure  requirement,  the  board  of  directors  is  authorized  to  approve  the  transaction,  unless  the  articles  of  association  provide  otherwise.  Our  articles  of
association  do  not  provide  otherwise.  Such  approval  must  determine  that  the  transaction  is  not  adverse  to  the  company’s  interest.  If  the  transaction  is  an
extraordinary transaction, or if it concerns exculpation, indemnification or insurance of an office holder, then it also must be approved by the company’s audit
committee  and  board  of  directors,  and,  under  certain  circumstances,  by  the  shareholders  of  the  company. An  office  holder  who  has  a  personal  interest  in  a
matter that is considered at a meeting of the board of directors or the audit committee generally may not be present at this meeting or vote on this matter unless
a majority of the board of directors or the audit committee has a personal interest in the matter.  If a majority of the board of directors or the audit committee
has a personal interest in the transaction, shareholder approval also would be required.

Duties of Shareholders

Under the Companies Law, the disclosure requirements that apply to an office holder also apply to a controlling shareholder of a public company. A
controlling shareholder is a shareholder who has the ability to direct the activities of a company, including a shareholder that owns 25% or more of the voting
rights if no other shareholder owns more than 50% of the voting rights, but excluding a shareholder whose power derives solely from his or her position on the
board  of  directors  or  any  other  position  with  the  company.  Two  or  more  shareholders  with  a  personal  interest  in  the  approval  of  the  same  transaction  are
deemed to be one shareholder for the purpose of being a “controlling shareholder.”

97

 
 
 
 
 
 
Approval of the audit committee, the board of directors and our shareholders, in that order, is required for:

·

·

extraordinary transactions, including a private placement, with a controlling shareholder or in which a controlling shareholder has a personal
interest; and
the terms of compensation or employment of a controlling shareholder or his or her relative, as an officer holder or employee of our company.

The shareholders approval must include the majority of shares voted at the meeting.  In addition to the majority vote, the shareholder approval must

satisfy either of two additional tests:

·
·

the majority includes at least one-third of the shares voted by shareholders who have no personal interest in the transaction; or
the total number of shares, other than shares held by the disinterested shareholders, that voted against the approval of the transaction does not
exceed 1% of the aggregate voting rights of our company.

Under the Companies Law, a shareholder has a duty to act in good faith and in a customary manner towards the company and other shareholders, and
to  refrain  from  abusing  his  or  her  power  in  the  company,  including  when  voting  in  a  shareholders  meeting  or  in  a  class  meeting  on  matters  such  as  the
following:

·
·
·
·

an amendment to our articles of association;
an increase in our authorized share capital;
a merger; or
approval of related party transactions that require shareholder approval.

In addition, any controlling shareholder, any shareholder who knows that he or she possesses the power to determine the outcome of a shareholders
meeting or a shareholders class meeting and any shareholder who has the power to prevent the appointment of an office holder, is under a duty to act with
fairness towards the company.  The Companies Law does not define the substance of this duty of fairness, except to state that the remedies generally available
upon a breach of contract will also apply in the event of a breach of the duty to act with fairness, taking into account the position in the company of those who
breached the duty of fairness.

Anti-Takeover Provisions Under Israeli Law

The  Companies  Law  provides  that  an  acquisition  of  shares  in  a  public  company  must  be  made  by  means  of  a  tender  offer  if  as  a  result  of  the
acquisition the purchaser would hold 25% or more of the voting rights in the company, unless there is already another shareholder of the company with 25% or
more of the voting rights.  Similarly, the Companies Law provides that an acquisition of shares in a public company must be made by means of a tender offer if
as a result of the acquisition the purchaser would hold more than 45% of the voting rights in the company, unless there is a shareholder with more than 45% of
the voting rights in the company.

The Companies Law requires the parties to a proposed merger to file a merger proposal with the Israeli Registrar of Companies, specifying certain
terms of the transaction.  Each merging company's board of directors and shareholders must approve the merger.  Shares in one of the merging companies held
by  the  other  merging  company  or  certain  of  its  affiliates  are  disenfranchised  for  purposes  of  voting  on  the  merger.   A  merging  company  must  inform  its
creditors of the proposed merger.  Any creditor of a party to the merger may seek a court order blocking the merger, if there is a reasonable concern that the
surviving company will not be able to satisfy all of the obligations of the parties to the merger.  Moreover, a merger may not be completed until at least 50 days
have passed from the time that the merger proposal was filed with the Israeli Registrar of Companies and at least 30 days have passed from the approval of the
shareholders of each of the merging companies.

98

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Finally,  in  general,  Israeli  tax  law  treats  stock-for-stock  acquisitions  less  favorably  than  does  U.S.  tax  law.    Israeli  tax  law  has  been  amended  to
provide for tax deferral in specified acquisitions, including transactions where the consideration for the sale of shares is the receipt of shares of the acquiring
company.  Nevertheless, Israeli tax law may subject a shareholder who exchanges his ordinary shares for shares in a foreign corporation to immediate taxation
or to taxation before his investment in the foreign corporation becomes liquid, although in the case of shares of a foreign corporation that are traded on a stock
exchange, the tax may be postponed subject to certain conditions.

Insurance, Indemnification and Exculpation of Directors and Officers; Limitations on Liability

Insurance of Office Holders

The Companies Law permits a company, if permitted by its articles of association, to insure an office holder in respect of liabilities incurred by the

office holder as a result of:

·
·

the breach of his or her duty of care to the company or to another person, or
the breach of his or her duty of loyalty to the company, to the extent that the office holder acted in good faith and had reasonable cause to
believe that the act would not prejudice the company.

A company can also insure an office holder against monetary liabilities imposed on the office holder in favor of a third party as a result of an act or omission
that the office holder committed in connection with his or her serving as an office holder.

Indemnification of Office Holders

Under the Companies Law, a company can, if permitted by its articles of association, indemnify an office holder for any of the following obligations

or expenses incurred in connection with his or her acts or omissions as an office holder:

· monetary  liability  imposed  upon  the  office  holder  in  favor  of  other  persons  pursuant  to  a  court  judgment,  including  a  settlement  or  an

·

arbitrator’s decision approved by a court;
reasonable litigation expenses, including attorney’s fees, incurred by the office holder as a result of an investigation or proceeding instituted
against  the  office  holder  by  a  competent  authority,  provided  that  such  investigation  or  proceeding  concluded  without  the  filing  of  an
indictment against the office holder; and either:

99

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
o
o

no financial liability was imposed on the office holder in lieu of criminal proceedings, or
financial liability was imposed on the office holder in lieu of criminal proceedings but the alleged criminal offense does not require
proof of criminal intent, and

·

reasonable litigation expenses, including attorneys’ fees, actually incurred by the office holder or imposed upon the office holder by a court:

·
·
·

in an action brought against the office holder by the company, on behalf of the company or on behalf of a third party;
in a criminal action in which the office holder is found innocent; or
in a criminal action in which the office holder is convicted but in which proof of criminal intent is not required.

A company may indemnify an office holder in respect of these liabilities either in advance of an event or following an event.  If a company undertakes
to indemnify an office holder in advance of an event, the indemnification, other than legal costs, must be limited to foreseeable events in light of the company’s
actual activities when the company undertook such indemnification, and reasonable amounts or standards, as determined by the board of directors.

Exculpation of Office Holders

Under the Companies Law, a company may, if permitted by its articles of association, also exculpate an office holder in advance, in whole or in part,

from liability for damages sustained by a breach of duty of care to the company, other than in connection with distributions.

Limitations on Exculpation, Insurance and Indemnification

Under the Companies Law, a company may indemnify or insure an office holder against a breach of duty of loyalty only to the extent that the office
holder acted in good faith and had reasonable grounds to assume that the action would not prejudice the company.  In addition, a company may not indemnify,
insure or exculpate an office holder against a breach of duty of care if committed intentionally or recklessly (excluding mere negligence), or committed with
the intent to derive an unlawful personal gain, or for a fine or forfeit levied against the office holder in connection with a criminal offense.

Our articles of association allow us to insure, indemnify and exculpate office holders to the fullest extent permitted by law, provided such insurance or
indemnification  is  approved  in  accordance  with  law.    Pursuant  to  the  Companies  Law,  exculpation  of,  procurement  of  insurance  coverage  for,  and  an
undertaking to indemnify or indemnification of, our office holders must be approved by our audit committee and our board of directors and, if the office holder
is a director, also by our shareholders.

We have entered into agreements with each of our directors and senior officers to insure, indemnify and exculpate them to the full extent permitted by
law against some types of claims, subject to dollar limits and other limitations. These agreements have been ratified by our audit committee, board of directors
and  shareholders.  We  have  acquired  directors’  and  officers’  liability  insurance  covering  our  officers  and  directors  and  the  officers  and  directors  of  our
subsidiaries against certain claims.

100

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
C.

MATERIAL CONTRACTS

In April 2008, we entered into a loan agreement with First International Bank of Israel that provides for borrowings in the aggregate amount of $15
million. The loan bears interest at LIBOR plus 1.5% with respect to $11.5 million of the loan and LIBOR plus 0.65% with respect to the remaining amount of
$3.5 million of the loan. The principal amount borrowed is repayable in 20 equal quarterly payments through April 2013. The bank has a lien on our assets and
we are required to maintain $3.5 million of compensating balances with the bank.  The agreement requires us, among other things, to maintain shareholders'
equity at specified levels and to achieve certain levels of operating income. The agreement also restricts us from paying dividends.

In July 2008, we entered into a loan agreement with Mizrachi Tfachot Bank that provides for borrowings in the aggregate amount of $15 million. The
loan bears interest at LIBOR plus 1.3% with respect to $11.5 million of the loan and LIBOR plus 0.50% with respect to the remaining amount of $3.5 million
of the loan. The bank has a lien on our assets and we are required to maintain $3.5 million of compensating balances with the bank. The other terms of the loan
with  Mizrachi  Tfachot  Bank  are  the  same  as  the  loan  agreement  with  First  International  Bank  described  in  the  preceding  paragraph.  Mizrachi  and  First
International share the lien on our assets.

D.

EXCHANGE CONTROLS

Non-residents of Israel who own our ordinary shares may freely convert all amounts received in Israeli currency in respect of such ordinary shares,
whether as a dividend, liquidation distribution or as proceeds from the sale of the ordinary shares, into freely-repatriable non-Israeli currencies at the rate of
exchange prevailing at the time of conversion (provided in each case that the applicable Israeli income tax, if any, is paid or withheld).

Since  January  1,  2003,  all  exchange  control  restrictions  on  transactions  in  foreign  currency  in  Israel  have  been  eliminated,  although  there  are  still
reporting  requirements  for  foreign  currency  transactions.    Legislation  remains  in  effect,  however,  pursuant  to  which  currency  controls  may  be  imposed  by
administrative action at any time.

The  State  of  Israel  does  not  restrict  in  any  way  the  ownership  or  voting  of  our  ordinary  shares  by  non-residents  of  Israel,  except  with  respect  to

subjects of countries that are in a state of war with Israel.

E

TAXATION

The following is a summary of the material Israeli and United States federal tax consequences, Israeli foreign exchange regulations and certain Israeli
government  programs  affecting  us.  To  the  extent  that  the  discussion  is  based  on  new  tax  or  other  legislation  that  has  not  been  subject  to  judicial  or
administrative interpretation, there can be no assurance that the views expressed in the discussion will be accepted by the tax or other authorities in question.
The discussion is not intended, and should not be construed, as legal or professional tax advice, is not exhaustive of all possible tax considerations and should
not be relied upon for tax planning purposes. Potential investors are urged to consult their own tax advisors as to the Israeli tax, United States federal income
tax and other tax consequences of the purchase, ownership and disposition of ordinary shares, including, in particular, the effect of any foreign, state or local
taxes.

101

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Israeli Tax Considerations

General Corporate Tax Structure

Generally,  Israeli  companies  are  subject  to  corporate  tax  on  taxable  income  at  the  rate  of  26%  for  the  2009  tax  year.  Following  an  amendment  to  the
Israeli    Income  Tax  Ordinance  (new  version)  1961  (the  “Tax  ordinance”),  which  came  into  effect  on  January  1,  2006,  the  corporate  tax  rate  in  Israel  is
scheduled to decrease as follows:  25% for the 2010 tax year and thereafter. Israeli companies are generally subject to capital gains tax at a rate of 25% for
capital  gains  (other  than  the  gains  deriving  from  the  sale  of  listed  securities)  derived  after  January  1,  2003.  In  July  2009,  Israel's  Parliament  (the  Knesset)
passed the Economic Efficiency Law (Amended Legislation for Implementing the Economic Plan for 2009 and 2010), 2009, which prescribes, among other
things, an additional gradual reduction in the Israeli corporate tax rate and real capital gains tax rate starting from 2011 to the following tax rates: 2011 - 24%,
2012 - 23%, 2013 - - 22%, 2014 - 21%, 2015 - 20%, 2016 and thereafter - 18%. However, the effective tax rate payable by us that derives income from an
approved or privileged enterprise may be considerably less.

Following an Ordinance, which came into effect on January 1, 2009, an Israeli corporation may elect a 5% rate of corporate tax (instead of 25%) for dividend
distributions received from a foreign subsidiary which is used in Israel in 2009, or within one year after actual receipt of the dividend, whichever is later. The
5% tax rate is subject to various conditions, which include conditions with regard to the identity of the corporation that distributes the dividends, the source of
the dividend, the nature of the use of the dividend income, and the period during which the dividend income will be used in Israel.

Tax Benefits Under the Law for the Encouragement of Capital Investments, 1959

Our facilities have been granted approved enterprise status pursuant to the Law for the Encouragement of Capital Investments, 1959 or the Investment

Law, which provides certain tax and financial benefits to investment programs that have been granted such status.

The Investment Law provides that a proposed capital investment in eligible facilities may be designated as an “approved enterprise.” Until 2005, the
designation required advance approval from the Investment Center of the Israel Ministry of Industry, Trade and Labor (the Investment Center). Each certificate
of approval for an approved enterprise relates to a specific investment program delineated both by its financial scope, including its capital sources, and by its
physical  characteristics,  such  as  the  equipment  to  be  purchased  and  utilized  pursuant  to  the  program.  The  tax  benefits  under  the  Investment  Law  are  not
available for income derived from products manufactured outside of Israel.

102

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
A  company  owning  an  approved  enterprise  may  elect  to  receive  either  governmental  grants  or  an  alternative  package  of  tax  benefits.  Under  the
alternative package, a company’s undistributed income derived from an approved enterprise will be exempt from corporate tax for a period of two to ten years
(depending  on  the  geographic  location  of  the  approved  enterprise  within  Israel).    The  exemption  commences  in  the  first  year  of  taxable  income,  and  the
company is taxed at a reduced corporate rate of 10% to 25% for the following five to eight years, depending on the extent of foreign shareholders’ ownership
of the company’s ordinary shares. The benefits period is limited to twelve years from completion of the investment under the approved plan or fourteen years
from  the  date  of  approval,  whichever  is  earlier  (these  limits  do  not  apply  to  the  exemption  period).   A  Foreign  Investors  Company,  or  FIC,  defined  in  the
Investment Law as a company of which more than 25% of its shareholders are non-Israeli residents, may enjoy benefits for a period of up to ten years, or
twelve  years  if  it  complies  with  certain  export  criteria  stipulated  in  the  Investment  Law  (the  actual  length  of  the  benefits  period  is  graduated  based  on  the
percentage of foreign ownership).

We have elected the alternative package of tax exemptions and reduced tax rates for our production facilities that have received Approved Enterprise
status. Accordingly, income derived from these facilities is generally entitled to a tax-exemption period of two years and a reduced corporate tax rate of 10% to
25%  for  an  additional  period  of  five  to  eight  years,  based  on  our  percentage  of  foreign  investment.  The  tax  benefits  for  our  existing  Approved  Enterprise
programs are scheduled to gradually expire by 2017. The period of tax benefits for each capital investment plan expires upon the earlier of: (1) twelve years
from completion of the investment under the approved plan, or (2) fourteen years from receipt of approval (these limits do not apply to the exemption period).

Out of our retained earnings as of December 31, 2009, approximately $540,000 are tax-exempt. If we were to distribute this tax-exempt income before
our complete liquidation, it would be taxed at the reduced corporate tax rate applicable to these profits (10% to 25%), and an income tax liability of up to
approximately $135,000 would be incurred. Our board of directors has currently determined that we will not distribute any amounts of our undistributed tax
exempt income as dividend. We intend to reinvest our tax-exempt income and not to distribute such income as a dividend. Accordingly, no deferred income
taxes have been provided on income attributable to our Approved Enterprise.

If we fail to meet the requirements of an Approved Enterprise we would be subject to corporate tax in Israel at the regular statutory rate. We could

also be required to refund tax benefits, with interest and adjustments for inflation based on the Israeli consumer price index.

The tax benefits derived from any certificate of approval relate only to taxable income attributable to the specific approved enterprise. If a company
has  more  than  one  approval  or  only  a  portion  of  its  capital  investments  are  approved,  its  effective  tax  rate  is  the  result  of  a  weighted  combination  of  the
applicable rates.

103

 
 
 
 
 
 
Our production facilities have been granted the status of approved enterprise. Income arising from our approved enterprise facilities is tax-free under
the alternative package of benefits described above and entitled to reduced tax rates based on the level of foreign ownership for specified periods. We have
derived, and expect to continue to derive, a substantial portion of our operating income from our approved enterprise facilities. The tax benefits attributable to
our current approved enterprises are scheduled to expire gradually until 2017.

Distribution  of  earnings  derived  from  approved  enterprise  which  were  previously  taxed  at  reduced  tax  rates,  would  not  result  in  additional  tax
consequences to us.  However, if retained tax-exempt income is distributed in a manner, we would be taxed at the reduced corporate tax rate applicable to such
profits (between 10%-25%).  We are not obliged to distribute exempt retained earnings under the alternative package of benefits, and may generally decide
from which source of income to declare dividends. We currently intend to reinvest the amount of our tax-exempt income and not to distribute such income as a
dividend.  Dividends from approved enterprises are generally taxed at a rate of 15% (which is withheld and paid by the company paying the dividend) if such
dividend is distributed during the benefits period or within twelve years thereafter. The twelve-year limitation does not apply to an FIC.

In addition, the benefits available to an approved enterprise are conditional upon the fulfillment of conditions stipulated in the Investment Law and
related regulations and the criteria set forth in the specific certificate of approval. In the event that a company does not meet these conditions, it will be subject
to  corporate  tax  at  the  rate  then  in  effect  under  Israeli  law  for  such  tax  year.    As  of  December  31,  2009,  management  believes  that  we  meet  all  of  the
aforementioned conditions.

On  April  1,  2005,  an  amendment  to  the  law  came  into  effect  (the  “Amendment”)  and  has  significantly  changed  the  provisions  of  the  law.  The
Amendment limits the scope of enterprises which may be approved by the Investment Center by setting criteria for the approval of a facility as a Beneficiary
Enterprise,  such  as  provisions  generally  requiring  that  at  least  25%  of  the  Privileged  Enterprise’s  income  will  be  derived  from  export.  Additionally,  the
Amendment enacted major changes in the manner in which tax benefits are awarded under the law so that companies no longer require Investment Center
approval in order to qualify for tax benefits.

Tax benefits are available under the 2005 Amendment to production facilities (or other eligible facilities), which are generally required to derive more
than 25% of their business income from export. In order to receive the tax benefits, the 2005 Amendment states that a company must make an investment in
the Beneficiary Enterprise exceeding a certain percentage or a minimum amount specified in the Investments Law. Such investment may be made over a period
of no more than three years ending at the end of the year in which the company requested to have the tax benefits apply to the Beneficiary Enterprise, or the
Year of Election. Where the company requests to have the tax benefits apply to an expansion of existing facilities, then only the expansion will be considered a
Beneficiary  Enterprise  and  the  company’s  effective  tax  rate  will  be  the  result  of  a  weighted  average  of  the  applicable  rates.  In  this  case,  the  minimum
investment  required  in  order  to  qualify  as  a  Beneficiary  Enterprise  is  required  to  exceed  a  certain  percentage  or  a  minimum  amount  of  the  company’s
production assets at the end of the year before the expansion.

104

 
 
 
 
 
 
The duration of tax benefits is subject to a limitation of the earlier of seven to ten years from the Commencement Year, or twelve years from the first
day of the Year of Election. The Commencement Year is defined as the later of (a) the first tax year in which a company had derived income for tax purposes
from the Beneficiary Enterprise or (b) the year in which a company requested to have the tax benefits apply to the Beneficiary Enterprise – Year of Election.
The tax benefits granted to a Beneficiary Enterprise are determined, as applicable to its geographic location within Israel, according to one of the following
new tax routes, which may be applicable to us:

·

·

Similar to the currently available alternative route, exemption from corporate tax on undistributed income for a period of two to ten years,
depending on the geographic location of the Beneficiary Enterprise within Israel, and a reduced corporate tax rate of 10% to 25% for the
remainder of the benefits period, depending on the level of foreign investment in each year.  Benefits may be granted for a term of seven to
ten years, depending  on  the  level  of  foreign  investment  in  the  company.  If  the  company  pays  a  dividend  out  of  income  derived  from  the
Beneficiary Enterprise during the tax exemption period, such income will be subject to corporate tax at the applicable rate (10%-25%) in
respect of the gross amount of the dividend that we may be distributed. The company is required to withhold tax at the source at a rate of
15% from any dividends distributed from income derived from the Beneficiary Enterprise; and

A special tax route, which enables companies owning facilities in certain geographical locations in Israel to pay corporate tax at the rate of
11.5% on income of the Beneficiary Enterprise. The benefits period is ten years. Upon payment of dividends, the company is required to
withhold tax at source at a rate of 15% for Israeli residents and at a rate of 4% for foreign residents.

Generally, a company that is Abundant in Foreign Investment (owned by at least 74% foreign shareholders and has undertaken to invest a minimum
sum of $20 million in the Beneficiary Enterprise as defined in the Investments Law) is entitled to an extension of the benefits period by an additional five
years, depending on the rate of its income that is derived in foreign currency.

The 2005 Amendment changes the definition of “foreign investment” in the Investments Law so that the definition now requires a minimal investment
of NIS 5 million by foreign investors. Furthermore, such definition now also includes the purchase of shares of a company from another shareholder, provided
that the company’s outstanding and paid-up share capital exceeds NIS 5 million. Such changes to the aforementioned definition will take effect retroactively
from 2003.

The 2005 Amendment will apply to approved enterprise programs in which the year of election under the Investments Law is 2004 or later, unless
such programs received approval from the Investment Center on or prior to December 31, 2004, in which case the 2005 Amendment provides that terms and
benefits included in any certificate of approval already granted will remain subject to the provisions of the law as they were on the date of such approval.

105

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
In addition, the law provides that terms and benefits included in any certificate of approval granted prior to December 31, 2004 will remain subject to
the  provisions  of  the  law  as  they  were  on  the  date  of  such  approval.  Therefore,  our  existing  “Approved  Enterprises”  will  generally  not  be  subject  to  the
provisions of the Amendment. As a result of the Amendment, tax-exempt income generated under the provisions of the law as amended, will subject us to
taxes upon distribution or liquidation and we may be required to record a deferred tax liability with respect to such tax-exempt income. We elected 2008 as
"year of election" under the Investments Law after the Amendment. We expect that a substantial portion of any taxable operating income that we may realize in
the future will be derived from our approved enterprise status.

Law for the Encouragement of Industrial Research and Development, 1984

Under  the  Law  for  the  Encouragement  of  Industrial  Research  and  Development,  1984  and  the  related  regulations,  or  the  Research  Law,  research,
development and pre-manufacturing programs that meet specified criteria and are approved by a governmental committee (the Research Committee) of the
Office of Chief Scientist (OCS) are eligible for grants of up to 50% of the expenditures on the program.  Each application to the OCS is reviewed separately,
and grants are based on the program approved by the Research Committee.  Expenditures supported under other incentive programs of the State of Israel are
not eligible for OCS grants. As a result, we cannot be sure that applications to the OCS will be approved or, if approved, that we will receive the amounts for
which we apply.

Recipients  of  these  grants  are  required  to  pay  royalties  on  the  revenues  derived  from  the  sale  of  product  developed  in  accordance  with  the
program.  The royalties are payable at the rate of 3% of revenues during the first three years, 4% of revenues during the following three years, and 5% of
revenues in the seventh year and thereafter, with the total royalties not to exceed 100% of the dollar value of the OCS grant.

The terms of the Israeli government participation require that products developed with OCS grants must generally be manufactured in Israel.  If we
receive OCS approval for any portion of this manufacturing to be performed outside of Israel, the royalty rate would be increased and the repayment schedule
would be accelerated, based on the extent of the manufacturing conducted outside of Israel.  Depending upon the extent of the manufacturing volume that is
performed outside of Israel, the ceiling on royalties would increase to 120%, 150% or 300% of the grant. Under an amendment to the Research Law effective
since 2005, the authority of the Research Committee to approve the transfer of manufacture outside of Israel was expanded.

The  technology  developed  pursuant  to  the  terms  of  these  grants  may  not  be  transferred  to  third  parties  without  the  prior  approval  of  the  Research
Committee.  This  approval  is  required  only  for  the  export  of  the  technology,  and  not  for  the  export  of  any  products  that  incorporate  the  sponsored
technology.  Approval of the transfer of technology may be granted only if the recipient agrees to abide by all the provisions of the Research Law, including the
restrictions on the transfer of know-how and the obligation to pay royalties in an amount that may be increased.  The 2005 amendment to the Research Law
granted authority to the Research Committee to approve the transfer of sponsored technology outside of Israel, subject to various conditions.

106

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
We have received grants from the OCS, and therefore we are subject to various restrictions under the Research Law on the transfer of technology or

manufacturing.  These restrictions do not terminate upon the full payment of royalties.

In order to meet specified conditions in connection with the grants and programs of the OCS, we have made representations to the Government of
Israel  about  our  Israeli  operations.    From  time  to  time  the  conduct  of  our  Israeli  operations  has  deviated  from  our  representations.    If  we  fail  to  meet  the
conditions to grants, including the maintenance of a material presence in Israel, or if there is any material deviation from the representations made by us to the
Israeli government, we could be required to refund the grants previously received (together with an adjustment based on the Israeli consumer price index and
an interest factor) and would likely be ineligible to receive OCS grants in the future.

Tax Benefits Under the Law for the Encouragement of Industry (Taxation), 1969

According  to  the  Law  for  the  Encouragement  of  Industry  (Taxation),  1969,  or  the  Industry  Encouragement  Law,  an  “industrial  company”  is  a
company resident in Israel, that at least 90% of its income, in any tax year (determined in Israeli currency, exclusive of income from certain government loans,
capital  gains,  interest  and  dividends)  is  derived  from  an  industrial  enterprise  owned  by  it.  An  industrial  enterprise  is  defined  as  an  enterprise  whose  major
activity in a given tax year is industrial production activity. We currently believe that we qualify as an industrial company within the definition of the Industry
Encouragement Law. Under the Industry Encouragement Law, industrial companies are entitled to the following preferred corporate tax benefits:

·
·
·
·

deduction of purchases of know-how and patents over an eight-year period for tax purposes;
the right to elect, under specified conditions, to file a consolidated tax return with related Israeli industrial companies; and
accelerated depreciation rates on equipment and buildings; and
deductions over a three-year period of expenses involved with the issuance and listing of shares on the Tel Aviv Stock Exchange or, on or
after January 1, 2003, on a recognized stock market outside of Israel.

Eligibility for the benefits under the Industry Encouragement Law is not subject to receipt of prior approval from any governmental authority. The
Israeli tax authorities may determine that we do not qualify as an industrial company, which would entail our loss of the benefits that relate to this status.  In
addition, no assurance can be given that we will continue to qualify as an industrial company, in which case the benefits described above will not be available
in the future.

107

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Israeli Transfer Pricing Regulations

On November 29, 2006, Income tax regulation (Determination of Market Terms), 2006, promulgated under Section 85A of the tax ordinance, came
into force (the “Transfer Pricing Regulations”). Section 85A of the tax Ordinance and the Transfer Pricing Regulations generally require that all cross-border
transactions carried out between related parties will be conducted on an arm’s length basis and will be taxed accordingly. As the Transfer Pricing Regulations
are  broadly  similar  to  transfer  pricing  regimes  already  in  place  in  other  jurisdictions  in  which  we  operate  outside  of  Israel,  we  do  not  expect  the  Transfer
Pricing Regulations to have a material impact on us.

Special Provisions Relating to Measurement of Taxable Income

We elected to measure our taxable income and file our tax return under the Israeli Income Tax Regulations (Principles Regarding the Management of
Books of Account of Foreign Invested Companies and Certain Partnerships and the Determination of Their Taxable Income), 1986. Accordingly, commencing
taxable year 2003, results for tax purposes are measured in terms of earnings in dollars.

Capital Gains Tax

Israeli  law  generally  imposes  a  capital  gains  tax  on  the  sale  of  publicly  traded  securities.    Pursuant  to  changes  made  to  the  Israeli  Income  Tax
Ordinance in January 2006, capital gains on the sale of our ordinary shares will be subject to Israeli capital gains tax, generally at a rate of 20% unless the
holder holds 10% or more of our voting power during the 12 months preceding the sale, in which case it will be subject to a 25% capital gains tax.

However, as of January 1, 2003, non-Israeli residents are exempt from Israeli capital gains tax on any gains derived from the sale of shares publicly
traded on the TASE, provided such gains do not derive from a permanent establishment of such shareholders in Israel.  Non-Israeli residents are also exempt
from Israeli capital gains tax on any gains derived from the sale of shares of Israeli companies publicly traded on a recognized stock exchange or regulated
market outside of Israel, provided that such capital gains are not derived from a permanent establishment in Israel and that such shareholders did not acquire
their shares prior to the issuer’s initial public offering. However, non-Israeli corporations will not be entitled to the exemption with respect to gains derived
from the sale of shares of Israeli companies publicly traded on the TASE, if an Israeli resident (i) has a controlling interest of 25% or more in such non-Israeli
corporation, or (ii) is the beneficiary or is entitled to 25% or more of the revenues or profits of such non-Israeli corporation, whether directly or indirectly.

In some instances where our shareholders may be subject to Israeli tax on the sale of their ordinary shares, the payment of the consideration may be

subject to the withholding of Israeli tax at the source.

108

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
United States-Israel Tax Treaty

Pursuant to the Convention Between the Government of the United States of America and the Government of Israel with respect to Taxes on Income,
as amended, or the United States-Israel Tax Treaty, the sale, exchange or disposition of ordinary shares by a person who holds the ordinary shares as a capital
asset and who qualifies as a resident of the United States within the meaning of the United States- Israel Tax Treaty and who is entitled to claim the benefits
afforded to such person by the United States-Israel Tax Treaty, or a Treaty United States Resident, generally will not be subject to the Israeli capital gains tax
unless such Treaty United States Resident holds, directly or indirectly, shares representing 10% or more of the voting power of our company during any part of
the  twelve-month  period  preceding  such  sale,  exchange  or  disposition,  subject  to  certain  conditions.   A  sale,  exchange  or  disposition  of  shares  by  a Treaty
United  States  Resident  who  holds,  directly  or  indirectly,  shares  representing  10%  or  more  of  the  voting  power  of  our  company  at  any  time  during  such
preceding twelve-month period would be subject to such Israeli tax, to the extent applicable; however, under the United States-Israel Tax Treaty, such Treaty
United States Resident would be permitted to claim a credit for such taxes against the United States federal income tax imposed with respect to such sale,
exchange or disposition, subject to the limitations in United States laws applicable to foreign tax credits. The United States-Israel Tax Treaty does not relate to
state or local taxes.

Tax on Dividends

Non-residents of Israel are subject to Israeli income tax on income accrued or derived from sources in Israel or received in Israel.  These sources of
income  include  passive  income  such  as  dividends,  royalties  and  interest,  as  well  as  non-passive  income  from  services  rendered  in  Israel.    Generally,  on
distributions  of  dividends,  other  than  bonus  shares  and  stock  dividends,  income  tax  at  the  rate  of  25%  is  withheld  at  the  source  (except  that  dividends
distributed on or after January 1, 2006 to an individual who is deemed “a non-substantial shareholder” are subject to tax at the rate of 20%), unless a different
rate is provided in a treaty between Israel and the shareholder’s country of residence.  Under the U.S.-Israel Tax Treaty, the maximum tax on dividends paid to
a holder of ordinary shares who is a Treaty United States Resident will be 25%, however that tax rate is reduced to 12.5% for dividends not generated by an
approved  enterprise  to  a  corporation  which  holds  10%  or  more  of  the  voting  power  of  our  company  during  a  certain  period  preceding  distribution  of  the
dividend.  Dividends derived from an approved enterprise will still be subject to 15% tax withholding.

Foreign Exchange Regulations

Dividends,  if  any,  paid  to  the  holders  of  the  ordinary  shares,  and  any  amounts  payable  upon  dissolution,  liquidation  or  winding  up,  as  well  as  the
proceeds of any sale in Israel of the ordinary shares to an Israeli resident, may be paid in non-Israeli currency or, if paid in Israeli currency, may be converted
into freely repatriable dollars at the rate of exchange prevailing at the time of conversion, provided that Israeli income tax has been paid or withheld on such
amounts.

109

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
United States Tax Considerations

United States Federal Income Taxes

The  following  summary  describes  the  material  U.S.  federal  income  tax  consequences  to  “U.S.  Holders”  (as  defined  below)  arising  from  the
acquisition, ownership and disposition of our ordinary shares. This summary is based on the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, or the “Code,” the
final,  temporary  and  proposed  U.S.  Treasury  Regulations  promulgated  thereunder  and  administrative  and  judicial  interpretations  thereof,  all  as  of  the  date
hereof and all of which are subject to change (possibly with retroactive effect) or different interpretations. For purposes of this summary, a “U.S. Holder” will
be deemed to refer only to any of the following holders of our ordinary shares:

·
·

·
·

an individual who is either a U.S. citizen or a resident of the U.S. for U.S. federal income tax purposes;
a corporation or other entity taxable as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes created or organized in or under the laws of the
U.S. or any political subdivision thereof;
an estate the income of which is subject to U.S. federal income tax regardless of the source of its income; and
a trust, if (a) a U.S. court is able to exercise primary supervision over the administration of the trust and one or more U.S. persons have the
authority  to  control  all  substantial  decisions  of  the  trust,  or  (b)  the  trust  has  a  valid  election  in  effect  under  applicable  U.S.  Treasury
Regulations to be treated as a U.S. person.

This  summary  does  not  consider  all  aspects  of  U.S.  federal  income  taxation  that  may  be  relevant  to  particular  U.S.  Holders  by  reason  of  their
particular circumstances, including potential application of the U.S. federal alternative minimum tax, or any aspect of state, local or non-U.S. federal tax laws
or U.S. federal tax laws other than U.S. federal income tax laws. In addition, this summary is directed only to U.S. Holders that hold our ordinary shares as
“capital assets” within the meaning of Section 1221 of the Code and does not address the considerations that may be applicable to particular classes of U.S.
Holders,  including  financial  institutions,  regulated  investment  companies,  real  estate  investment  trusts,  pension  funds,  insurance  companies,  broker-dealers,
tax-exempt  organizations,  grantor  trusts,  partnerships  or  other  pass-through  entities  and  partners  or  other  equity  holders  in  such  partnerships  or  other  pass-
through  entities,  holders  whose  functional  currency  is  not  the  U.S.  dollar,  holders  who  have  elected  mark-to-market  accounting,  holders  who  acquired  our
ordinary  shares  through  the  exercise  of  options  or  otherwise  as  compensation,  holders  who  hold  our  ordinary  shares  as  part  of  a  “straddle,”  “hedge”  or
“conversion  transaction,”  holders  selling  our  ordinary  shares  short,  holders  deemed  to  have  sold  our  ordinary  shares  in  a  “constructive  sale,”  and  holders,
directly, indirectly or through attribution, of 10% or more (by vote or value) of our outstanding ordinary shares.

Each  U.S.  Holder  should  consult  with  its  own  tax  advisor  as  to  the  particular  tax  consequences  to  it  of  the  acquisition,  ownership  and
disposition of our ordinary shares, including the effects of applicable tax treaties, state, local, foreign or other tax laws and possible changes in the tax
laws.

110

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Distributions With Respect to Our Ordinary Shares

For U.S federal income tax purposes, the amount of a distribution with respect to our ordinary shares will equal the amount of cash distributed, the fair
market value of any property distributed and the amount of any Israeli taxes withheld on such distribution as described above under “Israeli Tax Considerations
– Tax on Dividends.” Other than distributions in liquidation or in redemption of our ordinary shares that are treated as exchanges, a distribution with respect to
our ordinary shares to a U.S. Holder generally will be treated as a dividend to the extent of our current and accumulated earnings and profits, as determined for
U.S. federal income tax purposes. The amount of any distribution that exceeds these earnings and profits will be treated first as a non-taxable return of capital,
reducing the U.S. Holder’s tax basis in its ordinary shares (but not below zero), and then generally as capital gain from a deemed sale or exchange of such
ordinary shares. Corporate U.S. Holders generally will not be allowed a deduction under Section 243 of the Code for dividends received on our ordinary shares
and thus will be subject to tax at the rate applicable to their taxable income. Currently, a noncorporate U.S. Holder’s “qualified dividend income” generally is
subject to tax at a reduced rate of 15%, although the rate applicable to dividend income is scheduled to return to the rate applicable to ordinary income after
December  31,  2010.  For  this  purpose,  “qualified  dividend  income”  generally  includes  dividends  paid  by  a  foreign  corporation  if,  among  other  things,  the
noncorporate U.S. Holder meets certain minimum holding period requirements and either (a) the stock of such corporation is readily tradable on an established
securities market in the U.S., including the Nasdaq Global Select Market, or (b) such corporation is eligible for the benefits of a comprehensive income tax
treaty with the U.S. which includes an information exchange program and is determined to be satisfactory by the U.S. Secretary of the Treasury. The U.S.
Secretary of the Treasury has indicated that the income tax treaty between the U.S. and Israel is satisfactory for this purpose. Dividends paid by us will not
qualify for the 15% U.S. federal income tax rate, however, if we are treated, for the tax year in which the dividends are paid or the preceding tax year, as a
“passive  foreign  investment  company”  for  U.S.  federal  income  tax  purposes.  See  the  discussion  below  under  the  heading  “Passive  Foreign  Investment
Company  Status.”  U.S.  Holders  are  urged  to  consult  their  own  tax  advisors  regarding  the  U.S.  federal  income  tax  consequences  of  their  receipt  of  any
distributions with respect to our ordinary shares.

A dividend paid by us in NIS will be included in the income of U.S. Holders at the U.S. dollar amount of the dividend, based on the “spot rate” of
exchange  in  effect  on  the  date  of  receipt  or  deemed  receipt  of  the  dividend,  regardless  of  whether  the  payment  is  in  fact  converted  into  U.S.  dollars.  U.S.
Holders will have a tax basis in the NIS for U.S. federal income tax purposes equal to that U.S. dollar value. Any gain or loss upon the subsequent conversion
of the NIS into U.S. dollars or other disposition of the NIS will constitute foreign currency gain or loss taxable as ordinary income or loss and will be treated as
U.S.-source income or loss for U.S. foreign tax credit purposes.

Dividends received with respect to our ordinary shares will constitute “portfolio income” for purposes of the limitation on the use of passive activity
losses  and,  therefore,  generally  may  not  be  offset  by  passive  activity  losses.  Dividends  received  with  respect  to  our  ordinary  shares  also  generally  will  be
treated as “investment income” for purposes of the investment interest deduction limitation contained in Section 163(d) of the Code, and as foreign-source
passive income for U.S. foreign tax credit purposes or, in the case of a U.S. Holder that is a financial services entity, financial services income. Subject to
certain limitations, U.S. Holders may elect to claim as a foreign tax credit against their U.S. federal income tax liability any Israeli income tax withheld from
distributions with respect to our ordinary shares which constitute dividends under U.S. income tax law. A U.S. Holder that does not elect to claim a foreign tax
credit may instead claim a deduction for Israeli income tax withheld, but only if the U.S. Holder elects to do so with respect to all foreign income taxes in such
year. In addition, special rules may apply to the computation of foreign tax credits relating to “qualified dividend income,” as defined above. The calculation of
foreign  tax  credits  and,  in  the  case  of  a  U.S.  Holder  that  elects  to  deduct  foreign  income  taxes,  the  availability  of  deductions  are  complex  and  involve  the
application of rules that depend on a U.S. Holder’s particular circumstances. U.S. Holders are urged to consult their own tax advisors regarding the availability
to them of foreign tax credits or deductions in respect of any Israeli tax withheld or paid with respect to any dividends which may be paid with respect to our
ordinary shares.

111

 
 
 
 
 
Disposition of Our Ordinary Shares

Subject to the discussion below under “Passive Foreign Investment Company Status,” a U.S. Holder’s sale, exchange or other taxable disposition of
our ordinary shares generally will result in the recognition by such U.S. Holder of capital gain or loss in an amount equal to the difference between the U.S.
dollar value of the amount realized and the U.S. Holder’s tax basis in the ordinary shares disposed of (measured in U.S. dollars). This gain or loss will be long-
term  capital  gain  or  loss  if  such  ordinary  shares  have  been  held  or  are  deemed  to  have  been  held  for  more  than  one  year  at  the  time  of  the  disposition.
Individual U.S. Holders currently are subject to a maximum tax rate of 15% on long-term capital gains recognized during tax years beginning on or before
December 31, 2010. If the U.S. Holder’s holding period on the date of the taxable disposition is one year or less, such gain or loss will be a short-term capital
gain or loss. Short-term capital gains generally are taxed at the same rates applicable to ordinary income. See “Israeli Tax Considerations – Capital Gains Tax”
for  a  discussion  of  taxation  by  Israel  of  capital  gains  realized  on  sales  of  our  ordinary  shares. Any  capital  loss  realized  upon  the  taxable  disposition  of  our
ordinary shares generally will be deductible only against capital gains and not against ordinary income, except that noncorporate U.S. Holders generally may
deduct annually from ordinary income up to $3,000 of net capital losses. In general, any capital gain or loss recognized by a U.S. Holder upon the taxable
disposition of our ordinary shares will be treated as U.S.-source income or loss for U.S. foreign tax credit purposes. However, under the tax treaty between the
United States and Israel, gain derived from the taxable disposition of ordinary shares by a U.S. Holder who is a resident of the U.S. for purposes of the treaty
and who sells the ordinary shares within Israel may be treated as foreign-source income for U.S. foreign tax credit purposes.

A U.S. Holder’s tax basis in its ordinary shares generally will be the U.S. dollar purchase price paid by such U.S. Holder to acquire such ordinary
shares. The U.S. dollar cost of ordinary shares purchased with foreign currency generally will be the U.S. dollar value of the purchase price on the date of
purchase or, in the case of our ordinary shares that are purchased by a cash basis U.S. Holder (or an accrual basis U.S. Holder that so elects), on the settlement
date  for  the  purchase.  Such  an  election  by  an  accrual  basis  U.S.  Holder  must  be  applied  consistently  from  year  to  year  and  cannot  be  revoked  without  the
consent of the U.S. Internal Revenue Service. The holding period of each ordinary share owned by a U.S. Holder will commence on the day following the date
of the U.S. Holder’s purchase of such ordinary share and will include the day on which the ordinary share is sold by such U.S. Holder.

112

 
 
 
 
In  the  case  of  a  U.S.  Holder  who  uses  the  cash  basis  method  of  accounting  and  who  receives  NIS  in  connection  with  a  taxable  disposition  of  our
ordinary  shares,  the  amount  realized  will  be  based  on  the  “spot  rate”  of  exchange  on  the  settlement  date  of  such  taxable  disposition.    If  such  U.S.  Holder
subsequently converts NIS into U.S. dollars at a conversion rate other than the spot rate in effect on the settlement date, such U.S. Holder may have a foreign
currency  exchange  gain  or  loss  treated  as  ordinary  income  or  loss  for  U.S.  federal  income  tax  purposes.  A  U.S.  Holder  who  uses  the  accrual  method  of
accounting may elect the same treatment required of cash method taxpayers with respect to a taxable disposition of ordinary shares, provided that the election
is applied consistently from year to year. Such election may not be changed without the consent of the U.S. Internal Revenue Service. If an accrual method
U.S. Holder does not elect to be treated as a cash method taxpayer (pursuant to U.S. Treasury Regulations applicable to foreign currency transactions), such
U.S. Holder may be deemed to have realized an immediate foreign currency gain or loss for U.S. federal income tax purposes in the event of any difference
between the U.S. dollar value of the NIS on the date of the taxable disposition and the settlement date. Any such currency gain or loss generally would be
treated  as  U.S.-source  ordinary  income  or  loss  and  would  be  subject  to  tax  in  addition  to  any  gain  or  loss  recognized  by  such  U.S.  Holder  on  the  taxable
disposition of ordinary shares.

Passive Foreign Investment Company Status

Generally, a foreign corporation is treated as a passive foreign investment company (“PFIC”) for U.S. federal income tax purposes for any tax year if,
in such tax year, either (i) 75% or more of its gross income (including its pro rata share of the gross income of any company in which it is considered to own
25% or more of the shares by value) is passive in nature (the “Income Test”), or (ii) the average percentage of its assets during such tax year (including its pro
rata share of the assets of any company in which it is considered to own 25% or more of the shares by value) which produce, or are held for the production of,
passive income (determined by averaging the percentage of the fair market value of its total assets which are passive assets as of the end of each quarter of such
year) is 50% or more (the “Asset Test”). Passive income for this purpose generally includes dividends, interest, rents, royalties and gains from securities and
commodities transactions.

There is no definitive method prescribed in the Code, U.S. Treasury Regulations or relevant administrative or judicial interpretations for determining
the value of a foreign corporation’s assets for purposes of the Asset Test. While the legislative history of the U.S. Taxpayer Relief Act of 1997 (the “1997 Act”)
indicates that for purposes of the Asset Test, “the total value of a publicly-traded foreign corporation’s assets generally will be treated as equal to the sum of the
aggregate  value  of  its  outstanding  stock  plus  its  liabilities,”  it  is  unclear  whether  other  valuation  methods  could  be  employed  to  determine  the  value  of  a
publicly-traded foreign corporation’s assets for purposes of the Asset Test.

Based on the composition of our gross income and the composition and value of our gross assets during 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008 and 2009, we
do not believe that we were a PFIC during any of such tax years. It should be noted that in determining whether we were a PFIC during 2009, we did not
characterize  as  a  passive  asset  the  amount  reflected  on  our  consolidated  balance  sheet  as  accrued  interest  with  respect  to  short-term  marketable  securities
because such accrued interest does not itself bear interest and thus does not produce passive interest income. It is likely, however, that under the asset valuation
method  described  in  the  legislative  history  of  the  1997  Act,  we  would  have  been  classified  as  a  PFIC  in  2001,  2002  and  2003  primarily  because  (a)  a
significant portion of our assets consisted of the remaining proceeds of our two public offerings of ordinary shares in 1999, and (b) the public market valuation
of our ordinary shares during such years was relatively low. There can be no assurance that we will not be deemed a PFIC in any future tax year.

113

 
 
 
 
 
 
U.S. Holders are urged to consult their own tax advisors for guidance as to our status as a PFIC in any tax year. In particular, U.S. Holders
should note that under legislation recently enacted by the U.S., they will be required to file an information return containing certain information required by the
U.S.  Internal  Revenue  Service  for  each  year  in  which  we  are  treated  as  a  PFIC.  The  U.S.  Internal  Revenue  Service  has  announced  that  it  is  developing
guidance for filing these annual information returns, but until further guidance is issued, a U.S. Holder that was required to file Internal Revenue Service Form
8621 (Return by a Shareholder of a Passive Foreign Investment Company or a Qualified Electing Fund) before March 18, 2010 (because such U.S. Holder had
recognized gain upon the disposition of our ordinary shares or had made a QEF Election, as described below) must continue to file Form 8621. A U.S. Holder
that was not otherwise required to file Form 8621 annually before March 18, 2010 will not be required to file the new annual information return for tax years
beginning before March 18, 2010.

If we are treated as a PFIC for U.S. federal income tax purposes for any year during a U.S. Holder’s holding period of our ordinary shares and the

U.S. Holder does not make a QEF Election or a “mark-to-market” election (both as described below):

·

·

·

“Excess distributions” by us to the U.S. Holder would be taxed in a special way. “Excess distributions” with respect to any U.S. Holder are
amounts received  by  such  U.S.  Holder  with  respect  to  our  ordinary  shares  in  any  tax  year  that  exceed  125%  of  the  average  distributions
received by such U.S.  Holder  from  us  during  the  shorter  of  (i)  the  three  previous  years,  or  (ii)  such  U.S.  Holder’s  holding  period  of  our
ordinary shares before the then-current tax year. Excess distributions must be allocated ratably to each day that a U.S. Holder has held our
ordinary shares. Thus, the U.S. Holder would be required to include in its gross income amounts allocated to the current tax year as ordinary
income for that year, pay tax on amounts allocated to each prior tax year in which we were a PFIC at the highest rate on ordinary income in
effect for such prior year and pay an interest charge on the resulting tax at the rate applicable to deficiencies of U.S. federal income tax.
The entire amount of any gain realized by the U.S. Holder upon the sale or other disposition of our ordinary shares also would be treated as
an “excess distribution” subject to tax as described above.
The tax basis in ordinary shares acquired from a decedent who was a U.S. Holder would not receive a step-up to fair market value as of the
date of the decedent’s death, but instead would be equal to the decedent’s basis, if lower.

Although we generally will be treated as a PFIC as to any U.S. Holder if we are a PFIC for any year during the U.S. Holder’s holding period, if we
cease  to  be  a  PFIC,  the  U.S.  Holder  may  avoid  the  consequences  of  PFIC  classification  for  subsequent  years  by  electing  to  recognize  gain  based  on  the
unrealized appreciation in its ordinary shares through the close of the tax year in which we cease to be a PFIC.

114

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
A U.S. Holder who beneficially owns shares of a PFIC must file U.S. Internal Revenue Service Form 8621 (Return by a Shareholder of a Passive
Foreign Investment Company or Qualified Electing Fund) with the U.S. Internal Revenue Service for each tax year in which such U.S. Holder recognizes gain
upon a disposition of our ordinary shares, receives certain distributions from us or makes the QEF Election or mark-to-market election described below.

For any tax year in which we are treated as a PFIC, a U.S. Holder may elect to treat its ordinary shares as an interest in a qualified electing fund (a
“QEF Election”), in which case the U.S. Holder would be required to include in income currently its proportionate share of our earnings and profits in years in
which we are a PFIC regardless of whether distributions of our earnings and profits are actually made to the U.S. Holder. Any gain subsequently recognized by
the U.S. Holder upon the sale or other disposition of its ordinary shares, however, generally would be taxed as capital gain and the denial of the basis step-up at
death described above would not apply.

A U.S. Holder may make a QEF Election with respect to a PFIC for any tax year.  A QEF Election is effective for the tax year in which the election is
made and all subsequent tax years of the U.S. Holder. Procedures exist for both retroactive elections and the filing of protective statements. A U.S. Holder
making the QEF Election must make the election on or before the due date, as extended, for the filing of its U.S. federal income tax return for the first tax year
to which the election will apply. A U.S. Holder must make a QEF Election by completing U.S. Internal Revenue Service Form 8621 and attaching it to its U.S.
federal  income  tax  return,  and  must  satisfy  additional  filing  requirements  each  year  the  election  remains  in  effect.  Upon  a  U.S.  Holder’s  request,  we  will
provide to such U.S. Holder the information required to make a QEF Election and to make subsequent annual filings.

As an alternative to a QEF Election, a U.S. Holder generally may elect to mark its ordinary shares to market annually, recognizing ordinary income or
loss (subject to certain limitations) equal to the difference, as of the close of the tax year, between the fair market value of its ordinary shares and the adjusted
tax basis of such shares. If a mark-to-market election with respect to ordinary shares is in effect on the date of a U.S. Holder’s death, the normally available
step-up in tax basis to fair market value will not be available. Rather, the tax basis of the ordinary shares in the hands of a U.S. Holder who acquired them from
a  decedent  will  be  the  lesser  of  the  decedent’s  tax  basis  or  the  fair  market  value  of  the  ordinary  shares.  Once  made,  a  mark-to-market  election  generally
continues unless revoked with the consent of the U.S. Internal Revenue Service.

The implementation of many aspects of the Code’s PFIC rules requires the issuance of Treasury Regulations which in many instances have yet to be
promulgated and which may have retroactive effect when promulgated. We cannot be sure that any of these regulations will be promulgated or, if so, what form
they will take or what effect they will have on the foregoing discussion. Accordingly, and due to the complexity of the PFIC rules, U.S. Holders should
consult their own tax advisors regarding our status as a PFIC and the eligibility, manner and advisability of making a QEF Election or a mark-to-
market election if we are treated as a PFIC.

115

 
 
 
 
 
 
Information Reporting and Backup Withholding

Payments in respect of our ordinary shares that are made in the U.S. or by certain U.S.-related financial intermediaries may be subject to information
reporting requirements and U.S. backup withholding tax at rates equal to 28% through 2010 and 31% after 2010. The information reporting requirements will
not apply, however, to payments to certain U.S. Holders, including corporations and tax-exempt organizations. In addition, the backup withholding tax will not
apply to a U.S. Holder that furnishes a correct taxpayer identification number on U.S. Internal Revenue Service Form W-9 (or substitute form). The backup
withholding tax is not an additional tax. Amounts withheld under the backup withholding tax rules may be credited against a U.S. Holder’s U.S. federal income
tax liability, and a U.S. Holder may obtain a refund of any excess amounts withheld under the backup withholding tax rules by filing the appropriate claim for
refund  with  the  U.S.  Internal  Revenue  Service.  U.S.  Holders  should  consult  their  own  tax  advisors  regarding  their  qualification  for  an  exemption  from  the
backup withholding tax and the procedures for obtaining such an exemption, if applicable.

The foregoing discussion of certain U.S. federal income tax considerations is a general summary only and should not be considered as income
tax advice or relied upon for tax planning purposes. Accordingly, each U.S. Holder should consult with its own tax advisor regarding U.S. federal,
state, local and non-U.S. income and other tax consequences of the acquisition, ownership and disposition of our ordinary shares.

F

DIVIDENDS AND PAYING AGENTS

Not applicable.

G.

STATEMENT BY EXPERTS

Not applicable.

H.

DOCUMENTS ON DISPLAY

We are subject to the informational requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, applicable to foreign private issuers and fulfill
the  obligations  with  respect  to  such  requirements  by  filing  reports  with  the  Securities  and  Exchange  Commission,  or  SEC.    You  may  read  and  copy  any
document  we  file,  including  any  exhibits,  with  the  SEC  without  charge  at  the  SEC’s  public  reference  room  at  100  F  Street,  N.E.,  Washington,  D.C.
20549.  Copies of such material may be obtained by mail from the Public Reference Branch of the SEC at such address, at prescribed rates.  Please call the
SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330 for further information on the public reference room.  Certain of our SEC filings are also available to the public at the SEC’s website
at http://www.sec.gov.

As a foreign private issuer, we are exempt from the rules under the Exchange Act prescribing the furnishing and content of proxy statements, and our
officers,  directors  and  principal  shareholders  are  exempt  from  the  reporting  and  “short-swing”  profit  recovery  provisions  contained  in  Section  16  of  the
Exchange Act.    In  addition,  we  are  not  required  under  the  Exchange  Act  to  file  periodic  reports  and  financial  statements  with  the  SEC  as  frequently  or  as
promptly as United States companies whose securities are registered under the Exchange Act.  However, we file with the Securities and Exchange Commission
an annual report on Form 20-F containing consolidated financial statements audited by an independent accounting firm.  We also furnish reports on Form 6-K
containing unaudited financial information after the end of each of the first three quarters.  We intend to post our Annual Report on Form 20-F on our website
(www.audiocodes.com) promptly following the filing of our Annual Report with the Securities and Exchange Commission.

116

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
I.

SUBSIDIARY INFORMATION

Not applicable.

ITEM 11.

QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK

We  are  exposed  to  financial  market  risk  associated  with  changes  in  foreign  currency  exchange  rates.    To  mitigate  these  risks,  we  use  derivative
financial  instruments.    The  majority  of  our  revenues  and  expenses  are  generated  in  U.S.  dollars.   A  portion  of  our  expenses,  however,  is  denominated  in
NIS.  In order to protect ourselves against the volatility of future cash flows caused by changes in foreign exchange rates, we use currency forward contracts
and  currency  options.  We  hedge  the  part  of  our  forecasted  expenses  denominated  in  NIS.  If  our  currency  forward  contracts  and  currency  options  meet  the
definition of a hedge, and are so designated, changes in the fair value of the contracts will be offset against changes in the fair value of the hedged assets or
liabilities  through  earnings.  For  derivative  instruments  not  designated  as  hedging  instruments,  the  gain  or  loss  is  recognized  in  current  earnings  during  the
period  of  change.  Our  hedging  program  reduces,  but  does  not  eliminate,  the  impact  of  foreign  currency  rate  movements  and  due  to  the  general  economic
slowdown along with the devaluation of the dollar, our results of operations may be adversely affected. Without taking into account the mitigating effect of our
hedging activity, a 10% decrease in the U.S. dollar exchange rates in effect for the year ended December 31, 2009 would cause a decrease in net income of
approximately $4 million.

We are subject to market risk from exposure to changes in interest rates relating to borrowings under our loan agreements. The interest rate on these
borrowings is based on LIBOR.  Based on our the scheduled amount of these borrowings to be outstanding in 2010, we estimate that each 100 basis point
increase in our borrowing rates would result in additional interest expense to us of approximately $250,000.

ITEM 12.

DESCRIPTION OF SECURITIES OTHER THAN EQUITY SECURITIES

Not applicable.

117

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
ITEM 13.

DEFAULTS, DIVIDEND ARREARAGES AND DELINQUENCIES

Not applicable.

PART II

ITEM 14.

MATERIAL MODIFICATIONS TO THE RIGHTS OF SECURITY HOLDERS AND USE OF PROCEEDS

Not applicable.

ITEM 15.

CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES

Disclosure Controls and Procedures

Our management, with the participation of our Chief Executive Officer, who is also our Interim Chief Financial Officer, evaluated the effectiveness of
our disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in 13a-15(e) under the Securities Exchange Act) as of December 31, 2009. Based on this evaluation, our
chief executive officer and chief financial officer have concluded that, as of such date, our disclosure controls and procedures were (i) designed to ensure that
material information relating to us, including our consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to our management, including our chief executive officer and chief
financial officer, by others within those entities, as appropriate to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosure, particularly during the period in which
this report was being prepared and (ii) effective, in that they provide reasonable assurance that information required to be disclosed by us in the reports that we
file or submit under the Exchange Act is recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the time periods specified in the SEC’s rules and forms.

Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting

Our management, under the supervision of our Chief Executive Officer, who is also our Interim Chief Financial Officer, is responsible for establishing
and maintaining adequate internal control over our financial reporting, as defined in Rules 13a-15(f) of the Exchange Act. Our internal control over financial
reporting  is  designed  to  provide  reasonable  assurance  to  our  management  and  board  of  directors  regarding  the  reliability  of  financial  reporting  and  the
preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. Internal control over financial reporting
includes policies and procedures that:

·
·

·

pertain to the maintenance of our records that in reasonable detail accurately and fairly reflect our transactions and asset dispositions;
provide reasonable assurance that our transactions are recorded as necessary to permit the preparation of our financial statements in accordance with
generally accepted accounting principles;
provide reasonable assurance that our receipts and expenditures are made only in accordance with authorizations of our management and board of
directors (as appropriate); and

118

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
·

provide reasonable assurance regarding the prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition of our assets that could have
a material effect on our financial statements.

Due  to  its  inherent  limitations,  internal  control  over  financial  reporting  may  not  prevent  or  detect  misstatements.  In  addition,  projections  of  any
evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of
compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

Under  the  supervision  and  with  the  participation  of  our  management,  including  our  principal  executive  officer,  who  is  also  our  interim  principal
financial  officer,  we  conducted  an  evaluation  of  the  effectiveness  of  our  internal  control  over  financial  reporting  as  of  December  31,  2009  based  on  the
framework for Internal Control - Integrated Framework set forth by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO). Based
on  our  assessment  under  that  framework  and  the  criteria  established  therein,  our  management  concluded  that  the  Company’s  internal  control  over  financial
reporting were effective as of December 31, 2009.

Attestation Report of the Registered Public Accounting Firm

This annual report includes an attestation report of our registered public accounting firm regarding internal control over financial reporting on page F-

3 of our audited consolidated financial statements set forth in “Item 18 - Financial Statements”, and is incorporated herein by reference.

Changes in Internal Control Over Financial Reporting

There were no changes in our internal controls over financial reporting identified with the evaluation thereof that occurred during the period covered

by this annual report that have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting

ITEM 16.

[RESERVED]

ITEM 16A. AUDIT COMMITTEE FINANCIAL EXPERT

Our  Board  of  Directors  has  determined  that  Joseph  Tenne  is  an  “audit  committee  financial  expert”  as  defined  in  Item  16A  of  Form  20-F  and  is

“independent” as defined in the applicable regulations.

ITEM 16B.

CODE OF ETHICS

We have adopted a Code of Conduct and Business Ethics that applies to our chief executive officer, chief financial officer and other senior financial

officers.  This Code has been posted on our website, www.audiocodes.com.

119

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
ITEM 16C.

PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTANT FEES AND SERVICES

Kost Forer Gabbay & Kasierer, a member of Ernst & Young Global, has served as our independent public accountants for each of the years in the
three-year period ended December 31, 2009. The following table presents the aggregate fees for professional audit services and other services rendered by Kost
Forer Gabbay & Kasierer in 2008 and 2009.

Audit Fees
Audit Related Fees
Tax Fees

Total

Year Ended December 31
(Amounts in thousands)

2008   

2009 

  $

  $

397    $
55     
30     
482    $

315 
50 
32 
397 

Audit Fees consist of fees billed for the annual audit of the company’s consolidated financial statements and the statutory financial statements of the
company. They also include fees billed for other audit services, which are those services that only the external auditor reasonably can provide, and include
services  rendered  for  the  integrated  audit  over  internal  controls  as  required  under  Section  404  of  the  Sarbanes-Oxley  Act  applicable  in  2008  and  2009,  the
provision of consents and the review of documents filed with the SEC.

Audit Related Fees consist of fees billed for assurance and related services that are reasonably related to the performance of the audit or review of the
company’s financial statements and include operational effectiveness of systems. They also include fees billed for other services in connection with merger and
acquisition due diligence.

Tax  Fees  include  fees  billed  for  tax  compliance  services,  including  the  preparation  of  tax  returns  and  claims  for  refund;  tax  consultations,  such  as
assistance and representation in connection with tax audits and appeals, transfer pricing, and requests for rulings or technical advice from taxing authorities; tax
planning services; and expatriate tax compliance, consultation and planning services.

Audit Committee Pre-approval Policies and Procedures

The Audit Committee of AudioCodes’ Board of Directors is responsible, among other matters, for the oversight of the external auditor subject to the
requirements of Israeli law. The Audit Committee has adopted a policy regarding pre-approval of audit and permissible non-audit services provided by our
independent auditors (the “Policy”).

Under the Policy, proposed services either (i) may be pre-approved by the Audit Committee without consideration of specific case-by-case services as
“general pre-approval”; or (ii) require the specific pre-approval of the Audit Committee  as “specific pre-approval”.  The Audit Committee may delegate either
type of pre-approval authority to one or more of its members. The appendices to the Policy set out the audit, audit-related, tax and other services that have
received the general pre-approval of the Audit Committee, including those described in the footnotes to the table, above; these services are subject to annual
review by the Audit Committee. All other audit, audit-related, tax and other services must receive a specific pre-approval from the Audit Committee.

120

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
     
 
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
The Audit Committee pre-approves fee levels annually for the audit services. Non-audited services are pre-approved as required. The Chairman of the

audit committee may approve non-audit services of up to $25,000 and then request the audit committee to ratify his decision.

During  2009,  no  services  provided  to  AudioCodes  by  Kost  Forer  Gabbay  &  Kasierer  were  approved  by  the  Audit  Committee  pursuant  to  the  de

minimis exception to the pre-approval requirement provided by paragraph (c)(7)(i)(C) of Rule 2-01 of Regulation S-X.

ITEM 16D.

EXEMPTIONS FROM THE LISTING STANDARDS FOR AUDIT COMMITTEES

Not applicable.

ITEM 16E.     PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES BY THE ISSUER AND AFFILIATED PURCHASERS

Not applicable.

ITEM 16F.     CHANGE IN REGISTRANT’S CERTIFIED ACCOUNTANT

Not applicable.

ITEM 16G.     CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

As a foreign private issuer whose shares are listed on the Nasdaq Global Select Market, we are permitted to follow certain home country corporate

governance practices instead of certain requirements of the Nasdaq Marketplace Rules.

We  do  not  comply  with  the  Nasdaq  requirement  that  we  obtain  shareholder  approval  for  certain  dilutive  events,  such  as  for  the  establishment  or
amendment of certain equity based compensation plans.  Instead, we follow Israeli law and practice which permits the establishment or amendment of certain
equity  based  compensation  plans  approved  by  our  board  of  directors  without  the  need  for  a  shareholder  vote,  unless  such  arrangements  are  for  the
compensation of directors, in which case they also require audit committee and shareholder approval.

We may elect in the future to follow Israeli practice with regard to, among other things, executive officer compensation, director nomination, composition of
the board of directors and quorum at shareholders’ meetings.  In addition, we may follow Israeli law, instead of the Nasdaq Marketplace Rules, which require
that we obtain shareholder approval for an issuance that will result in a change of control of the company, certain transactions other than a public offering
involving issuances of a 20% or more interest in the company and certain acquisitions of the stock or assets of another company.

121

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
A foreign private issuer that elects to follow a home country practice instead of Nasdaq requirements, must submit to Nasdaq in advance a written statement
from an independent counsel in its home country certifying that its practices are not prohibited by the home country’s laws.  In addition, a foreign private issuer
must  disclose  in  its  annual  reports  filed  with  the  Securities  and  Exchange  Commission  or  on  its  website  each  such  requirement  that  it  does  not  follow  and
describe  the  home  country  practice  followed  by  the  issuer  instead  of  any  such  requirement.   Accordingly,  our  shareholders  may  not  be  afforded  the  same
protection as provided under Nasdaq’s corporate governance rules.

For a discussion of the requirements of Israeli law with respect to these matters, see Item 6.C. "Directors, Senior Management and Employees –

Board Practices," and Item 10.B. "Additional Information – Memorandum and Articles of Association."

PART III

ITEM 17.

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Not applicable.

ITEM 18.

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Reference is made to pages F-1 to F-43 hereto.

ITEM 19.

EXHIBITS

The following exhibits are filed as part of this Annual Report:

Exhibit
No.

Exhibit

  Memorandum of Association of Registrant. (1) †

  Articles of Association of Registrant, as amended. (3)

Indenture, dated  November  9,  2004,  between  AudioCodes  Ltd.  and  U.S.  Bank  National  Association,  as  Trustee,  with  respect  to  the
2.00% Senior Convertible Notes due 2024. (5)

  AudioCodes Ltd. 1997 Key Employee Option Plan (C). (1)

  AudioCodes Ltd. 1997 Key Employee Option Plan, Qualified Stock Option Plan—U.S. Employees (D). (1)

  Founder’s Agreement between Shabtai Adlersberg and Leon Bialik, dated January 1, 1993. (1) †

  License Agreement between AudioCodes Ltd. and DSP Group, Inc., dated as of May 6, 1999. (1) †

122

1.1

1.2

2.1

4.1

4.2

4.3

4.4

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Exhibit
No.

Exhibit

  Lease Agreement between AudioCodes Inc. and Spieker Properties, L.P., dated January 26, 2000. (3)

  Shareholders Agreement by and among DSP Group, Inc., Shabtai Adlersberg, Leon Bialik, Genesis Partners I, L.P., Genesis Partners I
(Cayman) L.P., Polaris Fund II (Tax Exempt Investors) L.L.C., Polaris Fund II L.L.C., Polaris Fund II L.P., DS Polaris Trust Company
(Foreign Residents) (1997) Ltd., DS Polaris Ltd., Dovrat, Shrem Trust Company (Foreign Funds) Ltd., Dovrat Shrem-Skies 92 Fund L.P.
and Chase Equity Securities CEA, dated as of May 6, 1999. (1)

  AudioCodes Ltd. 1997 Key Employee Option Plan (D). (1)

  AudioCodes Ltd. 1997 Key Employee Option Plan (E). (1)

  AudioCodes Ltd. 1999 Key Employee Option Plan (F), as amended. (4)

  AudioCodes Ltd. 1997 Key Employee Option Plan, Qualified Stock Option Plan—U.S. Employees (E). (1)

  AudioCodes Ltd. 1999 Key Employee Option Plan, Qualified Stock Option Plan—U.S. Employees (F). (4)

  AudioCodes Ltd. 2001 Employee Stock Purchase Plan—Global Non U.S., as amended.   (2)

  AudioCodes Ltd. 2001 U.S. Employee Stock Purchase Plan, as amended. (2)

4.5

4.6

4.7

4.8

4.9

4.10

4.11

4.12

4.13

4.13a

  AudioCodes Ltd. 2007 U.S. Employee Stock Purchase Plan. (10)

4.15

4.16

4.17

4.18

4.19

  Sublease Agreement between AudioCodes USA, Inc. and Continental Resources, Inc., dated December 30, 2003. (6)

  Employment Agreement between AudioCodes Ltd. and Shabtai Adlersberg. (13)

  OEM Purchase and Sale Agreement No. 011449 between AudioCodes Ltd and Nortel Networks Ltd., dated as of April 28, 2003. (6)§

  Amendment No. 1 to OEM Purchase and Sale No. 011449 between AudioCodes Ltd and Nortel Networks Ltd., dated as of May 1, 2003.

(6)§

  Purchase and Sale Agreement by and among Nortel Networks, Ltd., AudioCodes Inc. and AudioCodes Ltd., dated as of April 7, 2003.

(6)

123

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Exhibit
No.

Exhibit

4.20

4.21

4.22

4.23

4.24

4.26

4.27

4.28

4.29

4.30

4.31

4.32

4.33

  Purchase Agreement, dated as of November 9, 2004, between  AudioCodes Ltd. and Merrill Lynch & Co., Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner
& Smith Incorporated and Lehman Brothers Inc., as representatives of the initial purchasers of AudioCodes’ 2.00% Senior Convertible
Notes due 2024. (5)

  Amendment No. 2 to OEM Purchase and Sale No. 011449 between AudioCodes Ltd and Nortel Networks Ltd., dated as of January 1,

2005. (7) §

  Amendment No. 3 to OEM Purchase and Sale No. 011449 between AudioCodes Ltd and Nortel Networks Ltd., dated as of February 15,

2005. (7) §

  Amendment No. 5 to OEM Purchase and Sale No. 011449 between AudioCodes Ltd and Nortel Networks Ltd., dated as of January 1,

2005. (7) §

  Amendment No.  6  to  OEM  Purchase  and  Sale  No.  011449  between  AudioCodes  Ltd  and  Nortel  Networks  Ltd.,  dated  as  of  April  1,

2005. (7)

  Amendment No. 4 to OEM Purchase and Sale No. 011449 between AudioCodes Ltd and Nortel Networks Ltd., dated as of April 28,

2005. (8) §

  Agreement and Plan of Merger, dated as of May 16, 2006, among AudioCodes Ltd., AudioCodes, Inc., Green Acquisition Corp., Nuera

Communications, Inc. and Robert Wadsworth, as Sellers’ Representative. (8)

  Building and Tenancy Lease Agreement, dated May 11, 2007, by and between Airport City Ltd. and AudioCodes Ltd. (9) †

  Agreement and Plan of Merger, dated as of July 6, 2006, by and among AudioCodes Ltd., AudioCodes, Inc., Violet Acquisition Corp.,

Netrake Corporation and Will Kohler, as Sellers’ Representative. (9)

  Series E Preferred Share Purchase Agreement, dated as of November 13, 2005, by and between CTI Squared Ltd. and AudioCodes Ltd.

(9)

  Amended and Restated Second Option Agreement, dated as of October 6, 2006, by and among CTI Squared Ltd., AudioCodes Ltd. and

each of the other parties thereto. (9)

  Amendment No. 7 to OEM Purchase and Sale No. 011449 between AudioCodes Ltd. and Nortel Networks Ltd., dated as of December

15, 2006. (9)

  Endorsement and Transfer of Rights Agreement, dated March 29, 2007, by and between Nortel Networks (Sales and Marketing) Ltd.

Israel and AudioCodes Ltd. (9)†

124

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Exhibit
No.

Exhibit

4.34

4.35

4.36

4.37

4.38

4.39

4.40

4.41

8.1

12.1

13.1

15.1

†
§

  Amendment No. 9 to OEM Purchase and Sale No. 011449 between AudioCodes Ltd. and Nortel Networks Ltd., dated as of October 30,

2007. (11) §

  Letter Agreements, dated April 30, 2008 between First International Bank of Israel, as lender, and AudioCodes Ltd., as borrower. (11) †

  Waiver dated November 24, 2008 to Letter Agreement, dated April 30, 2008, between First International Bank of Israel, as lender, and

AudioCodes Ltd., as borrower. (12) †

  Amendment dated February 16, 2009 to Letter Agreements, dated April 30, 2008, between First International Bank of Israel, as lender,

and AudioCodes Ltd., as borrower. (12) †

  Letter Agreements, dated July 14, 2008, between Bank Mizrahi Tefahot Ltd., as lender, and AudioCodes Ltd., as borrower. (12) †

  Amendment dated  November  2,  2008  to  Letter  Agreement,  dated  July  14,  2008,  between  Bank  Mizrahi  Tefahot  Ltd.,  as  lender,  and

AudioCodes Ltd., as borrower. (12) †

  Amendment  dated  April  1,  2009  to  Letter  Agreement,  dated  July  14,  2008,  between  Bank  Mizrahi  Tefahot  Ltd.,  as  lender,  and

AudioCodes Ltd., as borrower. (12) †

  AudioCodes Ltd. 2008 Equity Incentive Plan. (12)

  Subsidiaries of the Registrant. (11)

  Certification of Shabtai Adlersberg, President, Chief Executive Officer and Interim Chief Financial Officer , pursuant to Section 302 of

the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002

  Certification by Chief Executive Officer and Interim Chief Financial Officer Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as Adopted Pursuant to

Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.

  Consent of Kost Forer Gabbay & Kasierer, a member of Ernst & Young Global.

English summary of Hebrew original.
Confidential treatment has been granted for certain portions of the indicated document.  The confidential portions have been omitted and filed
separately with the Securities and Exchange Commission as required by Rule 24b-2 promulgated under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.

125

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
(8)
(9)
(10)
(11)
(12)
(13)

Incorporated herein by reference to Registrant’s Registration Statement on Form F-1 (File No. 333-10352).
Incorporated herein by reference to Registrant’s Registration Statement on Form
Incorporated herein by reference to Registrant’s Form 20-F for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2000.
Incorporated herein by reference to Registrant’s Form 20-F for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2002.
Incorporated by reference herein to Registrant’s Registration Statement on Form F-3 (File No. 333-123859).
Incorporated herein by reference to Registrant’s Form 20-F for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2003.
Incorporated herein by reference to Registrant’s Form 20-F for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2004.
Incorporated herein by reference to Registrant’s Form 20-F for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2005.
Incorporated herein by reference to Registrant’s Form 20-F for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2006.
Incorporated by reference to Registrant’s Registration Statement on Form S-8 (File No. 333-144825).
Incorporated by reference to Registrant’s Form 20-F for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2007.
Incorporated by reference to Registrant’s Form 20-F for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2008
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 1 to Registrant’s Form 6-K filed on November 12, 2009.

126

 
 
The registrant hereby certifies that it meets all of the requirements for filing on Form 20-F and that it has duly caused and authorized the undersigned

to sign this Annual Report on Form 20-F on its behalf.

SIGNATURES

AUDIOCODES LTD.

By: 

/s/ SHABTAI ADLERSBERG
Shabtai Adlersberg

 President, Chief Executive Officer and
 Interim Chief Financial Officer

Date: June 29, 2010

127

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
AUDIOCODES LTD. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES

CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

AS OF DECEMBER 31, 2009

IN U.S. DOLLARS

INDEX

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

Consolidated Balance Sheets

Consolidated Statements of Operations

Statements of Changes in Shareholders' Equity

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 - - - - - - - - - - - -

Page

F-2 - F-3

F-4 - F- 5

F-6

F-7

F-8 - F-9

   F-10 - F-44

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

To the Board of Directors and Shareholders of

AudioCodes LTD.

We  have  audited  the  accompanying  consolidated  balance  sheets  of  AudioCodes  Ltd.  ("AudioCodes"  or  "the  Company")  and  its  subsidiaries  as  of
December 31, 2008 and 2009, and the related consolidated statements of operations, changes in equity and cash flows for each of the three years in the period
ended December 31, 2009. These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these
financial statements based on our audits.

We  conducted  our  audits  in  accordance  with  the  standards  of  the  Public  Company Accounting  Oversight  Board  (United  States).  Those  standards
require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit
includes  examining,  on  a  test  basis,  evidence  supporting  the  amounts  and  disclosures  in  the  financial  statements.  An  audit  also  includes  assessing  the
accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that
our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

In our opinion the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the consolidated financial position of the
Company and its subsidiaries at December 31, 2008 and 2009, and the consolidated results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in
the period ended December 31, 2009, in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States.

As discussed in Note 2s and Note 10, the Company has changed its method of accounting for convertible debt instruments effective January 1, 2009,
due to the adoption of FSP APB 14-1, “Accounting for Convertible Debt Instruments That May Be Settled in Cash upon Conversion (Including Partial Cash
Settlement)”, as codified in ASC 470-20, “Debt with Conversion and Other Options”. The consolidated financial statements have been retrospectively adjusted
to  reflect  the  adoption  of  the  FSP.  Additionally  as  discussed  in  Note  2aa  to  the  consolidated  financial  statements,  effective  January  1  2009  the  Company
changed its manner of accounting for the acquisition of non-controlling interest, due to the adoption of ASC 810 (formerly FAS 160, "Non-controlling Interest
in Consolidation Financial Statements").

We  also  have  audited,  in  accordance  with  the  standards  of  the  Public  Company  Accounting  Oversight  Board  (United  States),  the  Company  and
subsidiaries' internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2009, based on criteria established in Internal Control-Integrated Framework issued
by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission and our report dated June 28, 2010 expressed an unqualified opinion thereon.

Tel-Aviv, Israel
June 28, 2010

KOST FORER GABBAY & KASIERER
A Member of Ernst & Young Global

F-2

 
 
 
REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

To the Board of Directors and Shareholders of

AudioCodes LTD.

We have audited AudioCodes Ltd's ("AudioCodes" or "the Company") internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2009, based on criteria
established in Internal Control-Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (the COSO criteria).
AudioCodes'  management  is  responsible  for  maintaining  effective  internal  control  over  financial  reporting,  and  for  its  assessment  of  the  effectiveness  of
internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting included in the accompanying
Management's Annual Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting included in the accompanying Management's Annual Report on Internal Control
Over Financial Reporting. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company's internal control over financial reporting based on our audit.

We  conducted  our  audit  in  accordance  with  the  standards  of  the  Public  Company  Accounting  Oversight  Board  (United  States).  Those  standards
require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all
material respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists,
testing  and  evaluating  the  design  and  operating  effectiveness  of  internal  control  based  on  the  assessed  risk,  and  performing  such  other  procedures  as  we
considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.

A  Company's  internal  control  over  financial  reporting  is  a  process  designed  to  provide  reasonable  assurance  regarding  the  reliability  of  financial
reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A Company's internal
control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and
fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the Company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to
permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the Company are
being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the Company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention
or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the Company's assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Because  of  its  inherent  limitations,  internal  control  over  financial  reporting  may  not  prevent  or  detect  misstatements.  Also,  projections  of  any
evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of
compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

In our opinion, AudioCodes maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2009, based on

the COSO criteria.

We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the consolidated balance
sheets of AudioCodes and its subsidiaries as of December 31, 2008 and 2009 and the related consolidated statements of operations, changes in equity and cash
flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2009 and our report dated June 28, 2010 expressed an unqualified opinion thereon.

Tel-Aviv, Israel
June 28, 2010

KOST FORER GABBAY & KASIERER
A Member of Ernst & Young Global

F-3

 
 
 
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
U.S. dollars in thousands

ASSETS

CURRENT ASSETS:

Cash and cash equivalents
Short-term bank deposits
Short-term marketable securities and accrued interest
Trade receivables (net of allowance for doubtful accounts of $ 519 and $ 723 at December 31, 2008 and 2009,

  $

respectively)

Other receivables and prepaid expenses
Deferred tax assets
Inventories

Total current assets

LONG-TERM ASSETS:

Investment in companies
Deferred tax assets
Severance pay funds

Total long-term assets

PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT, NET

INTANGIBLE ASSETS, DEFERRED CHARGES, NET (1)

GOODWILL

Total assets

(1)

See Note 2s and Note 10.

The accompanying notes are an integral part of the consolidated financial statements.

F-4

AUDIOCODES LTD. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES

December 31,

2008

2009

36,779    $
61,870     
16,481     

29,564     
3,573     
972     
20,623     

38,969 
13,902 
- 

18,522 
2,754 
1,053 
13,516 

169,862     

88,716 

1,245     
1,255     
10,297     

1,510 
1,174 
12,235 

12,797     

14,919 

6,844     

4,956 

8,706     

6,847 

32,095     

32,095 

  $

230,304    $

147,533 

 
  
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
     
 
 
   
     
 
   
     
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
 
   
      
  
   
 
   
      
  
   
      
  
   
   
   
 
   
      
  
   
 
   
      
  
   
 
   
      
  
   
 
   
      
  
   
 
   
      
  
 
AUDIOCODES LTD. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES

CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
U.S. dollars in thousands, except share and per share data

LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS' EQUITY

CURRENT LIABILITIES:

Current maturities of long-term bank loans
Trade payables
Other payables and accrued expenses
Senior convertible notes (1)

Total current liabilities

LONG-TERM LIABILITIES:

Accrued severance pay
Senior convertible notes
Long-term banks loans

Total long-term liabilities

COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENT LIABILITIES

EQUITY:

AudioCodes equity:
Share capital -

Ordinary shares of NIS 0.01 par value -
Authorized: 100,000,000 at December 31, 2008 and 2009; Issued: 47,574,800 shares at December 31, 2008 and

47,661,550 shares at December 31, 2009; Outstanding: 40,182,444 shares at December 31, 2008 and 40,269,194
shares at December 31, 2009

Additional paid-in capital (1)
Treasury stock
Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss)
Accumulated deficit (1)

Non controlling interest (2)

Total  equity (1) (2)

Total liabilities and equity

(1)
(2)

See Note 2s and Note 10.
See Note 2aa.

The accompanying notes are an integral part of the consolidated financial statements.

F-5

December 31,

2008

2009

  $

6,000    $
11,661     
23,961     
70,670     

6,000 
8,609 
19,550 
- 

112,292     

34,159 

12,174     
-     
21,750     

13,336 
403 
15,750 

33,924     

29,489 

125     
186,998     
(25,057)    
(912)    
(77,294)    

125 
189,079 
(25,057)
98 
(80,116)

83,860     

84,129 

228     

(244)

84,088     

83,885 

  $

230,304    $

147,533 

 
  
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
     
 
 
   
     
 
   
     
 
   
   
   
 
   
      
  
   
 
   
      
  
   
      
  
   
   
   
 
   
      
  
   
 
   
      
  
   
      
  
 
   
      
  
   
      
  
   
      
  
   
      
  
   
      
  
   
   
   
   
   
 
   
      
  
 
   
 
   
      
  
   
 
   
      
  
   
 
   
      
  
 
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS
U.S. dollars in thousands, except per share data

Revenues
Cost of revenues

Gross profit

Operating expenses:

Research and development, net
Selling and marketing
General and administrative
Impairment of goodwill and other intangible assets

Total operating expenses

Operating loss
Financial expenses, net (1)

Loss before taxes on income
Taxes on income, net
Equity in losses of affiliated companies, net

Net loss

Net loss attributable to non-controlling interest

Net loss attributable to AudioCodes' shareholders

Basic and diluted net loss per share attributable to AudioCodes' shareholders (1)

(1)

See Note 2s and Note 10.

The accompanying notes are an integral part of the consolidated financial statements.

F-6

AUDIOCODES LTD. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES

Year ended December 31,
2008

2007

2009

  $

158,235    $
69,185     

174,744    $
77,455     

125,894 
56,194 

89,050     

97,289     

69,700 

40,706     
42,900     
9,637     
-     

37,833     
44,657     
9,219     
85,015     

29,952 
32,111 
7,821 
- 

93,243     

176,724     

69,884 

(4,193)    
2,167     

(6,360)    
1,265     
1,097     

(79,435)    
3,268     

(82,703)    
505     
2,582     

(184)
2,744 

(2,928)
290 
76 

(8,722)    

(85,790)    

(3,294)

-     

-     

472 

(8,722)   $

(85,790)   $

(2,822)

(0.20)   $

(2.08)   $

(0.07)

  $

  $

 
  
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
 
   
     
     
 
   
 
   
      
      
  
   
 
   
      
      
  
   
      
      
  
   
   
   
   
 
   
      
      
  
   
 
   
      
      
  
   
   
 
   
      
      
  
   
   
   
 
   
      
      
  
   
 
   
      
      
  
   
 
   
      
      
  
 
   
      
      
  
 
STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN EQUITY
U.S. dollars in thousands

AUDIOCODES LTD. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES

Share
capital

Additional
paid-in
capital

Treasury
stock

  Accumulated  
other
  comprehensive 
income

Retained
earnings
(accumulated  
deficit)

Non-

controlling  

interests

Total
  comprehensive 
income (loss)  

Total
equity

Balance as of January 1, 2007

  $

131 

  $

169,456 

  $

(11,320)   $

122 

  $

17,218 

  $

Issuance of shares upon exercise of options and employee

stock purchase plan

Stock compensation related to options granted to employees  
Comprehensive loss, net:

Unrealized gains on foreign currency cash flow hedges
Net loss (1)

Total comprehensive loss, net

Balance as of December 31, 2007
Purchase of treasury stock
Issuance of shares upon exercise of options and employee

stock purchase plan

Stock compensation related to options granted to employees  
Early redemption of Senior Convertible Note
Acquisition of NSC (2)
Comprehensive loss, net:

Unrealized losses on foreign currency cash flow hedges  
Net loss (1)

Total comprehensive loss, net

Balance as of December 31, 2008

Issuance of shares upon exercise of options and employee

stock purchase plan

Stock compensation related to options granted to employees  
Comprehensive loss, net:

Unrealized profit on foreign currency cash flow hedges
Net loss

2 
- 

- 
- 

4,798 
7,967 

- 
- 

- 
- 

- 
- 

133 
(10)  

182,221 
- 

(11,320)  
(13,737)  

2 
- 

- 

- 
- 

1,545 
4,341 
(1,109)  

- 

- 
- 

- 
- 

- 

- 
- 

- 
- 

925 
- 

1,047 
- 

- 
- 

- 

(1,959)  

- 

- 
- 

- 

(8,722)  

8,496 
- 

- 
- 

- 

- 

(85,790)  

125 

186,998 

(25,057)  

(912)  

(77,294)  

- 
- 

- 
- 

90 
1,991 

- 
- 

- 
- 

- 
- 

- 
- 

1,010 
- 

- 
- 

(2,822)  

Total comprehensive loss, net

Balance as of December 31, 2009

(1)
(2)

See Note 2s and Note 10.
See Note 2aa.

  $

125 

  $

189,079 

  $

(25,057)   $

98 

  $

(80,116)

 $

The accompanying notes are an integral part of the consolidated financial statements.

F-7

- 

- 
- 

- 

  $

  $

925 
(8,722)  
(7,797)  

- 
- 

- 
- 

228 

- 

- 

  $

  $

(1,959)  
(85,790)  
(87,749)  

228 

- 
- 

  $

- 
(472)  

  $

(244)  

  $

175,607 

4,800 
7,967 

925 
(8,722)

180,577 
(13,747)

1,547 
4,341 
(1,109)
228 

(1,959)
(85,790)

84,088 

90 
1,991 

1,010 
(3,294)

1,010 
(3,294)  
(2,284)  

  $

83,885 

 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
U.S. dollars in thousands

Cash flows from operating activities:

Net loss (1)
Adjustments required to reconcile net loss to net cash provided by operating activities:

Depreciation and amortization
Impairment of goodwill, other intangible assets and investment in affiliate
Amortization of marketable securities premiums and accretion of discounts, net
Equity in losses of affiliated companies, net
Stock-based compensation expenses
Amortization of senior convertible notes discount and deferred charges and gain from

redemption (1)

Decrease (increase) in accrued interest on marketable securities, bank deposits and structured

notes

Decrease (increase) in deferred tax assets, net
Decrease (increase) in trade receivables, net
Decrease (increase) in other receivables and prepaid expenses
Decrease (increase) in inventories
Increase (decrease) in trade payables
Increase (decrease) in other payables and accrued expenses (2)
Increase (decrease) in accrued severance pay, net

AUDIOCODES LTD. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES

Year ended December 31,
2008

2007

2009

  $

(8,722)   $

(85,790)   $

(3,294)

7,789     
-     
39     
1,097     
7,967     

7,441     
86,111     
112     
1,486     
4,341     

5,040     

4,592     

(611)    
2,390     
5,014     
(1,412)    
(2,643)    
1,263     
(5,181)    
356     

125     
(169)    
(3,960)    
450     
(1,840)    
2,728     
333     
451     

4,969 
- 
252 
76 
1,991 

2,930 

2,312 
- 
11,042 
908 
7,107 
(3,052)
(3,491)
(776)

Net cash provided by operating activities

12,386     

16,411     

20,974 

Cash flows from investing activities:

Investments in affiliated companies
Purchase of property and equipment
Purchase of marketable securities
Investment in short-term and long-term bank deposits
Proceeds from short-term bank deposits
Proceeds from structured notes called by the issuer
Proceeds from redemption of marketable securities upon maturity
Payment for acquisition of CTI Squared Ltd ("CTI2") (3)

(1,003)    
(2,629)    
-     
(29,065)    
28,700     
10,000     
31,600     
(4,897)    

(6,330)    
(3,158)    
(16,795)    
(100,864)    
90,142     
-     
17,000     
-     

(341)
(1,271)

(49,318)
95,203 
- 
16,000 
- 

Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities

32,706     

(20,005)    

60,273 

Cash flows from financing activities:
Purchase of treasury stock
Redemption of senior convertible notes
Proceeds from long-term bank loans
Repayment of long-term bank loans
Proceeds from issuance of shares upon exercise of options and employee stock purchase plan

-     
-     
-     
-     
4,800     

(13,747)    
(50,240)    
30,000     
(2,250)    
1,547     

- 
(73,147)
- 
(6,000)
90 

Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities

4,800     

(34,690)    

(79,057)

Increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents
Cash and cash equivalents at the beginning of the year

49,892     
25,171     

(38,284)    
75,063     

2,190 
36,779 

Cash and cash equivalents at the end of the year

  $

75,063    $

36,779    $

38,969 

(1)
(2)

See Note 2s and Note 10.
See Note 2aa.

The accompanying notes are an integral part of the consolidated financial statements.

F-8

 
  
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
   
     
     
 
   
      
      
  
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
 
   
      
      
  
   
 
   
      
      
  
   
      
      
  
   
   
   
  
   
   
   
   
   
 
   
      
      
  
   
 
   
      
      
  
   
      
      
  
   
   
   
   
   
 
   
      
      
  
   
 
   
      
      
  
   
   
 
   
      
      
  
 
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
U.S. dollars in thousands

(3)    Payment for acquisition of CTI Squared Ltd.

Net fair value of assets acquired and liabilities assumed of CTI2 at the date of acquisition (see

also Note 1b):
Working capital, net (excluding cash and cash equivalents)
Technology
Backlog
Goodwill

(4)

Supplemental disclosure of cash flow activities:

Cash paid during the year for income taxes

Cash paid during the year for interest

The accompanying notes are an integral part of the consolidated financial statements.

F-9

AUDIOCODES LTD. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES

Year ended December 31,
2008

2007

2009

  $

(7,519)   $
1,530     
41     
10,845     

  $

4,897    $

-    $
-     
-     
-     

-    $

- 
- 
- 
- 

- 

  $

  $

403    $

 646    $

363 

2,500    $

2,455    $

2,238 

 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
 
 
   
     
     
 
   
     
     
 
 
 
   
     
     
 
 
   
     
     
 
 
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 
   
      
      
  
 
 
 
 
   
      
      
  
   
      
      
  
 
 
   
      
      
  
 
 
 
   
      
      
  
 
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
U.S. dollars in thousands, except share and per share data

NOTE 1:-

GENERAL

a.   Business overview:

AUDIOCODES LTD. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES

AudioCodes Ltd. ("the Company") and its subsidiaries (together "the Group") design, develop and market products for voice, data and
video  over  IP  networks  to  service  providers  and  channels  (such  as  distributors),  OEMs,  network  equipment  providers  and  systems
integrators.

The Company operates through its wholly-owned subsidiaries in the United States, Europe, Asia, Latin America and Israel.

During 2008, the Group faced an adverse change in its business as a result of the global economic slowdown and credit crisis. During the
fourth quarter of 2008, the Company recorded a non-cash impairment charge with respect to goodwill and intangible assets as follows:

Goodwill - - $ 79,117 (see also Note 2k).
Intangible assets – $ 5,898 (see also Notes 2k and 7).

b.   Acquisition of CTI Squared Ltd.:

On  April  1,  2007,  the  Group  acquired  the  remaining  outstanding  common  stock  of  CTI  Squared  Ltd  ("CTI2"),  a  leading  provider  of
enhanced messaging and communications platforms deployed globally by service providers and enterprises. CTI2's platforms integrate
data  and  voice  messaging  services  over  internet,  intranet,  PSTN,  cellular,  cable  and  enterprise  networks.  Prior  to  this  acquisition,  the
Group had an investment in CTI2 in the amount of $ 1,565.

In consideration for the acquisition, the Group paid $ 4,897 in cash at the closing of the transaction in April 2007 and committed to pay
an additional $ 5,000 by April, 2008. In February 2008, the Group paid the additional amount of $ 5,000.

CTI2  became  a  wholly-owned  subsidiary  of  the  Company  and,  accordingly,  its  results  of  operations  have  been  included  in  the
consolidated financial statements of the Group since the acquisition date.

This acquisition was accounted for under the purchase method of accounting in accordance with FAS 141, "Business Combination".

F-10

 
  
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
U.S. dollars in thousands, except share and per share data

NOTE 1:-

GENERAL (Cont.)

Based  upon  an  independent  valuation  of  tangible  and  intangible  assets  acquired,  the  Group  has  allocated  the  total  acquisition  cost  of
CTI2's assets and liabilities as follows:

AUDIOCODES LTD. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES

Trade receivables
Other receivables and prepaid expenses
Property and equipment

Total tangible assets acquired

Technology (six years useful life)
Backlog (one year useful life)
Goodwill

Total intangible assets acquired

Total tangible and intangible assets acquired

Trade payables
Other current liabilities and accrued expenses

Accrued severance pay, net

Total liabilities assumed

Net assets acquired

  $

April 2,
2007

117 
134 
10 

261 

1,530 
41 
10,845 

12,416 

12,677 

(64)
(822)
(329)

(1,215)

  $

11,462 

Goodwill includes, but is not limited to, the synergistic value and potential competitive benefits that could be realized by the Company
from the acquisition. Goodwill is not deductible for tax purposes.

The value assigned to tangible and intangible assets acquired and liabilities assumed was determined as follows:

Current  assets  and  liabilities  are  recorded  at  their  carrying  amounts.  The  carrying  amounts  of  current  assets  and  liabilities  were
reasonable proxies for their fair value due to their short-term maturity. Property and equipment are presented at current replacement cost.
The fair value of intangible assets was determined using the income approach.

c.   Acquisition of Natural Speech Communication Ltd.:

Through  December  31,  2009,  the  Group  had  invested  an  aggregate  of  $  8,418  in  Natural  Speech  Communication  Ltd.  ("NSC"),  a
privately-held company engaged in speech recognition. As of December 1, 2008, the Company began consolidating the financial results
of NSC into AudioCodes' financial results since it became the primary beneficiary in accordance with FIN No. 46R, "Consolidation of
Variable  Interest  Entities  in  interpretation  of  ARB  No.  51".    As  of  December  31,  2009,  the  Group  owned  59.74%  of  the  outstanding
share capital of NSC. (See also Note 19).

F-11

 
  
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
   
 
   
  
   
 
   
  
   
   
   
 
   
  
   
 
   
  
   
 
   
  
   
   
   
 
   
  
   
 
   
  
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
U.S. dollars in thousands, except share and per share data

NOTE 1:-

GENERAL (Cont.)

This acquisition was accounted for in accordance with the measurement guidance in FIN 46R.

AUDIOCODES LTD. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES

Other receivables and prepaid expenses
Inventory
Property and equipment

Total tangible assets acquired

Trade payables
Other current liabilities and accrued expenses
 Accrued severance pay, net
 Minority interest

Total liabilities assumed

Net assets acquired

December 1,
2008

  $

  $

152 
47 
194 

393 

(84)
(305)
(57)
(228)

(674)

(281)

Based upon an independent valuation of tangible and intangible assets acquired, the reported amount of NSC (plus the fair value of any
consideration paid) was less than the fair value of the net assets of NSC. Therefore, the excess was allocated and reported as a pro-rata
adjustment to all of the consolidated assets.

The following unaudited pro forma information does not purport to represent what the Group's results of operations would have been
had the acquisition of NSC been consummated on January 1, 2007, nor does it purport to represent the results of operations of the Group
for any future period.

Revenues

Net loss

Basic and diluted net loss per share

Year ended December 31,

2007

2008

  $

  $

  $

159,358    $

175,489 

(5,621)   $

(83,604)

(0.13)   $

(2.03)

d.   The Group  is  dependent  upon  sole  source  suppliers  for  certain  key  components  used  in  its  products,  including  certain  digital  signal
processing chips. Although there are a limited number of manufacturers of these particular components, management believes that other
suppliers could provide similar components at comparable terms. A change in suppliers, however, could cause a delay in manufacturing
and a possible loss of sales, which could adversely affect the operating results of the Group and its financial position.

e.   In January 2009, the Group's largest customer announced that it would seek creditor protection for itself and some of its subsidiaries. As
a result from the loss of the this customer, a significant reduction of the amount of products purchased by this customer or the Group's
inability to obtain a satisfactory replacement of this customer in a timely manner may have a significant impact on the Group's future
revenues  and  the  results  of  operations.  For  the  years  ended  December  31,  2007,  2008  and  2009,  this  customer  accounted  for  17.0%,
14.4% and 15.6%, respectively, of the Group's revenues.

F-12

 
  
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
   
 
   
  
   
 
   
  
   
   
   
   
 
   
  
   
 
   
  
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
     
 
 
   
      
  
 
   
      
  
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
U.S. dollars in thousands, except share and per share data

NOTE 2:-

SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES

AUDIOCODES LTD. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES

The consolidated financial statements have been prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles in the United States
("U.S. GAAP").

a.   Use of estimates:

The preparation of financial statements in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles requires management to make
estimates,  judgments  and  assumptions  that  affect  the  amounts  reported  in  the  financial  statements  and  accompanying  notes.  The
Company's management believes that the estimates, judgment and assumptions used are reasonable based upon information available at
the time they are made. As applicable to these consolidated financial statements, the most significant estimates and assumptions relate to
sales  reserves  and  allowances,  income  taxes,  valuation  of  goodwill  and  intangible  assets,  purchase  price  allocation  on  acquisitions,
inventories,  and  assumptions  related  to  the  application  of  the  amended  ASC  470-20,  with  regards  to  convertible  notes  issues  by  the
Company and which may be settled in cash upon conversion. Actual results could differ from those estimates.

b.   Financial statements in U.S. dollars:

A majority of the group's revenues is generated in U.S. dollars. In addition, most of the group's costs are denominated and determined in
U.S.  dollars  and  in  new  Israeli  shekels.  The  Company's  management  believes  that  the  U.S.  dollar  is  the  currency  in  the  primary
economic environment in which the group operates. Thus, the functional and reporting currency of the group is the U.S. dollar.

Accordingly, monetary accounts maintained in currencies other than the dollar are remeasured into U.S. dollars in accordance with ASC
830 (formerly: FAS 52), "Foreign Currency Matters". All transaction gains and losses of the remeasured monetary balance sheet items
are reflected in the statements of operations as financial income or expenses, as appropriate.

c.   Principles of consolidation:

The  consolidated  financial  statements  include  the  accounts  of  the  Company  and  its  wholly-owned  subsidiaries.  Intercompany
transactions  and  balances,  including  profits  from  intercompany  sales  not  yet  realized  outside  the  Group,  have  been  eliminated  upon
consolidation.

d.   Cash equivalents:

Cash equivalents are short-term highly liquid investments that are readily convertible into cash with original maturities of three months
or less, at the date acquired.

e.   Short-term bank deposits:

Short-term bank deposits are deposits with maturities of more than three months but less than one year. The deposits are mainly in U.S.
dollars and bear interest at an average rate of 4.00% and 0.35% for 2008 and 2009, respectively. Short-term deposits are presented at
their cost, including accrued interest. The banks have a lien on the Company's assets and the Company is required to maintain $ 7,000 of
compensating balances with the banks which are included in short-term bank deposits (see also Note 11.)

F-13

 
  
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
U.S. dollars in thousands, except share and per share data

NOTE 2:-

SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (Cont.)

f.   Marketable securities:

AUDIOCODES LTD. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES

The  Company  accounts  for  investments  in  debt  securities  in  accordance  with  ASC  320  (formerly  FAS  115),  "Investments-Debt  and
Equity Securities".

Management  determines  the  appropriate  classification  of  its  investments  in  marketable  debt  securities  at  the  time  of  purchase  and
reevaluates  such  determinations  at  each  balance  sheet  date.  Marketable  debt  securities  are  classified  as  held-to-maturity  since  the
Company has the intent and ability to hold the securities to maturity and, accordingly, debt securities are stated at amortized cost.

For the year ended December 31, 2008, all securities covered by ASC No. 320 were designated by the Company's management as held-
to-maturity. As of December 31, 2009, the Group does not hold any marketable securities.

The amortized cost of held-to-maturity securities is adjusted for amortization of premiums and accretion of discounts to maturity. Such
amortization and interest are included in the consolidated statement of operations as financial income or expenses, as appropriate. The
accrued interest on short-term and long-term marketable securities is included in the balance of short-term marketable securities.

Effective January 1, 2009, the Company adopted an amendment to ASC 320 which changed the impairment and presentation model for
its debt securities. The amendment had no effect on the Company.

For the years ended December 31, 2007, 2008 and 2009, no other than temporary impairment losses have been identified.

g.   Inventories:

Inventories are stated at the lower of cost or market value. Cost is determined as follows:

Raw materials - using the "weighted average cost" method.
Finished products - using the "weighted average cost" method with the addition of direct manufacturing costs.

The Group periodically evaluates the quantities on hand relative to current and historical selling prices and historical and projected sales
volume  and  technological  obsolescence.  Based  on  these  evaluations,  inventory  write-offs  are  taken  based  on  slow  moving  items,
technological obsolescence, excess inventories, discontinued products and for market prices lower than cost.

h.   Investment in companies:

The Company accounts for investments in companies in which it has the ability to exercise significant influence over the operating and
financial  policies  using  the  equity  method  of  accounting  in  accordance  with  the  requirements  of  ASC  323  (formerly  Accounting
Principle Board ("APB") No. 18), "Investments-Equity method and Joint Ventures". If the Company does not have the ability to exercise
significant influence over operating and financial policies of a company, the investment is stated at cost.

F-14

 
  
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
U.S. dollars in thousands, except share and per share data

NOTE 2:-

SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (Cont.)

AUDIOCODES LTD. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES

Investment  in  companies  represents  investments  in  ordinary  shares,  preferred  shares  and  convertible  loans.  According  to  ASC  323,
losses of such companies are recognized based on the ownership level of the particular security held by the Company.

The Company's investments are reviewed for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount
of the investment may not be recoverable in accordance with ASC 323. As of December 31, 2007 and 2009, no impairment losses had
been  identified.  During  2008,  based  on  management's  most  recent  analyses,  the  Company  recognized  an  impairment  loss  of  $  1,096
relating to its investment in NSC.

i.   Property and equipment:

Property and equipment are stated at cost, net of accumulated depreciation. Depreciation is calculated by the straight-line method over
the estimated useful lives of the assets, at the following annual rates:

Computers and peripheral equipment
Office furniture and equipment
Leasehold improvements

j.   Deferred charges:

%

33
6 - 20 (mainly 15%)

  Over the shorter of the term of the

lease or the life of the asset

Costs  incurred  in  respect  of  issuance  of  senior  convertible  notes  are  deferred  and  amortized  using  the  effective  interest  method  and
classified  as  a  component  of  interest  expense  over  the  five-year-period  from  issuance  to  expected  maturity  in  November  2009,  in
accordance ASC No. 470. See also Note 2s, Note 7 and Note 10.

k.   Impairment of long-lived assets:

The Group's long-lived assets are reviewed for impairment in accordance with ASC 360-10-35 (formerly FAS 144), "Property, Plant and
Equipment - Subsequent Measurement", whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of an asset may
not be recoverable. Recoverability of assets to be held and used is measured by a comparison of the carrying amount of an asset to the
future undiscounted cash flows expected to be generated by the asset if such assets are considered to be impaired, the impairment to be
recognized  is  measured  by  the  amount  by  which  the  carrying  amount  of  the  assets  exceeds  the  fair  value  of  the  assets.  The  loss  is
allocated to the long-lived assets of the Group on a pro rata basis using the relative carrying amounts of those assets, except that the loss
allocated to an individual long-lived asset of the Group shall not reduce the carrying amount of that asset below its fair value whenever
that fair value is determinable As of December 31, 2007, 2008 and 2009, no impairment losses have been identified for property and
equipment since the fair value of those assets was higher than its carrying amounts.

Intangible assets are comprised of acquired technology, customer relations, trade names, existing contracts for maintenance and backlog.
All intangible assets are amortized using the straight-line method over their estimated useful life.

F-15

 
  
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
U.S. dollars in thousands, except share and per share data

NOTE 2:-

SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (Cont.)

AUDIOCODES LTD. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES

Intangible assets that are not considered to have an indefinite useful life are amortized using the straight-line basis over their estimated
useful lives, which range from one to ten years. Recoverability of these assets is measured by a comparison of the carrying amount of the
asset to the undiscounted future cash flows expected to be generated by the assets. If the assets are considered to be impaired, the amount
of any impairment is measured as the difference between the carrying value and the fair value of the impaired assets.

During 2007 and 2009, no impairment charges were identified. During 2008, the Company recorded an impairment charge for intangible
assets in the amount of $ 5,898 (See also Note 1).

l.   Goodwill:

Goodwill  and  certain  other  purchased  intangible  assets  have  been  recorded  in  the  Company's  financial  statements  as  a  result  of
acquisitions.  Goodwill  represents  the  excess  of  the  purchase  price  in  a  business  combination  over  the  fair  value  of  net  tangible  and
intangible assets acquired under ASC 350 (formerly FAS 142), "Intangible, Goodwill and Other", Goodwill is not amortized, but rather
is subject to an annual impairment test. ASC 350 requires goodwill to be tested for impairment at least annually or between annual tests
in certain circumstances, and written down when impaired.

The  Company  performs  annual  impairment  analysis  of  goodwill  at  December  31  of  each  year,  or  more  often  as  applicable.  The
provisions of ASC No. 350 require that a two-step impairment test be performed on goodwill at the level of the reporting units. In the
first step, the Company compares the fair value of each reporting unit to its carrying value. If the fair value exceeds the carrying value of
the net assets, goodwill is considered not impaired, and no further testing is required to be performed. If the carrying value of the net
assets exceeds the fair value, then the Company must perform the second step of the impairment test in order to determine the implied
fair value of goodwill. If the carrying value of goodwill exceeds its implied fair value, then the Company would record an impairment
loss equal to the difference.

The  Company  believes  that  its  business  activity  and  management  structure  meet  the  criterion  of  being  a  single  reporting  unit  for
accounting  purposes.  The  Company  has  performed  an  annual  impairment  analysis  as  of  December  31,  2007,  2008  and  2009  using
discounted cash flows, market multiples and market capitalization. Significant estimates used in the methodologies include estimates of
future cash-flows, future short-term and long-term growth rates, weighted average cost of capital and market multiples for the reporting
unit.

During 2007 and 2009, no impairment charges were identified. In 2008, as the fair value of the net assets of the reporting unit was lower
than the carrying value as of the valuation date, the goodwill was deemed to be impaired and step 2 analysis was required. During 2008,
an impairment charge to goodwill in the amount of $ 79,117 was recorded. (See also Note 1).

F-16

 
  
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
U.S. dollars in thousands, except share and per share data

NOTE 2:-

SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (Cont.)

m.   Revenue recognition:

AUDIOCODES LTD. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES

The Group generates its revenues primarily from the sale of products through a direct sales force and sales representatives. The Group's
products  are  delivered  to  its  customers,  which  include  original  equipment  manufacturers,  network  equipment  providers,  systems
integrators and distributors in the telecommunications and networking industries, all of whom are considered end-users.

Revenues from products are recognized in accordance with Staff Accounting Bulletin ("SAB") No. 104), "Revenue Recognition", when
the  following  criteria  are  met:  persuasive  evidence  of  an  arrangement  exists,  delivery  of  the  product  has  occurred,  the  fee  is  fixed  or
determinable, and collectability is probable. The Group has no remaining obligation to customers after the date on which products are
delivered other than pursuant to warranty obligations and right of return.

The Group grants to certain customers a right of return or the ability to exchange a specific percentage of the total price paid for products
they have purchased over a limited period for other products. The Group maintains a provision for product returns and exchanges based
on its experience with historical sales returns, analysis of credit memo data and other known factors, in accordance with ASC No. 605.
The  provision  was  deducted  from  revenues  and  amounted  to  $  559,  $  754  and  $  656,  as  of  December  31,  2007,  2008  and  2009,
respectively.

Revenues from the sale of products which were not yet determined to be final sales due to market acceptance were deferred and included
in deferred revenues. In cases where collectability is not probable, revenues are deferred and recognized upon collection.

n.   Warranty costs:

The Group generally provides a warranty period of 12 months at no extra charge. The Group estimates the costs that may be incurred
under its basic limited warranty and records a liability in the amount of such costs at the time product revenue is recognized. Factors that
affect the Group's warranty liability include the number of installed units, historical and anticipated rates of warranty claims, and cost per
claim. The Group periodically assesses the adequacy of its recorded warranty liability and adjusts the amount as necessary.

o.   Research and development costs:

Research and development costs, net of government grants received, are charged to the statement of operations as incurred.

p.   Income taxes:

The Group accounts for income taxes in accordance with ASC 740 (formerly FAS 109), "Income Taxes". ASC 740 prescribes the use of
the liability method whereby deferred tax asset and liability account balances are determined based on differences between the financial
reporting and tax bases of assets and liabilities and for carryforward losses. Deferred taxes are measured using the enacted tax rates and
laws  that  will  be  in  effect  when  the  differences  are  expected  to  reverse.  The  Group  provides  a  valuation  allowance,  if  necessary,  to
reduce deferred tax assets to their estimated realizable value if it is more likely than not that some portion or all of the deferred tax asset
will not be realized.

F-17

 
  
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
U.S. dollars in thousands, except share and per share data

NOTE 2:-

SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (Cont.)

AUDIOCODES LTD. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES

ASC  740  prescribes  a  recognition  threshold  and  measurement  attribute  for  financial  statement  recognition  and  measurement  of  a  tax
position  taken  or  expected  to  be  taken  in  a  tax  return  and  also  provides  guidance  on  various  related  matters  such  as  derecognition,
interest and penalties, and disclosure. On January 1, 2007, the Company adopted an amendment to ASC 740. The initial application of
the amendment did not have a material effect on the Company's shareholders' equity. The Company recognizes interest and penalties, if
any, related to unrecognized tax benefits in tax expenses.

q.   Comprehensive income (loss)

The Company accounts for comprehensive income (loss) in accordance with ASC 220 (formerly FAS 130) "Comprehensive Income".
ASC 220 establishes standards for the reporting and display of comprehensive income and its components in a full set of general purpose
financial  statements.  Comprehensive  income  generally  represents  all  changes  in  shareholders'  equity  during  the  period  except  those
resulting from investments by, or distributions to, shareholders. The Company determined that its items of comprehensive income (loss)
relates to gains and losses on hedging derivatives instruments.

r.   Concentrations of credit risk:

Financial instruments that potentially subject the Group to concentrations of credit risk consist principally of cash and cash equivalents,
bank deposits, marketable securities, trade receivables and foreign currency derivative contracts.

The majority of the Group's cash and cash equivalents and bank deposits are invested in U.S. dollar instruments with major banks in
Israel  and  the  United  States.  Such  investments  in  the  United  States  may  be  in  excess  of  insured  limits  and  are  not  insured  in  other
jurisdictions. Management believes that the financial institutions that hold the Group's investments are in corporations with high credit
standing. Accordingly, management believes that minimal credit risk exists with respect to these financial investments.

The  trade  receivables  of  the  Group  are  derived  from  sales  to  customers  located  primarily  in  the  Americas,  the  Far  East,  Israel  and
Europe. However, under certain circumstances, the Group may require letters of credit, other collateral, additional guarantees or advance
payments. Regarding certain credit balances, the Group is covered by foreign trade risk insurance. The Group performs ongoing credit
evaluations of its customers and establishes an allowance for doubtful accounts based upon a specific review.

s.   Senior convertible notes:

Effective January 1, 2009, the Company adopted an amendment to ASC 470-20, "Debt with Conversion and Other Options" (originally
issued as FSP APB 14-1, "Accounting for Convertible debt Instruments that may be settled in cash upon conversion"). FSP APB 14-1
specifies  that  issuers  of  such  instruments  should  separately  account  for  the  liability  and  equity  components  on  the  issuance  day  in  a
manner  that  will  reflect  the  entity's  nonconvertible  debt  borrowing  rate  when  interest  cost  is  recognized  in  subsequent  periods.  The
amended ASC 470-20 is effective for financial statements issued for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2008, and interim periods
within those fiscal years. The Company applied this amendment to ASC 470-20 retrospectively to all periods presented and comparative
figures have been adjusted accordingly. See also Note 10.

F-18

 
  
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
U.S. dollars in thousands, except share and per share data

NOTE 2:-

SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (Cont.)

AUDIOCODES LTD. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES

The Company presents the outstanding principal amount of its senior convertible notes as a long-term liability, in accordance with ASC
210-10-45.  The  debt  is  classified  as  a  long-term  liability  until  the  date  of  conversion  on  which  it  would  be  reclassified  to  equity,  or
within one year of the first contractual redemption date, on which it would be reclassified as a short-term liability. Accrued interest on
the senior convertible notes is included in "other payables and accrued expenses".

The initial purchasers discount on the debt is amortized according to the interest method over the expected five-year term of the senior
convertible notes in accordance with ASC 470,-20 This five-years-period ended in November 2009. Please refer also to Note 10.

According  to  ASC  470-20,  if  an  instrument  within  the  scope  of  this  ASC  is  repurchased,  an  issuer  shall  allocate  the  consideration
transferred and related transaction costs incurred, to the extinguishment of the liability component and the reacquisition of the equity
component.

t.   Basic and diluted net earnings per share:

Basic  net  earnings  per  share  are  computed  based  on  the  weighted  average  number  of  ordinary  shares  outstanding  during  each  year.
Diluted net earnings per share are computed based on the weighted average number of ordinary shares outstanding during each year, plus
potential  dilutive  ordinary  shares  considered  outstanding  during  the  year,  in  accordance  with  ASC  No.  260  (formerly  FAS  128),
"Earnings Per Share".

Senior convertible notes and certain outstanding stock options and warrants have been excluded from the calculation of the diluted net
earnings per ordinary share since such securities are anti-dilutive for all years presented. The total weighted average number of shares
related to the senior convertible notes and outstanding options and warrants that have been excluded from the calculations of diluted net
income per share was 11,765,438, 12,156,728 and 8,768,909 for the years ended December 31, 2007, 2008 and 2009, respectively.

u. Accounting for stock-based compensation:

The  Company  accounts  for  stock-based  compensation  in  accordance  with  ASC  718  formerly  FAS  123(R))  "Compensation-Stock
Compensation"  requires  companies  to  estimate  the  fair  value  of  equity-based  payment  awards  on  the  date  of  grant  using  an  option-
pricing model. The value of the portion of the award that is ultimately expected to vest is recognized as an expense over the requisite
service periods in the Company's consolidated statement of operations.

The Company recognizes compensation expenses for the value of its awards based on the accelerated method over the requisite service
period  of  each  of  the  awards,  net  of  estimated  forfeitures.  ASC  No.  718  requires  forfeitures  to  be  estimated  at  the  time  of  grant  and
revised,  if  necessary,  in  subsequent  periods  if  actual  forfeitures  differ  from  those  estimates.  Estimated  forfeitures  are  based  on  actual
historical pre-vesting forfeitures.

The Company applies ASC 718 and ASC 505-50 (formerly, EITF 96-18), "Equity-Based Payments to Non-Employees" with respect to
options and warrants issued to non-employees. Accordingly, the Company uses option valuation models to measure the fair value of the
options and warrants at the measurement date as defined in ASC 505-50.

During 2008 and 2009, the Company decided on an exceptional and ex-gratia basis to extend the validity of certain options granted to
employees by a period of 1-2 years and re-priced the exercise price to certain employees.

F-19

 
  
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
U.S. dollars in thousands, except share and per share data

NOTE 2:-

SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (Cont.)

AUDIOCODES LTD. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES

The Company accounted for these changes as modification in accordance with ASC 718. A modification to the terms of an award should
be treated as an exchange of the original award for a new award with total compensation cost equal to the grant-date fair value of the
original award plus the incremental value measured at the same date. Under ASC 718, the calculation of the incremental value is based
on the excess of the fair value of the new (modified) award based on current circumstances over the fair value of the original option
measured immediately before its terms are modified based on current circumstances.

The  weighted-average  estimated  fair  value  of  employee  stock  options  granted  during  the  years  ended  December  31,  2007,  2008  and
2009, was $ 3.23, $ 1.89 and $ 1.22 per share, respectively, using the Black-Scholes option pricing formula. Fair values were estimated
using the following weighted-average assumptions (annualized percentages):

Dividend yield
Expected volatility
Risk-free interest
Expected life
Forfeiture rate

Year ended December 31,
2008

2007

2009

0%   
54.7%   
4.6%   

0%   
52.0%   
2.6%   

0%
48.7%
2.3%

4.8 years 

4.8 years 

7.0%   

11.0%   

5.0 years 

7.0%

The Company used its historical volatility in accordance with ASC 718. The computation of volatility uses historical volatility derived
from the Company's exchange traded shares. In 2009, the expected term of options granted is estimated based on historical experience
and  represents  the  period  of  time  that  options  granted  are  expected  to  be  outstanding.  In  2006  and  2008,  the  expected  term  was
determined  based  on  the  simplified  method  in  accordance  with  SAB  107  and  SAB  110.  The  risk  free  interest  rate  assumption  is  the
implied yield currently available on United States treasury zero-coupon issues with a remaining term equal to the expected life of the
Company's  options.  The  dividend  yield  assumption  is  based  on  the  Company's  historical  experience  and  expectation  of  no  future
dividend payouts and may be subject to substantial change in the future. The Company has historically not paid cash dividends and has
no foreseeable plans to pay cash dividends in the future.

The  total  equity-based  compensation  expense  relating  to  all  of  the  Company's  equity-based  awards  recognized  for  the  twelve  months
ended December 31, 2007, 2008 and 2009 was included in items of the consolidated statements of income as follows:

Cost of revenues
Research and development, net
Selling and marketing expenses
General and administrative expenses

Year ended December 31,
2008

2007

2009

  $

613    $
3,011     
3,476     
867     

318    $
1,467     
2,026     
530     

117 
642 
913 
319 

Total equity-based compensation expenses

  $

7,967    $

4,341    $

1,991 

F-20

 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
   
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
 
   
     
     
 
   
   
   
 
   
      
      
  
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
U.S. dollars in thousands, except share and per share data

NOTE 2:-

SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (Cont.)

v. Treasury stock:

AUDIOCODES LTD. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES

The Company has repurchased its ordinary shares from time to time in the open market and holds such shares as treasury stock. The
Company presents the cost to repurchase treasury stock as a reduction of shareholders' equity.

w. Severance pay:

The  liability  for  severance  pay  for  Israeli  employees  is  calculated  pursuant  to  Israel's  Severance  Pay  Law,  based  on  the  most  recent
salary  of  the  employees  multiplied  by  the  number  of  years  of  employment  as  of  the  balance  sheet  date  for  all  employees  in  Israel.
Employees are entitled to one month's salary for each year of employment, or a portion thereof. The Group's liability for all of its Israeli
employees is fully provided for by monthly deposits with severance pay funds, insurance policies and by an accrual. The value of these
deposits is recorded as an asset in the Company's balance sheet.

The  deposited  funds  include  profits  accumulated  up  to  the  balance  sheet  date.  The  deposited  funds  may  be  withdrawn  only  upon  the
fulfillment of the obligation pursuant to Israel's Severance Pay Law or labor agreements.

Severance  pay  expenses  for  the  years  ended  December  31,  2007,  2008  and  2009,  amounted  to  approximately  $  2,409,  $  2,701  and
$1,136, respectively.

x. Employee benefit plan:

During 2007, the Group merged its separate 401(k) defined contribution plans into one plan covering employees in the U.S. All eligible
employees may elect to contribute a portion of their annual compensation to the plan through salary deferrals, subject to the IRS limit of
$ 16.5 during 2009 ($ 22 including catch-up contributions for participants age 50 or over). The Group matches employee contributions
to  the  plan  up  to  a  limit  of  3.75%  of  their  eligible  compensation,  subject  to  IRS  limits.  In  2007,  2008  and  2009,  the  Group  matched
contributions in the amount of $ 361, $ 380 and $ 280, respectively.

y. Advertising expenses:

Advertising expenses are charged to the statements of operations as incurred. Advertising expenses for the years ended December 31,
2007, 2008 and 2009, amounted to $ 350, $ 407 and $139, respectively.

z. Fair value of financial instruments:

The estimated fair value of financial instruments has been determined by the Group using available market information and valuation
methodologies.  Considerable  judgment  is  required  in  estimating  fair  values.  Accordingly,  the  estimates  may  not  be  indicative  of  the
amounts the Company could realize in a current market exchange.

The following methods and assumptions were used by the Group in estimating its fair value disclosures for financial instruments:

F-21

 
  
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
U.S. dollars in thousands, except share and per share data

NOTE 2:-

SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (Cont.)

AUDIOCODES LTD. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES

The carrying amounts of cash and cash equivalents, short-term bank deposits, trade receivables and trade payables approximate their fair
value  due  to  the  short-term  maturity  of  such  instruments.  The  fair  value  of  long-term  bank  loans  and  senior  convertible  loans  also
approximates their carrying value, since they bear interest at rates close to the prevailing market rates.

The fair value of foreign currency contracts (used for hedging purposes) is estimated by obtaining current quotes from banks.

Fair value is an exit price, representing the amount that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly
transaction  between  market  participants.  As  such,  fair  value  is  a  market-based  measurement  that  should  be  determined  based  on
assumptions that market participants would use in pricing an asset or a liability. As a basis for considering such assumptions, ASC 820
establishes a three-tier value hierarchy, which prioritizes the inputs used in the valuation methodologies in measuring fair value:

Level 1
Level 2

Level 3

-
-

-

Observable inputs that reflect quoted prices (unadjusted) for identical assets or liabilities in active markets.
Observable inputs,  other  than  quoted  prices  included  in  Level  1,  such  as  quoted  prices  for  similar  assets  and
liabilities  in  active  markets;  quoted  prices  for  identical  or  similar  assets  and  liabilities  in  markets  that  are  not
active; or other inputs that are observable or can be corroborated by observable market data
Unobservable inputs which are supported by little or no market activity and that are significant to the fair value
of the assets and liabilities. This includes certain pricing models, discounted cash flow methodologies and similar
techniques that use significant unobservable inputs

The fair value hierarchy also requires an entity to maximize the use of observable inputs and minimize the use of unobservable inputs
when measuring fair value. (see also Notes 3 and 8).

The  Company  adopted  the  provisions  of  ASC  820-10,  "Fair  Value  Measurements  and  Disclosures"  (formerly  FAS  157,  "Fair  Value
Measurements"), with respect to non-financial assets and liabilities effective January 1, 2009. The adoption of ASC 820-10 did not have
a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

In  April  2009,  the  Company  adopted  the  FASB's  updated  guidance  ASC  820-10  (formerly,  FSP  FAS  157-4),  related  to  fair  value
measurements and disclosures, which provides additional guidance for estimating fair value in accordance with the guidance related to
fair value measurements when the volume and level of activity for an asset or liability have significantly decreased. The amended ASC
820-10 also includes guidance on identifying circumstances that indicate a transaction is not orderly. The adoption of this guidance did
not have a material effect on the consolidated financial statements.

aa. Consolidation

On January 1, 2009, the Company adopted an amendment to ASC 810, "Consolidation" (originally issued as FAS 160). According to the
amendment,  non-controlling  interest  in  a  subsidiary  is  an  ownership  interest  in  the  consolidated  entity  that  should  be  reported  as  a
separate  component  of  equity  in  the  consolidated  financial  statements.  As  such,  changes  in  the  parent's  ownership  interest  with  no
change of control are treated as equity transactions, rather than step acquisitions or dilution gains or losses. The amendment clarifies that
losses  of  partially  owned  consolidated  subsidiaries  shall  continue  to  be  allocated  to  the  non-controlling  interests  even  when  their
investment was already reduced to zero.

F-22

 
  
 
 
 
 
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
U.S. dollars in thousands, except share and per share data

NOTE 2:-

SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (Cont.)

AUDIOCODES LTD. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES

The amendment applies prospectively, except for the presentation and disclosure requirements, which are applied retrospectively to all
periods presented. As a result, upon adoption, the Company retroactively reclassified the "Minority interests" balance to be presented in
a new caption in total shareholders' equity, "Non-controlling interest". The adoption also impacted certain captions previously used in the
consolidated statement of operations, largely identifying net loss including the portion attributable to non-controlling interest and net loss
attributable to AudioCodes' shareholders. This amendment required the Company to include the accumulated amount of non-controlling
interest as part of shareholders' equity ($ 228 at December 31, 2008).

The net loss amounts the Company has previously reported are now presented as "Net loss attributable to AudioCodes' shareholders,"
and, as required, net loss per share continue to reflect amounts attributable only to AudioCodes' shareholders. Similarly, in the statements
of  changes  in  shareholders'  equity,  the  Company  distinguished  between  equity  amounts  attributable  to  AudioCodes'  shareholders  and
amounts attributable to the non-controlling interest.

ab. Variable interest entities

ASC 810-10, "Consolidation" provides a framework for identifying Variable Interest Entities ("VIEs") and determining when a company
should include the assets, liabilities, non-controlling interests and results of activities of a VIE in its consolidated financial statements.

The Company’s assessment of whether an entity is a VIE and the determination of the primary beneficiary is judgmental in nature and
involves the use of estimates and assumptions. Those include, among others, forecasted cash flows, their respective probabilities and the
economic value of certain preference rights. In addition, such assessment also involves estimates of whether a group entity can finance
its current activities, until it reaches profitability, without additional subordinated financial support.

ac. Derivatives and hedging:

The  Company  accounts  for  derivatives  and  hedging  based  on  ASC  815  (formerly  FAS  133),  "Derivatives  and  Hedging"  ("ASC  No.
815").

The Company accounts for its derivative instruments as either assets or liabilities and carries them at fair value. Derivative instruments
that are not designated and qualified as hedging instruments must be adjusted to fair value through earnings.

For derivative instruments that hedge the exposure to variability in expected future cash flows that are designated as cash flow hedges,
the effective portion of the gain or loss on the derivative instrument is reported as a component of accumulated other comprehensive
income (loss) in equity and reclassified into earnings in the same period or periods during which the hedged transaction affects earnings
and is classified as finance income (expense), net. The ineffective portion of the gain or loss on the derivative instrument is recognized in
current earnings and classified as finance income. To receive hedge accounting treatment, cash flow hedges must be highly effective in
offsetting changes to expected future cash flows on hedged transactions.
During 2009, the Company recorded accumulated other comprehensive income in the amount of $ 1,010 from its currency forward with
respect to payroll and rent expenses expected to be incurred during 2009. Such amount will be recorded into earnings during 2010. See
also Note 18.

F-23

 
  
 
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
U.S. dollars in thousands, except share and per share data

NOTE 2:-

SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (Cont.)

ad. Codification:

AUDIOCODES LTD. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES

In June 2009, the Financial Accounting Standards Board ("FASB") issued a standard that established the FASB Accounting Standards
Codification ("ASC") and amended the hierarchy of generally accepted accounting principles ("GAAP") such that the ASC became the
single source of authoritative U.S. GAAP. Rules and interpretive releases issued by the SEC under authority of federal securities law are
also  sources  of  the  authoritative  GAAP  for  SEC  registrants.  All  other  literature  is  considered  non-authoritative.  New  accounting
standards issued subsequent to June 30, 2009 are communicated by the FASB through Accounting Standards Updates ("ASUs"). The
ASC is effective for the Company from September 1, 2009. Throughout the notes to the consolidated financial statements references that
were previously made to former authoritative U.S. GAAP pronouncements have been changed to coincide with the appropriate section
of the ASC.

ae. Impact of recently issued accounting pronouncements:

(1)

In October 2009, the FASB issued an update to ASC No. 605-25, "Revenue recognition - Multiple-Element Arrangements", that
provides amendments to the criteria for separating consideration in multiple-deliverable arrangements to:

a)

b)

c)

d)

Provide updated guidance on whether multiple deliverables exist, how the deliverables  in  an  arrangement  should  be
separated, and how the consideration should be allocated;
Require an  entity  to  allocate  revenue  in  an  arrangement  using  estimated  selling  prices  ("ESP")  of  deliverables  if  a
vendor does not have vendor-specific objective evidence of selling price ("VSOE") or third-party evidence of selling
price ("TPE");
Eliminate  the  use  of  the  residual  method  and  require  an  entity  to  allocate  revenue  using  the  relative  selling  price
method.
Require  expanded  disclosures  of  qualitative  and  quantitative  information  regarding  application  of  the  multiple-
deliverable revenue arrangement guidance.

The  mandatory  adoption  date  is  January  1,  2011.  The  Company  may  elect  to  adopt  the  update  prospectively,  to  new  or
materially modified arrangements beginning on the adoption date, or retrospectively, for all periods presented. The Company is
currently evaluating the impact of this update on its consolidated results of operations and financial condition.

(2)

In January  2010,  the  FASB  updated  the  "Fair  Value  Measurements  Disclosures".  More  specifically,  this  update  will  require
(a) an entity to disclose separately the amounts of significant transfers in and out of Level 1 and 2 fair value measurements and
to describe the reasons for the transfers; and (b) information about purchases, sales, issuances and settlements to be presented
separately  (i.e.  present  the  activity  on  a  gross  basis  rather  than  net)  in  the  reconciliation  for  fair  value  measurements  using
significant  unobservable  inputs  (Level  3  inputs).  This  update  clarifies  existing  disclosure  requirements  for  the  level  of
disaggregation  used  for  classes  of  assets  and  liabilities  measured  at  fair  value,  and  requires  disclosures  about  the  valuation
techniques and inputs used to measure fair value for both recurring and nonrecurring fair value measurements using Level 2 and
Level  3  inputs.  As  applicable  to  the  Company,  this  will  become  effective  as  of  the  first  interim  or  annual  reporting  period
beginning after December 15, 2009, except for the gross presentation of the Level 3 roll forward information, which is required
for  annual  reporting  periods  beginning  after  December  15,  2010  and  for  interim  reporting  periods  within  those  years.  The
Company  does  not  expect  that  the  adoption  of  the  new  guidance  will  have  a  material  impact  on  its  consolidated  financial
statements.

F-24

 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
AUDIOCODES LTD. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
U.S. dollars in thousands, except share and per share data

NOTE 2:-

SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (Cont.)

(3)

In  June  2009,  the  FASB  issued  an  update  to  ASC  810,  "Consolidation,"  which,  among  other  things,  (i)  requires  ongoing
reassessments  of  whether  an  entity  is  the  primary  beneficiary  of  a  variable  interest  entity  and  eliminates  the  quantitative
approach previously required for determining the primary beneficiary of a variable interest entity; (ii) amends certain guidance
for determining whether an entity is a variable interest entity; and (iii) requires enhanced disclosure that will provide users of
financial statements with more transparent information about an entity’s involvement in a variable interest entity. The update is
effective for interim and annual periods beginning after November 15, 2009. The Company does not expect the adoption of the
update to have a material impact on its financial condition or results of operations.

af. Reclassification:

Certain  2008  figures  have  been  reclassified  to  conform  to  the  2009  presentation.  The  reclassification  had  no  effect  on  previously
reported net income (loss), shareholders' equity or cash flows.

NOTE 3:-

MARKETABLE SECURITIES AND ACCRUED INTEREST

The following is a summary of held to maturity marketable securities.

Corporate debentures:
Maturing within one year

Accrued interest

December 31, 2008
Net

  Amortized    
cost

unrealized    

losses

Fair
Value

  $

16,253    $

1    $

16,252 

16,253     

228     

1     

-     

16,252 

228 

  $

16,481    $

1    $

16,480 

The unrealized losses on the Company's investments are due to interest rate increases. The contractual cash flows of these investments were
issued by highly rated corporations. Accordingly, it was expected that the securities would not be settled at a price less than the amortized cost
of  the  Company's  investment.  Since  the  Company  had  the  ability  and  intent  to  hold  these  investments  until  a  recovery  of  fair  value,  the
Company did not consider these investments to be other-than-temporarily impaired as of December 31, 2008.

During 2009, all marketable securities were redeemed upon contractual maturity.

F-25

 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
     
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
   
     
     
 
 
   
      
      
  
 
   
 
   
      
      
  
   
 
   
      
      
  
 
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
U.S. dollars in thousands, except share and per share data

NOTE 4:-

INVENTORIES

Raw materials
Finished products

AUDIOCODES LTD. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES

December 31,

2008

2009

  $

9,346    $
11,277     

5,923 
7,593 

  $

20,623    $

13,516 

In  the  years  ended  December  31,  2007,  2008  and  2009,  the  Group  wrote-off  inventories  in  a  total  amount  of  $  973,  $  2,356  and  $  3,421,
respectively.

NOTE 5:-

INVESTMENT IN COMPANIES

a. As of December 31, 2009 the Company owns 20.21% of Mailvision's outstanding share capital.

Invested in equity
Loans
Accumulated net loss

Total investment

December 31,

2008

2009

  $

993    $
301     
(49)    

993 
642 
(125)

  $

1,245    $

1,510 

b.

In December 2006, the Company extended a convertible loan in the amount of $ 1,000 to another unrelated privately held company. The
loan bears interest at LIBOR+2% per annum and was due and payable in December 2007. In December, 2007, the Company requested
repayment of this loan. During 2008, the Company received back shares of another unrelated privately-held company and $ 870 in cash.
The remaining balance of the loan in the amount of $ 130 and received shares were written off.

NOTE 6:-

PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT

Cost:

Computers and peripheral equipment
Office furniture and equipment
Leasehold improvements

Accumulated depreciation:

Computers and peripheral equipment
Office furniture and equipment
Leasehold improvements

December 31,

2008

2009

  $

18,645    $
9,466     
2,437     

19,852 
9,458 
2,354 

30,548     

31,664 

15,507     
7,154     
1,043     

17,359 
8,276 
1,073 

23,704     

26,708 

Depreciated cost

  $

6,844    $

4,956 

Depreciation expenses amounted to $ 3,392, $ 3,602 and $ 3,159 for the years ended December 31, 2007, 2008 and 2009, respectively.

F-26

 
  
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
     
 
   
 
   
      
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
     
 
   
   
 
   
      
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
     
 
   
   
 
   
      
  
 
   
   
      
  
   
   
   
 
   
      
  
 
   
 
   
      
  
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
U.S. dollars in thousands, except share and per share data

NOTE 7:-

INTANGIBLE ASSETS, DEFERRED CHARGES

a.    Cost:

Acquired technology
Customer relationship
Trade name
Existing contracts for maintenance
Deferred charges

Accumulated amortization:
Acquired technology
Customer relationship
Trade name
Existing contracts for maintenance
Deferred charges

Impairment:
Acquired technology
Customer relationship
Trade name
Existing contracts for maintenance

AUDIOCODES LTD. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES

Useful life
(years)

December 31,

2008

2009

    $

5-10
9
3
3
5

17,512    $
8,001     
466     
204     
478     

17,512 
8,001 
466 
204 
478 

26,661     

26,661 

8,847     
2,222     
389     
170     
429     

10,321 
2,521 
415 
181 
478 

12,057     

13,916 

1,995     
3,829     
51     
23     

1,995 
3,829 
51 
23 

5,898     

5,898 

Amortized cost

     $

8,706    $

6,847 

b. Amortization expenses related to intangible assets amounted to $ 4,397, $ 3,839 and $ 1,810 for the years ended December 31, 2007,

2008 and 2009, respectively.

c. Amortization expenses related to deferred charges amounted to $ 96, $ 94 and $ 49 for the years ended December 31, 2007, 2008

and 2009, respectively.

d. Expected amortization expenses for the years ended December 31:

2010
2011
2012
2013
 2014
 2015 and thereafter

  $
  $
  $
  $
  $
  $

1,530 
1,327 
1,124 
933 
869 
1,064 

F-27

 
  
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
   
     
     
 
 
   
 
   
     
 
   
     
 
   
     
 
   
     
 
 
   
      
      
  
 
 
   
      
 
   
      
      
  
 
   
      
 
   
      
 
   
      
 
   
      
 
   
      
 
 
   
      
      
  
 
 
   
      
 
   
      
      
  
 
   
      
 
   
      
 
   
      
 
   
      
 
 
   
      
      
  
 
 
   
      
 
 
   
      
      
  
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
U.S. dollars in thousands, except share and per share data

NOTE 8:-

FAIR VALUE MEASUREMENTS

In accordance with ASC No. 820, the Company measures its foreign currency derivative instruments at fair value. Investments in foreign
currency derivative instruments are classified within Level 2 value hierarchy. This is because these assets are valued using alternative pricing
sources and models utilizing market observable inputs.

AUDIOCODES LTD. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES

Foreign currency derivative instruments

NOTE 9:-

OTHER PAYABLES AND ACCRUED EXPENSES

Employees and payroll accruals
Royalties provision
Government authorities
Accrued expenses
Deferred revenues
Others

NOTE 10:-

SENIOR CONVERTIBLE NOTES

December 31,

2008

2009

(912)    

98 

December 31,

2008

2009

  $

7,537    $
1,066     
184     
11,342     
3,695     
137     

6,947 
1,403 
594 
8,172 
1,964 
470 

  $

23,961    $

19,550 

In  November  2004,  the  Company  issued  an  aggregate  of  $  125,000  (including  the  exercise  of  the  option  as  described  below)  principal
amount of its 2% Senior Convertible Notes due November 9, 2024 ("the Notes"). The Company is obligated to pay interest on the Notes
semi-annually on May 9 and November 9 of each year.

The  Notes  are  convertible,  at  the  option  of  the  holders  at  any  time  before  the  maturity  date,  into  ordinary  shares  of  the  Company  at  a
conversion rate of 53.4474 ordinary shares per $ 1 principal amount of Notes, representing a conversion price of approximately $ 18.71 per
share. Upon such conversion in lieu of the delivering of ordinary shares, the Company may elect to pay the holders cash or a combination of
cash and ordinary shares. The Notes are subject to redemption at any time on or after November 9, 2009, in whole or in part, at the option of
the Company, at a redemption price of 100% of the principal amount plus accrued and unpaid interest. The Notes are subject to repurchase, at
the holders' option, on November 9, 2009, November 9, 2014 or November 9, 2019, at a repurchase price equal to 100% of the principal
amount plus accrued and unpaid interest, if any, on such repurchase date. The Company may choose to settle in cash upon conversion.

F-28

 
  
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
     
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
     
 
   
   
   
   
   
 
   
      
  
 
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
U.S. dollars in thousands, except share and per share data

NOTE 10:-

SENIOR CONVERTIBLE NOTES (Cont.)

AUDIOCODES LTD. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES

Effective January 1, 2009, the Company adopted the amendment to ASC 470-20 (formerly FSP APB 14-1) "Debt with Conversion and Other
Options". The amendment specifies that issuers of such instruments should separately account for the liability and equity components in a
manner that will reflect the entity's nonconvertible debt borrowing rate when interest cost is recognized in subsequent periods. As a result,
the Company recorded an additional $ 2,775 interest expense in 2009.

The cumulative effect of the change in accounting principle on periods prior to these presented in the amount of $ 9,329 is recognized as of
the beginning of the first period presented, as an offsetting adjustment to the opening balance of retained earnings for that period. In addition,
an increase of         $ 20,251 was recorded to additional paid in capital as of January 1, 2007.

During  2008  and  2009,  the  Company  repurchased  $  51,500  and  $73,100,  respectively,  in  principal  amount  of  its  2%  Senior  Convertible
Notes for a total cost, including accrued interest, of $ 50,200 and $ 73,147, respectively. Based on the amended ASC-470-20 and as a result
of the repurchase, the Company recorded a gain in the amount of $ 372 related to the liability component and a decrease of additional paid-in
capital in the amount of $ 1,109 related to the equity component in its 2008 statements of operations. There was no gain or loss in connection
with the repurchase in 2009. As of December 31, 2009, $ 403 in the principal amount of the notes remained outstanding.

The  following  tables  shows  the  financial  statements  line  items  affected  by  retrospective  application  of  an  amendment  to  ASC  470-20
(formerly FSP APB 14-1), "Debt with Conversion and Other Options" on the affected financial statement line items for the periods indicated:

Year ended December 31,

2007

2008

As
previously
reported

Effect of
change

As
adjusted
under the
amended
ASC 
470-20

As
previously
reported

Effect of
change

As
adjusted
under the
amended
ASC 
470-20

2,670     
(1,523)    
(3,885)    

(4,837)    
(4,837)    
(4,837)    

(2,167)    
(6,360)    
(8,722)    

1,182     
(78,253)    
(81,340)    

(4,450)    
(4,450)    
(4,450)    

(3,268)
(82,703)
(85,790)

  $

(0.09)   $

(0.11)   $

(0.2)   $

(1.97)   $

(0.11)   $

(2.08)

F-29

Financial income (loss)
Loss before income taxes
Net loss

Net loss per share:
Basic and diluted

 
  
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
   
 
 
   
     
     
     
     
     
 
   
   
   
 
   
      
      
      
      
      
  
   
      
      
      
      
      
  
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
U.S. dollars in thousands, except share and per share data

NOTE 10:-

SENIOR CONVERTIBLE NOTES (Cont.)

Intangible assets, deferred charges and other, net
Total assets

Senior convertible note

Equity:

Additional paid-in capital
Accumulated deficit
Total equity

Total liabilities and equity

AUDIOCODES LTD. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES

December 31, 2008

As
previously
reported

Effect of
change

As adjusted
under the
amended
ASC 
470-20

9,084    $
230,482    $

(178)   $
(178)   $

8,906 
230,304 

71,374    $

(704)   $

70,670 

167,856    $
(58,678)   $
83,334    $

19,142    $
(18,616)   $
754    $

186,998 
(77,294)
84,088 

230,482    $

(178)   $

230,304 

  $
  $

  $

  $
  $
  $

  $

The  table  below  shows  the  components  of  the  net  carrying  amount  of  the  liability  component  and  the  equity  component  of  the  Notes  at
December 31, 2008 and at December 31, 2009:

Principal amount of liability component
Unamortized discount

Net carrying amount of liability component

Equity component

December 31,

2008

2009

  $

  $

  $

73,498    $
2,828     

70,670    $

403 
- 

403 

19,142    $

19,142 

The following represents the components of interest expense and effective interest rates relating to the Notes:

Contractual interest expense
Amortization of discount

Total interest expense

Effective interest rate

Year ended December 31,
2008

2009

2007

  $

  $

  $

2,498 
4,945 

  $

2,308 
4,868 

1,260 
2,828 

7,443 

  $

7,176 

  $

4,088 

3.35%   

3.35%   

3.35%

F-30

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
 
   
     
     
 
 
   
      
      
  
 
   
      
      
  
   
      
      
  
 
   
      
      
  
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
     
 
   
 
   
      
  
 
   
      
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
   
   
 
   
  
   
  
   
  
 
   
  
   
  
   
  
   
 
AUDIOCODES LTD. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
U.S. dollars in thousands, except share and per share data

NOTE 11:-

LONG-TERM BANK LOANS

In April and July 2008, the Company entered into loan agreements with banks in Israel and was provided with loans in the total amount of
$ 30,000. The loans bear interest at LIBOR plus 1.3%-1.5% with respect to $ 23,000 of the loans and LIBOR plus 0.5%-0.65% with respect
to  the  remaining  principal  amount  of  $  7,000  of  the  loans.  The  principal  amount  borrowed  is  repayable  in  20  equal  quarterly  payments
through  July  2013.  The  banks  have  a  lien  of  the  Company's  assets  and  the  Company  is  required  to  maintain  $  7,000  of  compensating
balances  with  the  banks  which  are  included  in  short  term  bank  deposits.  The  agreement  requires  the  Company,  among  other  things,  to
maintain equity at specified levels and to achieve certain levels of operating income. The agreement also restricts the Company from paying
dividends. As of December 31, 2009, the Company was in compliance with its covenants to the banks.

NOTE 12:-

COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENT LIABILITIES

a. Lease commitments:

The Group's facilities are rented under several lease agreements in Israel and the U.S. for periods ending in 2021.

Future minimum rental commitments under non-cancelable operating leases for the years ended December 31, are as follows:

2010
2011
2012
2013
2014
2015 and thereafter

  $

4,686 
6,146 
5,624 
2,399 
2,414 
12,901 

  $

34,170 

In connection with the Company's offices lease agreement in Israel, the lessor has a lien on $3,500 of short term bank deposits.

Rent expenses for the years ended December 31, 2007, 2008 and 2009, were approximately $ 4,471, $ 6,432 and $ 4,558, respectively.

b. Other commitments:

The Company is obligated under certain agreements with its suppliers to purchase specified items of excess inventory. Non- cancelable
obligations as of December 31, 2009, were approximately $ 930.

F-31

 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
U.S. dollars in thousands, except share and per share data

NOTE 12:-

COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENT LIABILITIES (Cont.)

c. Royalty commitment to the Office of the Chief Scientist of Israel ("OCS"):

AUDIOCODES LTD. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES

Under  the  research  and  development  agreements  of  the  Company  with  the  OCS  and  pursuant  to  applicable  laws,  the  Company  is
required to pay royalties at the rate of 3%-4.5% of sales of products developed with funds provided by the OCS, up to an amount equal
to 100% of the OCS research and development grants received, linked to the U.S. dollar plus interest on the unpaid amount received
based  on  the  12-month  LIBOR  rate  applicable  to  dollar  deposits.  The  Company  is  obligated  to  repay  the  Israeli  Government  for  the
grants received only to the extent that there are sales of the funded products.

As of December 31, 2009, the Company has a contingent obligation to pay royalties in the amount of approximately $ 8,715.

As of December 31, 2009, the Company has paid or accrued royalties to the OCS in the amount of $ 360, which was recorded to cost of
revenues.

d. Royalty commitments to third parties:

The Group has entered into technology licensing fee agreements with third parties. Under the agreements, the Group agreed to pay the
third parties royalties, based on sales of relevant products.

e. Legal proceedings:

In  September  2009,  Network  Gateway  Solutions  LLC  filed  a  claim  against  AudioCodes  Ltd.  and  AudioCodes  Inc.  and  19  other
defendants alleging infringement of certain patents. The case is still at an early stage. The amount of monetary demand or a settlement
demand of any kind was not indicated. Due to the preliminary stage of the claim, the Company and its legal advisors can not currently
assess the outcome or possible adverse effect on the Company's consolidated financial position or results of operations. However, the
Company believes that it has substantial legal claims to oppose these allegations.

Prior  to  the  acquisition  of  Nuera  Communications  Inc.  by  the  Company  in  2006,  one  of  Nuera’s  customers  had  been  named  as  a
defendant in a patent infringement suit involving technology the customer purchased from Nuera. In the suit, the plaintiff alleged that the
customer used devices to offer services that infringe upon a patent the plaintiff owns. The customer has sought indemnification from
Nuera pursuant to the terms of a purchase agreement between Nuera and the customer relating to the allegedly infringing technology at
issue. There were no additional  developments and the Company and its legal advisors can not currently assess the outcome or possible
adverse effect on the Company's financial position or results of operations. However, the Company believes that it has substantial legal
claims to oppose these allegations.

F-32

 
  
 
 
 
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
U.S. dollars in thousands, except share and per share data

NOTE 13:-

EQUITY

a. Treasury stock:

AUDIOCODES LTD. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES

In  January  2008,  the  Company's  Board  of  Directors  approved  a  new  share  repurchase  program  pursuant  to  which  the  Company  was
authorized to purchase up to an aggregate amount of 4,000,000 of its outstanding ordinary shares. During 2008, the Company purchased
an additional 3,450,217 of its outstanding ordinary shares under the new share repurchase plan, at a weighted average price per share of
$ 3.98.

b. Warrants issued to consultants:

During 2008, 10,000 warrants were granted to consultants at an exercise price of $ 4.82 per share, expiring seven years from the date of
grant.  The  Company  recorded  compensation  expenses  in  accordance  with  ASC  505.  The  amount  recorded  is  immaterial.  As  of
December 31, 2009, 10,000 warrants to consultants are outstanding and exercisable at an exercise price of $ 4.82 per share.

c. Employee Stock Purchase Plan:

In May 2001, the Company's Board of Directors adopted the Employee Stock Purchase Plan ("the Purchase Plan"), and, in July 2007,
amended the Purchase Plan. As amended, the Purchase Plan provides for the issuance of a maximum of 6,500,000 ordinary shares. As of
December 31, 2008, 4,004,683 shares were still available for future issuance under the Purchase Plan. Eligible employees can have up to
15% of their wages, up to certain maximums, used to purchase ordinary shares. The Purchase Plan is implemented with purchases every
six  months  occurring  on  January  31  and  July  31  of  each  year.  The  price  of  the  ordinary  shares  purchased  under  the  Purchase  Plan  is
equal to 85% of the lower of the fair market value of the ordinary shares on the commencement date of each offering period or on the
semi-annual  purchase  date.  The  Purchase  Plan  is  considered  a  compensatory  plan.  Therefore,  the  Company  recorded  compensation
expense in accordance with ASC 718, "Compensation - Stock Compensation", with respect to purchases under the Purchase Plan.

During the years ended December 31, 2007 and 2008, 649,853 and 319,453 shares, respectively, were issued under the Purchase Plan for
aggregate consideration of $ 3,619 and $ 1,214, respectively. During 2008, the Company's Board of Directors decided to suspend the
Purchase Plan.

d. Employee Stock Option Plans:

Under  the  Company's  1997  and  1999  Stock  Option  Plans,  options  to  purchase  ordinary  shares  may  be  granted  to  officers,  directors,
employees and consultants of the Group. As of December 31, 2009, both plans had expired and no options are available for future grants
under these plans.

During 2008, the Board of Directors approved the 2008 Equity Incentive Plan that is effective starting January 2009. As of December
31, 2009, the total number of shares authorized for grant under this Plan is 914,545.

Stock options granted under the abovementioned plans are exercisable at the fair market value of the ordinary shares at the date of grant
and  usually  expire  seven  or  ten  years  from  the  date  of  grant.  The  options  generally  vest  over  four  years  from  the  date  of  grant.  Any
options that are forfeited or cancelled before expiration become available for future grants.

F-33

 
  
 
 
 
 
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
U.S. dollars in thousands, except share and per share data

NOTE 13:-

EQUITY (Cont.)

The following is a summary of the Group's stock option activity and related information for the year ended December 31, 2009:

Year ended December 31, 2009

AUDIOCODES LTD. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES

Outstanding at beginning of year
Changes during the year:

Granted
Exercised
Forfeited
Expired

Weighted
average
remaining
contractual
term (in
years)

Aggregate
intrinsic
value

Amount
of options

Weighted
average
exercise
price

6,346,537    $

7.81     

  *)

1,094,577    $
(86,750)   $
(787,513)   $
(400,984)   $

1.82     
1.04     
7.09     
7.91     

Options outstanding at end of year

  *)

6,165,867    $

6.93     

3.0    $

Vested and expected to vest

5,734,256    $

6.93     

3.0    $

Options exercisable at end of year

4,419,161    $

8.10     

1.86    $

192 

178 

192 

*)         Including 40,269 restricted share units ("RSU'S") granted in December 2009.

The weighted-average grant-date fair value of options granted during the years ended December 31, 2007, 2008 and 2009 was $ 3.23,
$  1.80  and  $  1.22,  respectively.  The  aggregate  intrinsic  value  in  the  table  above  represents  the  total  intrinsic  value  (the  difference
between the Company's closing stock price on the last trading day of the fiscal year and the exercise price, multiplied by the number of
in-the-money  options)  that  would  have  been  received  by  the  option  holders  had  all  option  holders  exercised  their  options  on  the  last
trading day of the fiscal year. This amount changes based on the fair market value of the Company's shares.

Total intrinsic value of options exercised for the twelve months ended December 31, 2007, 2008 and 2009 was $ 613, $ 124 and $ 130,
respectively. As of December 31, 2009, there was $ 1,840 of total unrecognized compensation cost related to non-vested share-based
compensation arrangements granted under the Company's stock option plans. That cost is expected to be recognized over a weighted-
average period of 0.96 years.

The options outstanding as of December 31, 2009, have been separated into ranges of exercise prices, as follows:

Range of
exercise
price

Options
outstanding
 as of 
December 31,
2009

Weighted 
average 
remaining
contractual
 life
(Years)

Weighted
average
exercise 
price

Options
exercisable 
as of 
December 31,
2009

Weighted
average
exercise price
of exercisable
options

$
$
$
$
$
$
$

0-1.1 
1.50-2.51 
2.67-4.00 
4.10-6.49 
6.51-9.24 
9.32-14.76 
15.94 

256,569 
1,027,400 
502,263 
1,258,525 
691,710 
2,399,400 
30,000 

6,165,867 

0.44 
2.16 
2.89 
5.20 
7.68 
11.07 
15.94 

6.93 

103,800 
281,150 
278,391 
911,460 
637,210 
2,177,150 
30,000 

  $
  $
  $
  $
  $
  $
  $

4,419,161 

  $

1.10 
2.38 
3.00 
5.00 
7.75 
11.11 
15.94 

8.10 

4.19 
5.09 
3.40 
2.78 
1.20 
2.46 
1.99 

  $
  $
  $
  $
  $
  $
  $

3.0 

  $

F-34

 
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
   
 
 
   
     
     
     
 
   
     
 
   
      
      
     
 
     
 
   
     
 
   
     
 
   
     
 
 
   
      
      
     
 
 
   
      
      
      
  
   
 
   
      
      
      
  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
U.S. dollars in thousands, except share and per share data

NOTE 13:-

EQUITY (Cont.)

AUDIOCODES LTD. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES

e. During  2008  and  2009,  the  Company  decided  on  an  exceptional  and  ex-gratia  basis  to  extend  the  validity  of  895,138  and  231,400
options, respectively, granted to employees by a period of 1-2 years and re-priced the exercise price to certain employees. Total options
that were re-priced in 2008 and 2009, were 100,000 and 50,000, respectively. The exercise price was adjusted in 2008 from a range of
5.7-6.7 to 4.17 and in 2009 from a range 4.17-14.76 to 0.

The  Company  accounted  for  these  changes  as  modifications  in  accordance  with  ASC  718.  The  Company  calculated  the  incremental
value of these modifications and recorded compensation cost in a total amount of $ 402 and $ 208 for the years ended December 31,
2008 and 2009, respectively.

f. Dividends:

In the event that cash dividends are declared in the future, such dividends will be paid in NIS. The Company does not intend to pay cash
dividends in the foreseeable future. (See also Note 14a.)

NOTE 14:-

TAXES ON INCOME

a.

Israeli taxation:

1.

Measurement of taxable income:

The  Company  has  elected  to  measure  its  taxable  income  and  file  its  tax  return  under  the  Israeli  Income  Tax  Regulations
(Principles  Regarding  the  Management  of  Books  of  Account  of  Foreign  Invested  Companies  and  Certain  Partnerships  and  the
Determination of Their Taxable Income), 1986. Accordingly, results for tax purposes are measured in terms of earnings in dollars.

2.

Tax benefits under the Law for the Encouragement of Capital Investments, 1959 ("the Investment Law"):

The Company's production facilities have been granted the status of an "Approved Enterprise" in accordance with the Investment
Law under four separate investment programs. According to the provisions of such Israeli Investment Law, the Company has been
granted the "Alternative Benefit Plan", under which the main benefits are tax exemptions and reduced tax rates.

Therefore, the Company's income derived from the Approved Enterprise will be entitled to a tax exemption for a period of two
years and to an additional period of five to eight years of reduced tax rates of 10% - 25% (based on the percentage of foreign
ownership).  The  duration  of  tax  benefits  of  reduced  tax  rates  is  subject  to  a  limitation  of  the  earlier  of  12  years  from
commencement of production, or 14 years from the approval date. The Company utilized tax benefits from the first program in
1998  and  has  been  no  longer  eligible  for  benefits  since  2007.  Tax  benefits  from  the  remaining  programs  are  scheduled  to
gradually expire through 2013.

F-35

 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
U.S. dollars in thousands, except share and per share data

NOTE 14:-

TAXES ON INCOME (Cont.)

AUDIOCODES LTD. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES

As  of  December  31,  2009,  retained  earnings  included  approximately  $  540  in  tax-exempt  income  earned  by  the  Company's
"Approved Enterprise". The Company's Board of Directors has decided not to declare dividends out of such tax-exempt income.
Accordingly, no deferred income taxes have been provided on income attributable to the Company's "Approved Enterprise".

Tax-exempt  income  attributable  to  the  "Approved  Enterprise"  cannot  be  distributed  to  shareholders  without  subjecting  the
Company  to  taxes  except  upon  complete  liquidation  of  the  Company.  If  such  retained  tax-exempt  income  is  distributed  in  a
manner other than upon the complete liquidation of the Company, it would be taxed at the corporate tax rate applicable to such
profits as if the Company had not elected the alternative tax benefits (currently between 10% - 25%) and an income tax liability of
approximately up to $ 135 would be incurred by the Company.

The  entitlement  to  the  above  benefits  is  conditional  upon  the  Company  fulfilling  the  conditions  stipulated  by  the  above
Investment  Law,  regulations  published  thereunder  and  the  letters  of  approval  for  the  specific  investments  in  "Approved
Enterprises".  In  the  event  of  failure  to  comply  with  these  conditions,  the  benefits  may  be  canceled  and  the  Company  may  be
required  to  refund  the  amount  of  the  benefits,  in  whole  or  in  part,  including  interest.  As  of  December  31,  2009,  management
believes that the Company is in compliance with all of the aforementioned conditions.

Income from sources other than the "Approved Enterprise" during the benefit period will be subject to tax at the regular tax rate
prevailing at that time.

On  April  1,  2005,  an  amendment  to  the  Investment  Law  came  into  effect  ("the  Amendment")  that  significantly  changed  the
provisions of the Investment Law. The Amendment limits the scope of enterprises that may be approved by the Investment Center
by setting criteria for the approval of a facility as a Beneficiary Enterprise including a provision generally requiring that at least
25% of the Beneficiary Enterprise's income will be derived from export. Additionally, the Amendment enacted major changes in
the manner in which tax benefits are awarded under the Investment Law so that companies no longer require Investment Center
approval in order to qualify for tax benefits.

However, the Investment Law provides that terms and benefits included in any certificate of approval already granted will remain
subject  to  the  provisions  of  the  Investment  Law  as  they  were  on  the  date  of  such  approval.  Therefore,  the  Company's  existing
"Approved Enterprises" will generally not be subject to the provisions of the Amendment. As a result of the Amendment, tax-
exempt  income  generated  under  the  provisions  of  the  Investment  Law,  as  amended,  will  subject  the  Company  to  taxes  upon
distribution  or  liquidation  and  the  Company  may  be  required  to  record  a  deferred  tax  liability  with  respect  to  such  tax-exempt
income. As of December 31, 2009, there was no taxable income attributable to the Beneficiary Enterprise.

F-36

 
  
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
U.S. dollars in thousands, except share and per share data

NOTE 14:-

TAXES ON INCOME (Cont.)

3.

Net operating loss carryforward:

AUDIOCODES LTD. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES

As of December 31, 2009, the Company has accumulated losses for tax purposes in the amount of approximately $ 48,000, which
can  be  carried  forward  and  offset  against  taxable  income  in  the  future  for  an  indefinite  period.  As  of  December  31,  2009,  the
Company recorded a deferred tax asset of $ 1,447 relating to the available net carry forward tax losses.

As  of  December  31,  2009,  the  Company's  Israeli  subsidiaries  have  estimated  total  available  carry  forward  tax  losses  of
approximately $ 60,000.

4.

Tax benefits under the law for the Encouragement of Industry (taxes), 1969 ("the Encouragement Law"):

The Encouragement Law, provides several tax benefits for industrial companies. An industrial company is defined as a company
resident in Israel, at least 90% of the income of which in a given tax year exclusive of income from specified Government loans,
capital gains, interest and dividends, is derived from an industrial enterprise owned by it. An industrial enterprise is defined as an
enterprise whose major activity in a given tax year is industrial production activity.

Management believes that the Company is currently qualified as an "industrial company" under the Encouragement Law and as
such,  enjoys  tax  benefits,  including:  (1)  Deduction  of  purchase  of  know-how  and  patents  and/or  right  to  use  a  patent  over  an
eight-year period; (2) The right to elect, under specified conditions, to file a consolidated tax return with additional related Israeli
industrial companies and an industrial holding company; (3) Accelerated depreciation rates on equipment and buildings; and (4)
Expenses related to a public offering on the Tel-Aviv Stock and on recognized stock markets outside of Israel, are deductible in
equal amounts over three years.

Eligibility for benefits under the Encouragement Law is not subject to receipt of prior approval from any Governmental authority.
No assurance can be given that the Israeli tax authorities will agree that the Company qualifies, or, if the Company qualifies, then
the  Company  will  continue  to  qualify  as  an  industrial  company  or  that  the  benefits  described  above  will  be  available  to  the
Company in the future.

5.

Tax rates:

Taxable income of Israeli companies is subject to tax at the rate of 27% in 2008, 26% in 2009, and 25% in 2010 and thereafter. In
July  2009,  Israel's  Parliament  (the  Knesset)  passed  the  Economic  Efficiency  Law  (Amended  Legislation  for  Implementing  the
Economic  Plan  for  2009  and  2010),  2009,  which  prescribes,  among  other  things,  an  additional  gradual  reduction  in  the  Israeli
corporate tax rate and real capital gains tax rate starting from 2011 to the following tax rates: 2011 - 24%, 2012 - 23%, 2013 -
22%, 2014 - 21%, 2015 - 20%, 2016 and thereafter - - 18%. However, the effective tax rate payable by a company which derives
income from an "Approved Enterprise" may be considerably lower (see also Note 14 a2).

F-37

 
  
 
 
 
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
U.S. dollars in thousands, except share and per share data

NOTE 14:-

TAXES ON INCOME (Cont.)

b. Loss before taxes on income comprised as follows:

c. Taxes on income are comprised as follows:

Domestic
Foreign

Current taxes
Deferred taxes

Domestic
Foreign

F-38

AUDIOCODES LTD. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES

Year ended December 31,
2008

2007

2009

(1,706)   $
(4,654)    

(2,811)   $
(79,892)    

(5,963)
3,035 

(6,360)   $

(82,703)   $

(2,928)

Year ended December 31,
2008

2007

2009

(1,125)   $
2,390     

674    $
(169)    

1,265    $

505    $

(1,575)   $
2,840     

(1,365)   $
1,870     

1,265    $

505    $

290 
- 

290 

484 
(194)

290 

  $

  $

  $

  $

  $

  $

 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
 
   
     
     
 
   
 
   
      
      
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
 
   
     
     
 
   
 
   
      
      
  
 
 
   
      
      
  
   
 
   
      
      
  
 
 
AUDIOCODES LTD. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
U.S. dollars in thousands, except share and per share data

NOTE 14:-

TAXES ON INCOME (Cont.)

d. Deferred income taxes:

Deferred  income  taxes  reflect  the  net  tax  effects  of  temporary  differences  between  the  carrying  amounts  of  assets  and  liabilities  for
financial reporting purposes and the amounts used for income tax purposes. Significant components of the Group's deferred tax liabilities
and assets are as follows:

Deferred tax assets:

Net operating loss carry forward
Reserves and allowances

Deferred tax liabilities:

Senior convertible notes
Depreciation

Net deferred tax assets before valuation allowance
Valuation allowance

Deferred tax asset

Domestic:

Short-term deferred tax asset
Long-term deferred tax asset

Foreign:

Short-term deferred tax asset
Long-term deferred tax asset

December 31,

2008

2009

  $

61,093    $
3,822     

53,748 
8,291 

64,915     

62,039 

735     
736     

1,471     

- 
- 

- 

63,444     
(61,217)    

62,039 
(59,812)

2,227    $

2,227 

652    $
795     

678 
765 

1,447    $

1,443 

320    $
460     

780    $

375 
409 

784 

  $

  $

  $

  $

  $

The  Company's  U.S.  subsidiaries  have  estimated  total  available  carry  forward  tax  losses  of  approximately  $  83,000  to  offset  against
future  taxable  income  that  expire  between  2020  and  2029.  As  of  December  31,  2009,  the  Company  recorded  a  deferred  tax  asset  of
$ 784 relating to the available net carry forward tax losses.

Utilization of U.S. net operating losses may be subject to substantial annual limitations due to the "change in ownership" provisions of
the Internal Revenue Code of 1986 and similar state provisions. The annual limitation may result in the expiration of net operating losses
before utilization.

F-39

 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
     
 
   
 
   
      
  
 
   
   
      
  
   
   
 
   
      
  
 
   
 
   
      
  
   
   
 
   
      
  
 
   
      
  
   
      
  
   
 
   
      
  
 
 
   
      
  
   
      
  
   
 
   
      
  
 
 
AUDIOCODES LTD. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
U.S. dollars in thousands, except share and per share data

NOTE 14:-

TAXES ON INCOME (Cont.)

e. Reconciliation of the theoretical tax expenses:

A reconciliation between the theoretical tax expense, assuming all income is taxed at the statutory tax rate applicable to income of the
Company, and the actual tax expense as reported in the statement of operations is as follows:

Loss before taxes, as reported in the consolidated statements of operations

  $

(6,360)   $

(82,703)   $

(2,928)

Statutory tax rate

29%   

27%   

26%

Year ended December 31,
2008

2007

2009

Theoretical tax benefits on the above amount at the Israeli statutory tax rate
Income tax at rate other than the Israeli statutory tax rate (1)
Non-deductible expenses including equity based compensation expenses
Non-deductible expenses which results from Impairment of goodwill, other intangible assets and

  $

investment in affiliate

Deferred taxes on losses for which a valuation allowance was provided
Utilization of operation losses carry forward
Taxes in respect to prior years
State and Federal taxes
Inter-company charges
Other individually immaterial income tax item

Actual tax expense

(1)   Per share amounts (basic) of the tax benefit resulting from the exemption

Per share amounts (diluted) of the tax benefit resulting from the exemption

(1,844)   $
655 
3,834 

- 
3,333 
(3,355)    
(1,588)    
689 
(430)    
(29)    

(22,330)   $
139 
2,172 

23,250 
75 
(3,231)    
87 
177 
57 
109 

  $

  $

  $

1,265 

  $

505 

  $

0.02 

0.02 

  $

  $

0.01 

0.01 

  $

  $

(761)
337 
1,425 

- 
633 
(1,469)
90 
21 
- 
14 

290 

0.01 

0.01 

f. The Company adopted the provisions of amendment to ASC 740 on January 1, 2007. Prior to 2007, the Company used the provisions of
FAS 5 (as codified in ASC 450) to determine tax contingencies. As of January 1, 2007, there was no difference in the Company's tax
contingencies under the provisions of the amended ASC. As a result, there was no effect on the Company's shareholders equity upon the
Company's adoption of the amended ASC.

F-40

 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
  
   
  
   
  
   
 
   
  
   
  
   
  
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
 
   
  
   
  
   
  
 
   
  
   
  
   
  
 
 
 
AUDIOCODES LTD. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
U.S. dollars in thousands, except share and per share data

NOTE 14:-

TAXES ON INCOME (Cont.)

A reconciliation of the beginning and ending amount of unrecognized tax benefits is as follows:

Gross unrecognized tax benefits as of January 1, 2009

Increase in tax position for current year

Gross unrecognized tax benefits as of December 31, 2009

  $

158 

- 

  $

158 

The Company recognizes interest and penalties related to unrecognized tax benefits in tax expenses. The liability for unrecognized tax
benefits does not include accrued interest and penalties of $ 153 and $ 164 at December 31, 2008 and 2009, respectively.

NOTE 15:-

BASIC AND DILUTED NET LOSS PER SHARE

Numerator:

Year ended December 31,
2008

2007

2009

Net loss available to ordinary shareholders

  $

(8,722)   $

(85,790)   $

(2,822)

Denominator:

Denominator for basic earnings per share - weighted average number of ordinary shares, net of

treasury stock

Effect of dilutive securities:
Employee stock options and ESPP
Senior convertible notes
Denominator for diluted net earnings per share - adjusted weighted average number of shares

42,699,307     

41,200,523     

40,207,923 

  *)
  *)

-    *)
-    *)

  -    *)
-    *)

42,699,307     

41,200,523     

- 
- 
40,207,923 

*)         Antidilutive.

NOTE 16:-

FINANCIAL EXPENSES, NET

Financial expenses:

Interest
Amortization of marketable securities premiums and accretion of discounts, net
Others

  $

(7,419)   $
(40)    
(617)    

(6,807)   $
(110)    
(131)    

(4,739)
(253)
(232)

Year ended December 31,
2008

2007

2009

Financial income:

Interest and others

(8,076)    

(7,048)    

(5,224)

5,909     

3,780     

2,480 

  $

(2,167)   $

(3,268)   $

(2,744)

F-41

 
  
 
   
  
   
 
   
  
 
   
  
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
   
     
     
 
 
   
     
     
 
 
   
      
      
  
   
      
      
  
 
   
      
      
  
   
   
      
      
  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
 
   
     
     
 
   
     
     
 
   
   
 
   
      
      
  
 
   
   
      
      
  
   
 
   
      
      
  
 
 
AUDIOCODES LTD. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
U.S. dollars in thousands, except share and per share data

NOTE 17:-

GEOGRAPHIC INFORMATION

a. Summary information about geographic areas:

The Group manages its business on a basis of one reportable segment (see Note 1 for a brief description of the Group's business). The
data  is  presented  in  accordance  with  ASC  280  (formerly:  SFAS  No.  131),  "Segment  Reporting".  Revenues  in  the  table  below  are
attributed to geographical areas based on the location of the end customers.

The following presents total revenues for the years ended December 31, 2007, 2008 and 2009 and long-lived assets as of December 31,
2007, 2008 and 2009.

2007

2008

2009

Total
revenues

Long-
lived
assets

Total
revenues

Long-
lived
assets

Total
revenues

Long-
lived
assets

Israel
Americas
Europe
Far East

  $

10,604    $
89,614     
40,305     
17,712     

23,261    $
113,894     
105     
53     

13,597    $
91,640     
40,854     
28,653     

21,599    $
26,250     
118     
56     

10,410    $
69,960     
27,101     
18,423     

21,138 
22,799 
87 
74 

  $

158,235    $

137,313    $

174,744    $

48,023    $

125,894    $

44,098 

b. Product lines:

Total revenues from external customers divided on the basis of the Company's product lines are as follows:

Technology
Networking

NOTE 18:-

DERIVATIVE INSTRUMENTS

Year ended December 31,
2008

2007

2009

  $

56,426    $
101,809     

58,484    $
116,260     

34,995 
90,899 

  $

158,235    $

174,744    $

125,894 

The Company enters into hedge transactions with a major financial institution, using derivative instruments, primarily forward contracts and
options to purchase and sell foreign currencies, in order to reduce the net currency exposure associated with anticipated expenses (primarily
salaries and rent expenses) in currencies other than U.S. dollar. The Company currently hedges such future exposures for a maximum period
of one year. However, the Company may choose not to hedge certain foreign currency exchange exposures for a variety of reasons, including
but not limited to immateriality, accounting considerations and the prohibitive economic cost of hedging particular exposures. There can be
no assurance the hedges will offset more than a portion of the financial impact resulting from movements in foreign currency exchange rates.

The Company records all derivatives in the consolidated balance sheet at fair value. The effective portions of cash flow hedges are recorded
in other comprehensive income until the hedged item is recognized in earnings. The ineffective portions of cash flow hedges are adjusted to
fair  value  through  earnings  in  financial  other  income  or  expense.  The  Company  does  not  enter  into  derivative  transactions  for  trading
purposes.

F-42

 
  
 
 
 
   
   
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
   
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
   
 
 
   
     
     
     
     
     
 
   
   
   
 
   
      
      
      
      
      
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
 
   
     
     
 
   
 
   
      
      
  
 
 
AUDIOCODES LTD. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
U.S. dollars in thousands, except share and per share data

NOTE 18:-

DERIVATIVE INSTRUMENTS (Cont.)

The Company had a net deferred loss associated with cash flow hedges of $ 912 and a net deferred gain associated with cash flow hedges of
$  98  recorded  in  other  comprehensive  income  as  of  December  31,  2008  and  2009,  respectively.  As  of  December  31,  2009,  the  hedged
transactions are expected to occur within twelve months.

The  Company  entered  into  forward  contracts  to  hedge  the  fair  value  of  assets  denominated  in  New  Israeli  Shekels  that  did  not  meet  the
requirement for hedge accounting. The Company measured the fair value of the contracts in accordance with ASC No. 820 at level 2. The net
losses recognized in "financial and other expenses, net" during 2009 were $ 81.

As of December 31, 2008 and 2009, the Company had outstanding forward contracts in the amount of $ 10,800 and $ 10,500, respectively.

The fair value of the Company’s outstanding derivative instruments and the effect of derivative instruments in cash flow hedging relationship
on other comprehensive income for the years ended December 31, 2008 and 2009, are summarized below:

Foreign exchange forward and
options contracts

Balance sheet

As of December 31,

2008

2009

Fair value of foreign exchange forward contracts

"Other receivables and prepaid expenses"

"Other payables and accrued expenses"

  $

  $

     $

98 

(912)   $

Increase (decrease) in gains recognized in OCI (effective
portion)

"Other comprehensive income"

  $

(1,959)   $

1,010 

The  effect  of  derivative  instruments  in  cash  flow  hedging  relationship  on  income  for  the  years  ended  December  31,  2009  and  2008  is
summarized below:

Foreign exchange forward and
options contracts

Statements of
operations

Year ended December 31,

2009

2008

Gain (loss)  on derivatives recognized in OCI

"Operating expenses"

Gain (loss) recognized in income on derivatives (effective

portion)

"Operating expenses"

  $

  $

1,622    $

(3,467)

(612)   $

1,508 

F-43

 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
   
     
 
 
 
 
 
   
      
  
 
 
  
 
 
 
   
      
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
   
     
 
 
 
 
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
U.S. dollars in thousands, except share and per share data

NOTE 19:-

SUBSEQUENT EVENTS

AUDIOCODES LTD. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES

In  January  2010,  AudioCodes  entered  into  an  agreement  to  acquire  all  of  the  outstanding  equity  of  NSC  that  it  had  not  owned  as  of
December 31, 2009. The closing of the transaction occurred in May 2010. Pursuant to the agreement, AudioCodes will pay an aggregate of
approximately $ 1,200 for the remaining interest in NSC, payable in three annual installments commencing on the first anniversary of the
closing.  AudioCodes  will  also  be  required  to  pay  an  additional  consolidation  price  of  up  to  $  500  in  2013  if  certain  aggregate  revenue
milestones are met for 2010, 2011 and 2012.

In May 2007, the Company entered into an agreement pursuant to which a building of approximately 145,000 square feet will be erected and
leased to the Company for period of eleven years. This new building is expected to be completed in 2010. In May 2010, the constructor and
owners of the building have notified the Company that it has completed a certain milestone in the construction of the building, and that in
accordance with the agreement the tenure of the building should be transferred to the Company effective May 2010. Under such scenario the
Company is required to pay lease starting that month. The Company rejected the claim and believes it has valid legal defenses to oppose such
claim since the Company is not legally allowed to occupy the building. Due to the preliminary stage of the claim and related discussions, the
Company and its legal advisors are unable currently to assess the outcome of the claim and its effect on the Company.

- - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - -

F-44

 
  
 
Exhibit No.

12.1

13.1

15.1

EXHIBIT INDEX

Exhibit

  Certification of Shabtai Adlersberg, President, Chief Executive Officer and Interim Chief Financial Officer , pursuant to Section 302 of the

Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.

  Certification by Chief Executive Officer and Interim Chief Financial Officer Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as Adopted Pursuant to

Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.

  Consent of Kost Forer Gabbay & Kasierer, a member of Ernst & Young Global.

128

 
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 
CERTIFICATION PURSUANT TO
SECTION 302(A) OF THE SARBANES-OXLEY ACT OF 2002

Exhibit 12.1

I, Shabtai Adlersberg, certify that:

1.

I have reviewed this annual report on Form 20-F of AudioCodes Ltd.;

2. Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the

statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;

3. Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial

condition, results of operations and cash flows of the company as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;

4. The company’s other certifying officer(s) and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in

Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for
the company and have:

(a) Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure

that material information relating to the company, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities,
particularly during the period in which this annual report is being prepared;

(b) Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision,
to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in
accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;

(c) Evaluated the effectiveness of the company’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness

of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and

(d) Disclosed in this report any change in the company’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the period covered by the annual

report that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the company’s internal control over financial reporting; and

5. The company’s other certifying officer(s) and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the

company’s auditors and the audit committee of company’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):

(a) All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely

to adversely affect the company’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and

(b) Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the company’s internal control over

financial reporting.

Date: June 29, 2010

/s/ Shabtai Adlersberg
Shabtai Adlersberg
Chief Executive Officer and
Interim Chief Financial Officer

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
CERTIFICATION PURSUANT TO
18 U.S.C. SECTION 1350
AS ADOPTED PURSUANT TO
SECTION 906 OF THE SARBANES-OXLEY ACT OF 2002

Exhibit 13.1

          In connection with the Annual Report of AudioCodes Ltd. (the “Company”) on Form 20-F for the period ending December 31, 2009 as filed with the
Securities and Exchange Commission on the date hereof (the “Report”), I, Shabtai Adlersberg, Chief Executive Officer and Interim Chief Financial Officer of
the Company, certify, pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, that, to my knowledge:

          (1)       The Report fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934; and

          (2)       The information contained in the Report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and result of operations of the Company.

 Date: June 29, 2010

/s/ Shabtai Adlersberg
 Shabtai Adlersberg
Chief Executive Officer and
Interim Chief Financial Officer

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Exhibit 15.1

CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

We consent to the incorporation by reference in the following Registration Statements:

1.           Registration Statement on Form S-8 (File No. 333-11894) pertaining to the AudioCodes Ltd. 1999 Key Employee Option Plan (F) and the

AudioCodes Ltd. 1999 Key Employee Option Plan, Qualified Stock Option Plan-US Employees (F),

2.           Registration Statement on Form S-8 (File No. 333-13268) pertaining to the AudioCodes Ltd. 1999 Key Employee Option Plan (F), as

amended, and the AudioCodes Ltd. 1999 Key Employee Option Plan, Qualified Stock Option Plan-US Employees (F),

3.           Registration Statement on Form S-8 (File No. 333-105473) pertaining to the AudioCodes Ltd. 1999 Key Employee Option Plan (F) and the

AudioCodes Ltd. 1999 Key Employee Option Plan, Qualified Stock Option Plan-US Employees (F),

4.           Registration Statement on Form S-8 (File No. 333-13378) pertaining to the AudioCodes Ltd. 2001 Employee Stock Purchase Plan Global

Non-U.S. and the AudioCodes Ltd. 2001 U.S. Employee Stock Purchase Plan,

5.           Registration Statement on Form S-8 (File No. 333-144823) pertaining to the AudioCodes Ltd. 2001 U.S. Employee Stock Purchase Plan, as

amended, and the AudioCodes Ltd. 2001 Employee Stock Purchase Plan Global Non-U.S., as amended,

6.           Registration Statement on Form S-8 (File No. 333-144825) pertaining to the AudioCodes Ltd. 2007 U.S. Employee Stock Purchase Plan, and

7.           Registration Statement on Form S-8 (File No. 333-160330) pertaining to the AudioCodes Ltd. 2008 Equity Incentive Plan.

of our reports dated June 28, 2010, with respect to the consolidated financial statements of AudioCodes Ltd., and the effectiveness of internal control over
financial  reporting  of  AudioCodes  Ltd.  included  in  this  Annual  Report  on  Form  20-F  for  the  year  ended  December  31,  2009,  filed  with  the  Securities  and
Exchange Commission.

Tel-Aviv, Israel
June 28, 2010

/s/ Kost Forer Gabbay & Kasierer

KOST FORER GABBAY & KASIERER
A Member of Ernst & Young Global